Expansions: New ${ipv6denorm:<string>} and ${ipv6norm:<string>} operators. Bug 1650
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3111 configuration file is output.
3112 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3113 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3114
3115 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3116 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3117 name will not be output.
3118
3119 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3120 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3121 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3122 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3123 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3124 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3125 written directly into the spool directory.
3126
3127 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3128 .code
3129 exim -bP +local_domains
3130 .endd
3131 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3132 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3133
3134 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3135 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3136 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3137 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3138 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3139 that driver are output. For example:
3140 .code
3141 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3142 .endd
3143 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3144 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3145 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3146 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3147 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3148 &%authenticators%&.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3151 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3152 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3153 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3154 The output format is one item per line.
3155
3156 .vitem &%-bp%&
3157 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3158 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3159 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3160 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3161 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3162 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3163 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3164 to allow any user to see the queue.
3165
3166 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3167 .code
3168 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3169 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3170 <other addresses>
3171 .endd
3172 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3173 .cindex "size" "of message"
3174 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3175 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3176 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3177 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3178 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3179 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3180 before the sender address.
3181
3182 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3183 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3184 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3185
3186 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3187 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3188 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3189 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3190 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3191 complete.
3192
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3196 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3197 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3198 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3199 of just &"D"&.
3200
3201
3202 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3203 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3204 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3205 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3206 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3207 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3208
3209
3210 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3211 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3212 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3213 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3214 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3215 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3216
3217 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3218 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3219 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3224
3225
3226 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3227 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3228 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3229 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3230 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3231 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3232
3233
3234 .vitem &%-brt%&
3235 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3236 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3237 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3238 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3239 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3240 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3241 .code
3242 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3243 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3244 .endd
3245 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3246 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3247 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3248 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3249 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3250 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3251 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3252 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3253 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3254 .code
3255 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3256 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3257 .endd
3258
3259 .vitem &%-brw%&
3260 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3261 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3262 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3263 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3264 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3265 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3266 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3267 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3268
3269 .vitem &%-bS%&
3270 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3271 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3272 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3273 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3274 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3275 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3276 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3277 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3278 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3279 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3280
3281 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3282 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3283 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3284
3285 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3286 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3287 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3288 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3289
3290 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3291 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3292 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3293
3294 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3295 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3296 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3297 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3298 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3299
3300 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3301 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3302
3303 .vitem &%-bs%&
3304 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3305 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3306 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3307 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3308 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3309 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3310 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3311 messages to the MTA.
3312
3313 In
3314 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3315 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3316 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3317 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3318 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3319 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3320 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3321
3322 .cindex "inetd"
3323 The
3324 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3325 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3326 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3327 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3328 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3329 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3330 the listening daemon.
3331
3332 .vitem &%-bt%&
3333 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3334 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3335 .cindex "address" "testing"
3336 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3337 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3338 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3339 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3340 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3341
3342 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3343 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3344
3345 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3346 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3347 security issues.
3348
3349 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3350 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3351 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3352 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3353 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3354 program.
3355
3356 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3357 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3358 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3359 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3360
3361 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3362 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3363 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3364 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3365 always shown.
3366
3367 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3368 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3369 message,
3370 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3371 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3372 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3373 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3374 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3375 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3376 doing such tests.
3377
3378 .vitem &%-bV%&
3379 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3380 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3381 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3382 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3383 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3384 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3385 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3386
3387 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3388 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3389 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3390 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3391 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3392 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3393 dynamic testing facilities.
3394
3395 .vitem &%-bv%&
3396 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3397 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3398 .cindex "address" "verification"
3399 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3400 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3401 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3402 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3403 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3404 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3405
3406 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3407 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3408 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3409
3410 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3411 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3412
3413 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3414 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3415 security issues.
3416
3417 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3418 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3419 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3420 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3421 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3422
3423 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3424 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3425 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3426 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3427 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3428 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3429 to succeed.
3430
3431 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3432 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3433 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3434
3435 The
3436 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3437 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3438 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3439 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3440
3441 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3442 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3443 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3444 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3445
3446 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3447 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3448 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3449 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3450 might happen.
3451
3452 .vitem &%-bw%&
3453 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3454 .cindex "daemon"
3455 .cindex "inetd"
3456 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3457 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3458 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3459 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3460
3461 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3462 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3463 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3464 each port only when the first connection is received.
3465
3466 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3467 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3468
3469 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3470 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3471 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3472 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3473 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3474 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3475 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3476 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3477 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3478 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3479 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3480
3481 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3482 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3483 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3484 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3485 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3486 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3487 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3488 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3489 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3490
3491 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3492 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3493 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3494 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3495 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3496 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3497 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3498
3499 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3500 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3501 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3502 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3503 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3504 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3505 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3506
3507 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3508 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3509 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3510 configuration file.
3511
3512 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3513 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3514 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3515 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3516 specified by this option.
3517
3518
3519 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3520 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3521 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3522 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3523 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3524 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3525 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3526 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3527
3528 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3529 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3530 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3531 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3532 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3533 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3534 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3535
3536 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3537 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3538 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3539 synonymous:
3540 .code
3541 exim -DABC ...
3542 exim -DABC= ...
3543 .endd
3544 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3545 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3546 example:
3547 .code
3548 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3549 .endd
3550 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3551
3552
3553 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3554 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3555 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3556 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3557 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3558 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3559 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3560 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3561 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3562 return code.
3563
3564 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3565 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3566 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3567 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3568 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3569 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3570 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3571 are:
3572 .display
3573 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3574 &`auth `& authenticators
3575 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3576 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3577 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3578 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3579 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3580 &`filter `& filter handling
3581 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3582 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3583 &`ident `& ident lookup
3584 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3585 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3586 &`load `& system load checks
3587 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3588 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3589 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3590 &`memory `& memory handling
3591 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3592 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3593 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3594 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3595 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3596 &`retry `& retry handling
3597 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3598 &`route `& address routing
3599 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3600 &`tls `& TLS logic
3601 &`transport `& transports
3602 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3603 &`verify `& address verification logic
3604 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3605 .endd
3606 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3607 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3608 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3609 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3610 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3611 turn everything off.
3612
3613 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3614 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3615 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3616 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3617 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3618 rather than stderr.
3619
3620 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3621 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3622 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3623 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3624 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3625 run in parallel.
3626
3627 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3628 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3629 in processing.
3630
3631 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3632 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3633
3634 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3635 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3636 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3637 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3638 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3639 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3642 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3643 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3644 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3645 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3646
3647 .vitem &%-E%&
3648 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3649 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3650 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3651 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3652 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3653 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3654 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3655 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3656 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3659 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3660 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3661 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3662 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3663 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3666 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3667 .cindex "sender" "name"
3668 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3669 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3670 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3671 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3672 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3673 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3674
3675 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3676 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3677 .cindex "sender" "address"
3678 .cindex "address" "sender"
3679 .cindex "trusted users"
3680 .cindex "envelope sender"
3681 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3682 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3683 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3684 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3685 users to use it.
3686
3687 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3688 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3689 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3690 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3691 domain.
3692
3693 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3694 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3695 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3696 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3697 examples of shell commands:
3698 .code
3699 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3700 exim -f "" user@domain
3701 .endd
3702 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3703 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3704 &%-bv%& options.
3705
3706 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3707 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3708 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3709 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3710
3711 White
3712 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3713 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3714 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3715 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3716 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3717 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3718
3719 .vitem &%-G%&
3720 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3721 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3722 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3723 .code
3724 control = suppress_local_fixups
3725 .endd
3726 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3727 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3728 in future.
3729
3730 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3731 this option.
3732
3733 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3734 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3735 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3736 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3737 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3738 headers.)
3739
3740 .vitem &%-i%&
3741 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3742 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3743 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3744 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3745 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3746 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3747 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3748
3749 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3750 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3751 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3752 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3753 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3754 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3755 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3756 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3757
3758 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3759
3760 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3761 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3762 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3763 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3764 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3765 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3766 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3767 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3768 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3769
3770 Retry
3771 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3772 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3773 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3774 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3775 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3776 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3777
3778 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3779 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3780 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3781 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3782
3783 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3784 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3785 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3786 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3787 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3788 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3789 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3790 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3791 can be used only by an admin user.
3792
3793 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3794 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3795 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3796 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3797 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3798 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3799 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3800 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3801 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3802 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3803 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3804
3805 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3806 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3807 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3808 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3809 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3810
3811 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3812 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3813 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3814 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3815 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3816
3817 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3818 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3821 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3822
3823 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3824 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3825 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3827 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3828 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3829 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3830 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3831
3832 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3833 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3836 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3837 connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3844
3845 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3846 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3847 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3848 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3849 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3850 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3851 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3852 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3853 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3854 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3855 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3856 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3857 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3858 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3859 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3860
3861 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3862 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3863 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3864 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3865 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3866 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3867 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3868 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3869 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3870 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3871
3872 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3873 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3874 .cindex "freezing messages"
3875 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3876 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3877 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3878 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3879 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3880 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3881 user.
3882
3883 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3884 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3885 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3886 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3887 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3888 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3889 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3890 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3891 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3892 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3893 user.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3896 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3897 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3898 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3899 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3900 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3901 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3902
3903 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3904 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3905 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3906 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3907 .cindex "removing recipients"
3908 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3909 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3910 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3911 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3912 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3913 can be used only by an admin user.
3914
3915 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3916 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3917 .cindex "removing messages"
3918 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3919 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3920 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3921 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3922 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3923 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3924 placed on the queue.
3925
3926 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3927 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3928 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3929 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3930 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3931 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3932 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3933 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3934 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3935 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3936 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3937
3938 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3939 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3940 .cindex "thawing messages"
3941 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3942 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3943 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3944 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3945 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3946 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3947 by an admin user.
3948
3949 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3950 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3951 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3952 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3953 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3954 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3958 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3959 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3960 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3961 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3962 only by an admin user.
3963
3964 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3965 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3967 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3968 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3969 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3970 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3971
3972 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3973 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3974 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3977 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-m%&
3980 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3981 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3982 treats it that way too.
3983
3984 .vitem &%-N%&
3985 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3986 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3987 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3988 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3989 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3990 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3991 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3992 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3993 than &"=>"&.
3994
3995 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3996 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3997 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3998 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3999 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4000 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4001 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4002 for that message.
4003
4004 .vitem &%-n%&
4005 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4006 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4007 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4008 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4009
4010 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4011 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4012 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4013 Exim.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4017 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4018 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4019 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4020 description above.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4024 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4025 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4026 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4027 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4028 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4029 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4030
4031 .vitem &%-odb%&
4032 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4033 .cindex "background delivery"
4034 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4035 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4036 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4037 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4038 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4039 processes to finish.
4040
4041 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4042 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4043 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4044 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4045
4046 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4047 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4048 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4049 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4050
4051 .vitem &%-odf%&
4052 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4053 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4054 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4055 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4056 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4057 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4058 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4059
4060 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4061 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4062 during deliveries.
4063
4064 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4065 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4066
4067 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4068 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4069 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4070 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4071
4072
4073 .vitem &%-odi%&
4074 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4075 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4076 Sendmail.
4077
4078 .vitem &%-odq%&
4079 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4080 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4081 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4082 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4083 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4084 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4085 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4086 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4087 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4088 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4089 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4090 forces queueing.
4091
4092 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4093 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4094 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4095 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4096 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4097 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4098 configuration file is in effect.
4099
4100 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4101 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4102 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4103 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4104 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4105 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4106 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4107 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4108 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4109 &%-qq%& option.
4110
4111 .vitem &%-oee%&
4112 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4113 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4114 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4115 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4116 message.
4117
4118 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4119 Provided
4120 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4121 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4122 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4123 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4124
4125 .vitem &%-oem%&
4126 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4127 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4128 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4129 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4130 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4131 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4132
4133 .vitem &%-oep%&
4134 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4135 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4136 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4137 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4138 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4139 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4140
4141 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4142 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4143 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4144 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4145 effect as &%-oep%&.
4146
4147 .vitem &%-oew%&
4148 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4149 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4150 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4151 effect as &%-oem%&.
4152
4153 .vitem &%-oi%&
4154 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4155 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4156 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4157 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4158 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4159 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4160 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4161
4162 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4163 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4164 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4165
4166 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4167 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4168 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4169 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4170 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4171 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4172 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4173 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4174
4175 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4176 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4177 .code
4178 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4179 .endd
4180 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4181 followed by a colon and the port number:
4182 .code
4183 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4184 .endd
4185 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4186 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4187 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4188 whichever one is last.
4189
4190 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4191 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4192 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4193 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4194 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4195 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4196 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4197 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4198
4199 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4200 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4201 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4202 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4203 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4204 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4205 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4206 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4207
4208 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4209 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4210 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4211 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4212 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4213 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4214 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4215 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4216 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4217 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4218
4219 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4220 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4221 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4222 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4223 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4224 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4225 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4226
4227 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4228 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4229 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4230 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4231 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4232 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4233 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4234 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4235 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4236
4237 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4238 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4239 is sending the bounce.
4240
4241 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4242 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4243 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4244 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4245 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4246 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4247 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4248 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4249 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4250 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4251 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4252 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4255 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4256 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4258 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4259 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4260 uses the name it is given.
4261
4262 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4263 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4264 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4266 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4267 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4268 used, when there is no default.
4269
4270 .vitem &%-om%&
4271 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4272 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4273 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4274 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4275 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-oo%&
4278 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4280 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4281 whatever that means.
4282
4283 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4284 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4285 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4286 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4287 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4288 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4289 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4290 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4291 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4294 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4295 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4296 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4297 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4298 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4299 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4300
4301 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4302 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4303 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4304 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4305 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4306 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4307 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4308 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4309
4310 .vitem &%-ov%&
4311 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4312 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4315 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4316 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4317 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4318 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4319 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4320 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4321 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4322 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4323 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4324
4325 .vitem &%-pd%&
4326 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4327 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4328 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4329 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4330 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4331 needed.
4332
4333 .vitem &%-ps%&
4334 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4335 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4336 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4337 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4338 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4339 started.
4340
4341 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4342 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4343 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4344 .display
4345 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4346 .endd
4347 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4348 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4349 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4350 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4351 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4352
4353 .vitem &%-q%&
4354 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4355 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4356 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4357 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4358 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4359 and &%-S%& options).
4360
4361 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4362 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4363 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4364 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4365 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4366 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4367
4368 If
4369 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4370 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4371 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4372 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4373 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4374 proceeding.
4375
4376 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4377 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4378 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4379 this to be repeated periodically.
4380
4381 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4382 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4383 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4384 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4385
4386 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4387 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4388 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4389
4390 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4391 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4392 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4393 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4394
4395 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4396 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4397 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4398 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4399 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4400 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4401 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4402 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4403 transports are run.
4404
4405 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4406 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4407 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4408 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4409 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4410 delivered down a single SMTP
4411 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4412 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4413 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4414 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4415 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4416 intermittently.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4419 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4420 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4421 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4422 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4423 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4424 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4425
4426 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4427 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4428 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4429 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4430 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4431 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4432 their retry times are tried.
4433
4434 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4435 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4436 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4437 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4438 frozen or not.
4439
4440 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4441 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4442 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4443 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4444 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4445 for later delivery.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4448 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4449 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4450 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4451 starting message id. For example:
4452 .code
4453 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4454 .endd
4455 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4456 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4457 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4458 .code
4459 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4460 .endd
4461 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4462 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4463 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4464 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4465 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4466 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4467
4468 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4469 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4470 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4471 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4472 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4473 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4474 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4475 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4476 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4477 .code
4478 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4479 .endd
4480 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4481 process every 30 minutes.
4482
4483 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4484 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4485
4486 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4487 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4488 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4489 compatibility.
4490
4491 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4492 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4493 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4494
4495 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4496 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4497 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4498 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4499 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4500 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4501 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4502 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4503 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4504
4505 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4506 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4507 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4508 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4509 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4510 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4511
4512 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4513 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4514 .code
4515 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4516 .endd
4517 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4518 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4519 applied to each queue run.
4520
4521 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4522 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4523 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4524 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4525 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4526 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4527 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4528 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4529 address will be skipped.
4530
4531 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4532 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4533 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4534 &'ff'& is present.
4535
4536 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4537 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4538 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4539 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4540 an arbitrary command instead.
4541
4542 .vitem &%-r%&
4543 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4544 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4547 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4548 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4549 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4550 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4551 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4552 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4553 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4554
4555 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4556 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4557 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4558 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4559 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4560
4561 .vitem &%-t%&
4562 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4563 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4564 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4565 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4566 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4567 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4568 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4569 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4570 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4571 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4572
4573 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4574 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4575 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4576 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4577 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4578 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4579 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4580 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4581 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4582 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4583 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4584
4585 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4586 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4587 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4588 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4589 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4590 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4591
4592 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4593 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4594 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4595 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4596 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4597 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4598 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4599 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4600 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4601
4602 .vitem &%-ti%&
4603 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4604 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4605 compatibility with Sendmail.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4608 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4609 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4610 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4611 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4612 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4613 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4614 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4615
4616
4617 .vitem &%-U%&
4618 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4619 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4620 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4621 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4622 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4623 set. Exim ignores this option.
4624
4625 .vitem &%-v%&
4626 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4627 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4628 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4629 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4630 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4631 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4632 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4633 unconditional.
4634
4635 .vitem &%-x%&
4636 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4637 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4638 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4639 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4640 this option.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4643 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4644 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4645 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4646
4647 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4648 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4649 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4650 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4651 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4652 under most shells.
4653 .endlist
4654
4655 .ecindex IIDclo1
4656 .ecindex IIDclo2
4657
4658
4659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4660 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4661 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4662 . creates a man page for the options.
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664
4665 .literal xml
4666 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4667 .literal off
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4675
4676
4677 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4678 "The runtime configuration file"
4679
4680 .cindex "run time configuration"
4681 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4682 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4683 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4684 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4685 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4686 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4687 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4688 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4689 control.
4690
4691 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4692 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4693 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4694 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4695 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4696 actually alter the string.
4697
4698 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4699 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4700 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4701 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4702 existing file in the list.
4703
4704 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4705 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4706 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4707 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4708 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4709 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4710 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4711 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4712 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4713 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4714 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4715
4716 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4717 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4718 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4719 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4720 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4721
4722 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4723 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4724 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4725 compromise the Exim user account.
4726
4727 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4728 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4729 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4730 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4731 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4732 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4733 configuration.
4734
4735
4736
4737 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4738 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4739 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4740 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4741 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4742 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4743 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4744 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4745 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4746 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4747 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4748
4749 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4750 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4751 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4752 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4753 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4754 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4755 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4756 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4757 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4758 &%-M%&).
4759
4760 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4761 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4762 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4763 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4764 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4765
4766 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4767 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4768 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4769 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4770 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4771 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4772
4773 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4774 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4775 necessarily be discarded.
4776 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4777 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4778 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4779 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4780 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4781 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4782
4783 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4784 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4785 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4786 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4787 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4788 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4789 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4790
4791 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4792 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4793 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4794
4795
4796
4797 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4799 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4800 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4801 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4802 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4803 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4804 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4805
4806 .ilist
4807 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4808 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4809 .next
4810 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4811 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4812 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4813 .next
4814 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4815 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4816 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4817 .next
4818 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4819 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4820 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4821 .next
4822 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4823 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4824 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4825 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4826 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4827 .next
4828 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4829 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4830 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4831 .next
4832 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4833 want to use this feature, you must set
4834 .code
4835 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4836 .endd
4837 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4838 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4839 .endlist
4840
4841 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4842 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4843 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4844 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4845
4846 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4847 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4848 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4849 and does not introduce a comment.
4850
4851 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4852 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4853 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4854 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4855 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4856
4857 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4858 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4859 change settings as required.
4860
4861 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4862 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4863 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4864 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4865 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4866 described.
4867
4868
4869
4870 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4871 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4872 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4873 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4874 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4875 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4876 using this syntax:
4877 .display
4878 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4879 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4880 .endd
4881 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4882 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4883 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4884 name is required.
4885
4886 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4887 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4888 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4889 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4890
4891 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4892 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4893 for example:
4894 .code
4895 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4896 .include /some/file
4897 .endd
4898 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4899 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4900 inclusion appears.
4901
4902
4903
4904 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4905 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4906 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4907 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4908 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4909 definition, and must be of the form
4910 .display
4911 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4912 .endd
4913 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4914 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4915 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4916 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4917 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4918
4919 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4920 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4921 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4922
4923 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4924 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4925 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4926 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4927 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4928 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4929 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4930 define
4931 .display
4932 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4933 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4934 .endd
4935 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4936 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4937 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4938 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4939 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4940 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4941
4942
4943 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4944 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4945 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4946 &'='&. For example:
4947 .code
4948 MAC = initial value
4949 ...
4950 MAC == updated value
4951 .endd
4952 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4953 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4954 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4955 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4956 .code
4957 MAC = initial value
4958 ...
4959 MAC == MAC and something added
4960 .endd
4961 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4962 from a number of other files.
4963
4964 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4965 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4966 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4967 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4968 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4969 file to be ignored.
4970
4971
4972
4973 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4974 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4975 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4976 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4977 .code
4978 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4979 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4980 .endd
4981 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4982 .code
4983 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4984 .endd
4985 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4986 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4987 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4988
4989
4990 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4991 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4992 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4993 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4994 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4995 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4996 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4997
4998 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4999 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5000 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5001 line. Thus:
5002 .code
5003 .ifdef AAA
5004 message_size_limit = 50M
5005 .else
5006 message_size_limit = 100M
5007 .endif
5008 .endd
5009 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5010 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5011 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5012 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5013 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5014
5015 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5016 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5017 in this line"& will always be true.
5018
5019 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5020 to clarify complicated nestings.
5021
5022
5023
5024 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5025 .cindex "common option syntax"
5026 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5027 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5028 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5029 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5030 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5031 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5032 space) and then the value. For example:
5033 .code
5034 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5035 .endd
5036 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5037 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5038 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5039 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5040 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5041 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5042 word &"hide"&. For example:
5043 .code
5044 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5045 .endd
5046 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5047 .code
5048 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5049 .endd
5050 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5051 all instances of the same driver.
5052
5053 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5054 that are found in option settings.
5055
5056
5057 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5058 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5059 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5060 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5061 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5062 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5063 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5064 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5065 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5066 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5067 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5068 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5069 .code
5070 queue_only
5071 queue_only = true
5072 .endd
5073 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5074 .code
5075 no_queue_only
5076 queue_only = false
5077 .endd
5078 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5079
5080
5081
5082
5083 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5084 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5085 .cindex "format" "integer"
5086 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5087 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5088 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5089 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5090 hexadecimal number.
5091
5092 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5093 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5094 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5095 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5096 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5097 used.
5098
5099
5100 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5101 .cindex "integer format"
5102 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5103 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5104 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5105 Such options are always output in octal.
5106
5107
5108 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5109 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5110 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5111 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5112 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5113
5114
5115
5116 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5117 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5118 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5119 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5120 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5121
5122 .table2 30pt
5123 .irow &%s%& seconds
5124 .irow &%m%& minutes
5125 .irow &%h%& hours
5126 .irow &%d%& days
5127 .irow &%w%& weeks
5128 .endtable
5129
5130 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5131 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5132 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5133
5134
5135
5136 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5137 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5138 .cindex "format" "string"
5139 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5140 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5141 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5142 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5143 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5144 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5145 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5146 therefore equivalent:
5147 .code
5148 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5149 trusted_users = uucp:\
5150 # This comment line is ignored
5151 mail
5152 .endd
5153 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5154 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5155 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5156 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5157 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5158
5159 .table2 100pt
5160 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5161 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5162 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5163 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5164 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5165 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5166 character"
5167 .endtable
5168
5169 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5170 character, that character replaces the pair.
5171
5172 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5173 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5174 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5175 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5176 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5177 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5178
5179
5180 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5181 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5182 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5183 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5184 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5185 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5186 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5187 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5188 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5189 within a quoted configuration string.
5190
5191
5192 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5193 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5194 .cindex "format" "user name"
5195 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5196 .cindex "format" "group name"
5197 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5198 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5199 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5200 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5201
5202
5203 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5204 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5205 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5206 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5207 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5208 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5209 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5210 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5211 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5212 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5213 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5214
5215 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5216 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5217 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5218 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5219 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5220 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5221 example, the list
5222 .code
5223 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5224 .endd
5225 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5226
5227 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5228 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5229 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5230 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5231
5232 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5233 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5234 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5235 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5236 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5237 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5238 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5239 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5240 .code
5241 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5242 .endd
5243 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5244 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5245 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5246
5247 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5248 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5249 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5250 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5251 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5252 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5253 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5254 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5255 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5256 .code
5257 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5258 .endd
5259 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5260 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5261 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5262 the value in quotes. For example:
5263 .code
5264 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5265 .endd
5266 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5267 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5268 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5269 enclosing an empty list item.
5270
5271
5272
5273 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5274 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5275 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5276 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5277 .code
5278 senders = user@domain :
5279 .endd
5280 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5281 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5282 items, the second of which is empty:
5283 .code
5284 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5285 .endd
5286 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5287 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5288 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5289 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5290 .code
5291 senders = :
5292 .endd
5293 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5294 is at the end of the list.
5295
5296
5297
5298
5299 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5300 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5301 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5302 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5303 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5304 a sequence of lines like this:
5305 .display
5306 <&'instance name'&>:
5307 <&'option'&>
5308 ...
5309 <&'option'&>
5310 .endd
5311 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5312 followed by three options settings:
5313 .code
5314 localuser:
5315 driver = accept
5316 check_local_user
5317 transport = local_delivery
5318 .endd
5319 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5320 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5321 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5322 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5323 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5324 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5325
5326 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5327 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5328
5329 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5330 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5331 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5332 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5333 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5334 server.
5335
5336 .cindex "generic options"
5337 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5338 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5339 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5340 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5341 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5342 .cindex "private options"
5343 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5344 they all have default values.
5345
5346 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5347 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5348 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5349
5350 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5351 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5352 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5353 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5354 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5355 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5356 configuration lines:
5357 .code
5358 remote_smtp:
5359 driver = smtp
5360 .endd
5361 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5362 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5363 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5364 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5365 thus:
5366 .code
5367 special_smtp:
5368 driver = smtp
5369 port = 1234
5370 command_timeout = 10s
5371 .endd
5372 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5373 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5374 lines.
5375
5376 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5377 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5378 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5379 option.
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384
5385
5386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5388
5389 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5390 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5391 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5392 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5393 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5394 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5395 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5396 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5397 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5398 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5399 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5400
5401
5402
5403 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5404 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5405 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5406 the line
5407 .code
5408 # primary_hostname =
5409 .endd
5410 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5411 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5412 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5413 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5414
5415 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5416 .code
5417 domainlist local_domains = @
5418 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5419 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5420 .endd
5421 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5422 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5423 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5424 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5425
5426 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5427 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5428 on the local host.
5429
5430 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5431 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5432 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5433 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5434 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5435 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5436
5437 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5438 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5439 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5440 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5441 domain is permitted.
5442
5443 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5444 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5445 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5446 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5447 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5448 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5449
5450 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5451 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5452 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5453
5454 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5455 .code
5456 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5457 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5458 .endd
5459 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5460 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5461 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5462 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5463 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5464 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5465 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5466 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5467 contents of a message to be checked.
5468
5469 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5470 .code
5471 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5472 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5473 .endd
5474 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5475 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5476 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5477 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5478
5479 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5480 .code
5481 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5482 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5483 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5484 .endd
5485 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5486 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5487 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5488 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5489 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5490 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5491 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5492
5493 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5494 .code
5495 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5496 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5497 .endd
5498 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5499 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5500 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5501 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5502 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5503 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5504 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5505 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5506 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5507 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5508 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5509 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5510 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5511 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5512 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5513 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5514
5515 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5516 .code
5517 # qualify_domain =
5518 # qualify_recipient =
5519 .endd
5520 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5521 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5522 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5523 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5524 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5525 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5526
5527 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5528 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5529 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5530 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5531 .code
5532 # allow_domain_literals
5533 .endd
5534 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5535 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5536 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5537 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5538 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5539 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5540
5541 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5542 .code
5543 never_users = root
5544 .endd
5545 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5546 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5547 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5548 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5549 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5550 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5551 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5552 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5553
5554 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5555 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5556 line,
5557 .code
5558 host_lookup = *
5559 .endd
5560 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5561 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5562 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5563 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5564 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5565 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5566 unreachable.
5567
5568 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5569 1413 (hence their names):
5570 .code
5571 rfc1413_hosts = *
5572 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5573 .endd
5574 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5575 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5576 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5577 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5578 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5579 information, you can change this.
5580
5581 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5582 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5583 .code
5584 prdr_enable = true
5585 .endd
5586
5587 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5588 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5589 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5590 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5591 .code
5592 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5593 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5594 .endd
5595 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5596 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5597
5598 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5599 over the default:
5600 .code
5601 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5602 +tls_certificate_verified
5603 .endd
5604
5605 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5606 .code
5607 # percent_hack_domains =
5608 .endd
5609 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5610 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5611 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5612
5613 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5614 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5615 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5616 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5617 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5618 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5619 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5620 always bounce messages.
5621 .code
5622 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5623 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5624 .endd
5625 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5626 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5627 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5628 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5629 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5630
5631
5632
5633 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5634 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5635 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5636 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5637 It starts with the line
5638 .code
5639 begin acl
5640 .endd
5641 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5642 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5643 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5644
5645 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5646 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5647 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5648 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5649 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5650 result of the ACL processing.
5651 .code
5652 acl_check_rcpt:
5653 .endd
5654 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5655 ACL, and names it.
5656 .code
5657 accept hosts = :
5658 .endd
5659 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5660 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5661 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5662 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5663 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5664 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5665
5666 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5667 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5668 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5669 manner.
5670 .code
5671 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5672 domains = +local_domains
5673 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5674
5675 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5676 domains = !+local_domains
5677 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5678 .endd
5679 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5680 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5681 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5682 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5683 in Internet mail addresses.
5684
5685 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5686 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5687 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5688 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5689 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5690 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5691 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5692 policy of being as safe as possible.
5693
5694 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5695 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5696 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5697 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5698 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5699 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5700
5701 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5702 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5703 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5704 have to modify this rule.
5705
5706 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5707 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5708 common convention of local parts constructed as
5709 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5710 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5711 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5712 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5713 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5714 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5715
5716 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5717 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5718 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5719 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5720 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5721 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5722 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5723 .code
5724 accept local_parts = postmaster
5725 domains = +local_domains
5726 .endd
5727 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5728 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5729 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5730 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5731 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5732
5733 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5734 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5735 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5736 .code
5737 require verify = sender
5738 .endd
5739 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5740 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5741 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5742 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5743 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5744 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5745 discusses the details of address verification.
5746 .code
5747 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5748 control = submission
5749 .endd
5750 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5751 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5752 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5753 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5754 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5755 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5756 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5757 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5758 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5759 .code
5760 accept authenticated = *
5761 control = submission
5762 .endd
5763 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5764 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5765 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5766 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5767 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5768 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5769 .code
5770 require message = relay not permitted
5771 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5772 .endd
5773 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5774 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5775 .code
5776 require verify = recipient
5777 .endd
5778 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5779 fails, the address is rejected.
5780 .code
5781 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5782 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5783 # $dnslist_text
5784 # dnslists = black.list.example
5785 #
5786 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5787 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5788 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5789 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5790 .endd
5791 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5792 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5793 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5794 line.
5795 .code
5796 # require verify = csa
5797 .endd
5798 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5799 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5800 records.
5801 .code
5802 accept
5803 .endd
5804 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5805 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5806 .code
5807 acl_check_data:
5808 .endd
5809 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5810 of this ACL are commented out:
5811 .code
5812 # deny malware = *
5813 # message = This message contains a virus \
5814 # ($malware_name).
5815 .endd
5816 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5817 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5818 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5819 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5820 .code
5821 # warn spam = nobody
5822 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5823 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5824 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5825 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5826 .endd
5827 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5828 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5829 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5830 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5831 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5832 whatever the spam score.
5833 .code
5834 accept
5835 .endd
5836 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5837
5838
5839 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5840 .cindex "default" "routers"
5841 .cindex "routers" "default"
5842 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5843 by the line
5844 .code
5845 begin routers
5846 .endd
5847 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5848 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5849 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5850 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5851 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5852 .code
5853 # domain_literal:
5854 # driver = ipliteral
5855 # domains = !+local_domains
5856 # transport = remote_smtp
5857 .endd
5858 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5859 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5860 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5861 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5862 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5863 .code
5864 dnslookup:
5865 driver = dnslookup
5866 domains = ! +local_domains
5867 transport = remote_smtp
5868 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5869 no_more
5870 .endd
5871 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5872 domains. This is specified by the line
5873 .code
5874 domains = ! +local_domains
5875 .endd
5876 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5877 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5878 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5879 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5880 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5881 passed on to the following routers.
5882
5883 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5884 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5885 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5886 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5887 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5888
5889 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5890 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5891 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5892 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5893 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5894 the address fails and is bounced.
5895
5896 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5897 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5898 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5899 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5900 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5901 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5902 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5903 out.
5904 .code
5905 system_aliases:
5906 driver = redirect
5907 allow_fail
5908 allow_defer
5909 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5910 # user = exim
5911 file_transport = address_file
5912 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5913 .endd
5914 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5915 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5916 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5917 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5918 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5919 the next router.
5920
5921 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5922 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5923 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5924 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5925 .code
5926 userforward:
5927 driver = redirect
5928 check_local_user
5929 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5930 # local_part_suffix_optional
5931 file = $home/.forward
5932 # allow_filter
5933 no_verify
5934 no_expn
5935 check_ancestor
5936 file_transport = address_file
5937 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5938 reply_transport = address_reply
5939 .endd
5940 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5941 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5942 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5943 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5944 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5945 namely:
5946 .code
5947 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5948 # local_part_suffix_optional
5949 .endd
5950 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5951 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5952 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5953 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5954 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5955 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5956 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5957
5958 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5959 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5960 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5961 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5962
5963 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5964 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5965 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5966 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5967 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5968 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5969 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5970
5971 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5972 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5973 There are two reasons for doing this:
5974
5975 .olist
5976 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5977 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5978 unnecessary work.
5979 .next
5980 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5981 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5982 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5983 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5984 this time.
5985 .endlist
5986
5987 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5988 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5989 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5990 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5991
5992 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5993 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5994 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5995 .code
5996 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5997 .endd
5998 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5999 transport.
6000 .code
6001 localuser:
6002 driver = accept
6003 check_local_user
6004 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6005 # local_part_suffix_optional
6006 transport = local_delivery
6007 .endd
6008 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6009 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6010 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6011 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6012 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6013
6014
6015 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6016 .cindex "default" "transports"
6017 .cindex "transports" "default"
6018 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6019 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6020 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6021 .code
6022 begin transports
6023 .endd
6024 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6025 .code
6026 remote_smtp:
6027 driver = smtp
6028 hosts_try_prdr = *
6029 .endd
6030 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6031 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6032 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6033 It is negotiated between client and server
6034 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6035 All other options are defaulted.
6036 .code
6037 local_delivery:
6038 driver = appendfile
6039 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6040 delivery_date_add
6041 envelope_to_add
6042 return_path_add
6043 # group = mail
6044 # mode = 0660
6045 .endd
6046 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6047 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6048 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6049 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6050 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6051 show how this can be done.
6052
6053 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6054 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6055 similarly-named options above.
6056 .code
6057 address_pipe:
6058 driver = pipe
6059 return_output
6060 .endd
6061 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6062 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6063 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6064 be returned to the sender.
6065 .code
6066 address_file:
6067 driver = appendfile
6068 delivery_date_add
6069 envelope_to_add
6070 return_path_add
6071 .endd
6072 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6073 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6074 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6075 .code
6076 address_reply:
6077 driver = autoreply
6078 .endd
6079 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6080 filter files.
6081
6082
6083
6084 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6085 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6086 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6087 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6088 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6089 introduced by the line
6090 .code
6091 begin retry
6092 .endd
6093 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6094 errors:
6095 .code
6096 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6097 .endd
6098 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6099 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6100 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6101 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6102
6103 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6104 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6105 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6106
6107
6108 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6109 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6110 .code
6111 begin rewrite
6112 .endd
6113 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6114 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6115
6116
6117
6118 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6119 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6120 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6121 .code
6122 begin authenticators
6123 .endd
6124 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6125 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6126 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6127 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6128 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6129 to support most MUA software.
6130
6131 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6132 .code
6133 #PLAIN:
6134 # driver = plaintext
6135 # server_set_id = $auth2
6136 # server_prompts = :
6137 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6138 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6139 .endd
6140 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6141 .code
6142 #LOGIN:
6143 # driver = plaintext
6144 # server_set_id = $auth1
6145 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6146 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6147 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6148 .endd
6149
6150 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6151 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6152 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6153 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6154 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6155 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6156 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6157 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6158
6159 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6160 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6161 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6162 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6163
6164 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6165 usercode and password are in different positions.
6166 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6167
6168 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6169
6170
6171
6172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6174
6175 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6176
6177 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6178 .cindex "PCRE"
6179 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6180 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6181 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6182 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6183 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6184 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6185
6186 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6187 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6188 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6189 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6190 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6191 case-insensitive.
6192
6193 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6194 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6195 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6196 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6197 .code
6198 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6199 .endd
6200 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6201 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6202 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6203 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6204 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6205 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6206 matched.
6207
6208 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6209 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6210 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6211 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6212 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6213 match anywhere in the subject string.
6214
6215 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6216 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6217 .code
6218 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6219 .endd
6220 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6221 You need to use:
6222 .code
6223 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6224 .endd
6225 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6226 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6227
6228
6229
6230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6232
6233 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6234 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6235 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6236 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6237 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6238 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6239
6240 .olist
6241 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6242 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6243 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6244 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6245 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6246 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6247 .next
6248 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6249 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6250 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6251 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6252 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6253 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6254 .endlist
6255
6256 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6257 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6258 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6259 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6260 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6261 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6262
6263 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6264 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6265 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6266 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6267 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6268 .code
6269 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6270 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6271 .endd
6272 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6273 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6274 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6275 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6276 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6277 .code
6278 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6279 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6280 .endd
6281 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6282 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6283
6284 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6285 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6286 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6287 .code
6288 domain1:
6289 domain2:
6290 .endd
6291 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6292 matches the list item.
6293
6294 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6295 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6296 .code
6297 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6298 .endd
6299 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6300 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6301 causes a second lookup to occur.
6302
6303 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6304 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6305 lookup is permitted.
6306
6307
6308 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6309 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6310 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6311 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6312
6313 .ilist
6314 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6315 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6316 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6317 .next
6318 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6319 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6320 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6321 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6322 .endlist
6323
6324 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6325 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6326 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6327 .code
6328 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6329 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6330 .endd
6331 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6332 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6333 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6334
6335
6336
6337
6338 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6339 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6340 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6341 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6342
6343 .ilist
6344 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6345 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6346 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6347 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6348 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6349 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6350 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6351 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6352 be found in several places:
6353 .display
6354 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6355 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6356 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6357 .endd
6358 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6359 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6360 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6361 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6362 .next
6363 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6364 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6365 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6366 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6367 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6368 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6369 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6370
6371 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6372 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6373 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6374 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6375 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6376 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6377 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6378 .next
6379 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6380 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6381 .cindex "sasldb2"
6382 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6383 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6384 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6385 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6386 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6387 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6388 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6389 .next
6390 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6391 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6392 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6393 .cindex "Courier"
6394 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6395 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6396 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6397 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6398 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6399 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6400 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6401 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6402 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6403 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6404 .next
6405 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6406 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6407 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6408 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6409 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6410 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6411 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6412 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6413 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6414 .next
6415 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6416 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6417 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6418 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6419 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6420 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6421 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6422 .code
6423 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6424 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6425 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6426 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6427 .endd
6428 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6429 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6430 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6431 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6432 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6433
6434 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6435 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6436 lookup types support only literal keys.
6437
6438 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6439 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6440 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6441 .next
6442 .cindex "linear search"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6444 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6445 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6446 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6447 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6448 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6449 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6450 in the file is used.
6451
6452 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6453 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6454 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6455 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6456 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6457 colon, for example:
6458 .code
6459 baduser: :fail:
6460 .endd
6461 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6462 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6463 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6464 wildcarding of any kind.
6465
6466 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6467 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6468 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6469 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6470 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6471 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6472 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6473 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6474 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6475
6476 .next
6477 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6478 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6479 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6480 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6481 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6482 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6483 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6484 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6485
6486 .next
6487 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6488 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6489 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6490 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6491 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6492 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6493 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6494 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6495 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6496
6497 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6498 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6499 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6500 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6501
6502 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6503 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6504
6505 .olist
6506 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6507 .code
6508 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6509 *fish data for anythingfish
6510 .endd
6511 .next
6512 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6513 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6514 .code
6515 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6516 .endd
6517 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6518 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6519 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6520 .code
6521 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6522 .endd
6523 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6524 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6525 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6526 .code
6527 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6528 .endd
6529
6530 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6531 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6532 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6533 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6534 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6535
6536 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6537 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6538 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6539 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6540 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6541
6542 .next
6543 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6544 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6545 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6546 example:
6547 .code
6548 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6549 .endd
6550 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6551 .endlist olist
6552
6553 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6554 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6555 be followed by optional colons.
6556
6557 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6558 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6559 lookup types support only literal keys.
6560 .endlist ilist
6561
6562
6563 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6564 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6565 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6566 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6567 many of them are given in later sections.
6568
6569 .ilist
6570 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6571 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6572 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6573 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6574 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6575 .next
6576 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6578 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6579 .next
6580 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6581 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6582 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6583 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6584 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6585 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6586 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6587 .next
6588 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6589 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6590 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6591 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6592 .next
6593 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6594 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6595 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6596 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6597 .next
6598 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6599 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6600 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6601 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6602 .next
6603 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6604 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6605 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6606 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6607 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6608 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6609 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6610 password value. For example:
6611 .code
6612 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6613 .endd
6614 .next
6615 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6616 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6617 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6618 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6619
6620 .next
6621 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6623 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6624 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6625
6626 .next
6627 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6628 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6629 .next
6630 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6631 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6632 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6633 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6634 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6635 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6636 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6637 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6638 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6639 .code
6640 require condition = \
6641 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6642 .endd
6643 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6644 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6645 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6646 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6647 .endlist
6648
6649
6650
6651 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6652 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6653 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6654 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6655 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6656 options such as a list of local domains.
6657
6658 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6659 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6660 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6661 or may give up altogether.
6662
6663
6664
6665 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6666 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6670 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6671 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6672 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6673
6674 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6675 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6676 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6677
6678 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6679 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6680 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6681
6682 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6683 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6684 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6685 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6686 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6687 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6688 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6689 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6690 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6691 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6692 .code
6693 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6694 .endd
6695 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6696 looks up these keys, in this order:
6697 .code
6698 jane@eyre.example
6699 *@eyre.example
6700 *
6701 .endd
6702 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6703 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6704 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6705 Exim move on to try the next key.
6706
6707
6708
6709 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6710 .cindex "partial matching"
6711 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6712 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6714 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6715 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6716 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6717 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6718 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6719 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6720 a key in a DBM file is
6721 .code
6722 *.dates.fict.example
6723 .endd
6724 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6725 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6726 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6727 file.
6728
6729 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6730 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6731 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6732
6733 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6734 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6735 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6736 partial matching keys
6737 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6738 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6739 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6740
6741 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6742 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6743 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6744 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6745 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6746 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6747 remains.
6748
6749 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6750 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6751 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6752 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6753 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6754 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6755 .code
6756 2250.dates.fict.example
6757 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6758 *.dates.fict.example
6759 *.fict.example
6760 .endd
6761 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6762 finishes.
6763
6764 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6765 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6766 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6767 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6768 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6769 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6770 .code
6771 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6772 .endd
6773 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6774 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6775 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6776 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6777 .code
6778 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6779 .endd
6780 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6781 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6782
6783 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6784 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6785 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6786
6787 .ilist
6788 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6789 .next
6790 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6791 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6792 .next
6793 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6794 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6795 for &"*"& on its own.
6796 .next
6797 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6798 .endlist
6799
6800
6801 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6802 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6803 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6804 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6805 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6806 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6807 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6808
6809 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6810 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6811 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6812 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6813 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6814
6815
6816
6817
6818 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6819 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6820 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6821 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6822 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6823 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6824 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6825
6826 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6827 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6828 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6829 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6830 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6831 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6832
6833 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6834 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6835 complete.
6836
6837
6838
6839
6840 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6842 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6843 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6844 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6845 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6846 .code
6847 [name=$local_part]
6848 .endd
6849 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6850 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6851 .code
6852 [name="$local_part"]
6853 .endd
6854 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6855 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6856 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6857 of the following form is provided:
6858 .code
6859 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6860 .endd
6861 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6862 .code
6863 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6864 .endd
6865 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6866 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6867 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6868
6869
6870
6871
6872 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6873 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6874 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6875 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6876 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6877 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6878 an expansion string could contain:
6879 .code
6880 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6881 .endd
6882 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6883 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6884 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6885 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6886
6887 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6888 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6889 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6890
6891 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6892 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6893 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6894 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6895 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6896 .code
6897 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6898 .endd
6899 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6900 white space is ignored.
6901 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6902 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6903 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6904
6905 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6906 When the type is PTR,
6907 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6908 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6909 .code
6910 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6911 .endd
6912 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6913 altered and nothing is added.
6914
6915 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6916 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6918 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6919 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6920 The field separator can be modified as above.
6921
6922 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6923 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6925 unless a field separator is specified.
6926 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6927 For SPF records the
6928 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6929 .code
6930 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6931 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6932 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6933 .endd
6934 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6935 white space is ignored.
6936
6937 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6938 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6939 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6940 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6941 specified.
6942 .code
6943 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6944 .endd
6945
6946 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6947 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6948 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6949 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6950 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6951 each followed by a comma,
6952 that may appear before the record type.
6953
6954 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6955 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6956 a defer-option modifier.
6957 The possible keywords are
6958 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6959 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6960 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6961 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6962 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6963 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6964 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6965 .code
6966 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6967 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6968 .endd
6969 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6970 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6971
6972 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6973 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6974 The possible keywords are
6975 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6976 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6977 with the lookup.
6978 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6979 is not labelled as authenticated data
6980 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6981 The default is &"never"&.
6982
6983 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6984
6985 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6986 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6987 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6988 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6989 (e.g. &"5s"&).
6990 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6991
6992 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6993 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6994 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6995
6996 .new
6997 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
6998 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
6999 .cindex DNS TTL
7000 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7001 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7002 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7003 .wen
7004
7005
7006 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7007 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7008 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7009 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7010 the pseudo-type MXH:
7011 .code
7012 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7013 .endd
7014 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7015 returned.
7016
7017 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7018 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7019 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7020 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7021 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7022 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7023 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7024 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7025 .code
7026 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7027 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7028 .endd
7029 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7030 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7031 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7032
7033 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7034 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7035 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7036 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7037 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7038 such a list.
7039
7040 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7041 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7042 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7043 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7044 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7045 result of a successful lookup such as:
7046 .code
7047 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7048 .endd
7049 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7050 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7051 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7052
7053 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7054 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7055 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7056 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7057 .code
7058 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7059 .endd
7060
7061
7062 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7063 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7064 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7065 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7066 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7067 .code
7068 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7069 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7071 .endd
7072 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7073 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7074 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7075 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7076
7077 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7078 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7079 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7080
7081
7082
7083
7084 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7085 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7086 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7087 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7088 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7089 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7090 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7091 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7092 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7093 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7094 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7095 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7096 .code
7097 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7098 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7099 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7100 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7101 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7102 .endd
7103 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7104 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7105
7106 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7107 the way they handle the results of a query:
7108
7109 .ilist
7110 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7111 gives an error.
7112 .next
7113 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7114 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7115 .next
7116 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7117 from all of them are returned.
7118 .endlist
7119
7120
7121 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7122 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7123 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7124 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7125
7126
7127 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7128 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7129 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7130 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7131 .code
7132 data = ${lookup ldap \
7133 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7134 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7135 .endd
7136 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7137 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7138 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7139 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7140
7141 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7142 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7143 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7144
7145 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7146 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7147 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7148 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7149 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7150 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7151 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7152 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7153 &_exim.conf_&.
7154
7155
7156 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7157 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7158 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7159 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7160 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7161 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7162
7163 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7164 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7165 the string:
7166 .code
7167 * => \2A
7168 ( => \28
7169 ) => \29
7170 \ => \5C
7171 .endd
7172 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7173 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7174 .code
7175 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7176 .endd
7177 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7178 .code
7179 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7180 .endd
7181 yields
7182 .code
7183 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7184 .endd
7185 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7186 .code
7187 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7188 .endd
7189 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7190 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7191 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7192 .code
7193 , + " \ < > ;
7194 .endd
7195 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7196 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7197 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7198 .code
7199 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7200 .endd
7201 yields
7202 .code
7203 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7204 .endd
7205 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7206 .code
7207 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7208 .endd
7209 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7210 authentication below.
7211
7212
7213 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7214 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7215 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7216 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7217 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7218 by starting it with
7219 .code
7220 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7221 .endd
7222 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7223 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7224 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7225 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7226 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7227 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7228 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7229 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7230 failures, and timeouts.
7231
7232 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7233 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7234 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7235 doubled. For example
7236 .code
7237 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7238 .endd
7239 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7240 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7241 the local host) is used.
7242
7243 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7244 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7245 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7246 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7247 not available.
7248
7249 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7250 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7251 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7252 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7253 .code
7254 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7255 .endd
7256 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7257 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7258 .code
7259 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7260 .endd
7261 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7262 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7263 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7264 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7265 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7266 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7267 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7268 backup host.
7269
7270 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7271 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7272 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7273
7274 .ilist
7275 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7276 interface.
7277 .next
7278 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7279 .endlist
7280
7281
7282 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7283 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7284
7285
7286
7287 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7288 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7289 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7290 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7291 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7292 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7293 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7294 them. The following names are recognized:
7295 .display
7296 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7297 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7298 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7299 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7300 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7301 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7302 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7303 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7304 .endd
7305 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7306 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7307 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7308 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7309
7310 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7311 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7312 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7313 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7314 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7315 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7316 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7317 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7318 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7319
7320 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7321 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7322
7323 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7324 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7325 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7326 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7327 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7328 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7329 alternate list (colon-separated).
7330
7331 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7332 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7333 .code
7334 ${lookup ldap
7335 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7336 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7337 {$value}fail}
7338 .endd
7339 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7340 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7341 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7342 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7343
7344 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7345 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7346 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7347
7348 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7349 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7350 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7351 quoting has two advantages:
7352
7353 .ilist
7354 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7355 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7356 .next
7357 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7358 .endlist
7359
7360 For example, a setting such as
7361 .code
7362 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7363 .endd
7364 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7365
7366 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7367 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7368 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7369 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7370 .code
7371 PASS=${quote:$3}
7372 .endd
7373 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7374 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7375 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7376
7377
7378
7379 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7380 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7381 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7382 as a sequence of values, for example
7383 .code
7384 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7385 .endd
7386 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7387 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7388 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7389 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7390 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7391 directory.
7392
7393 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7394 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7395 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7396
7397 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7398 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7399 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7400 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7401 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7402 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7403 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7404 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7405 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7406
7407 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7408 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7409 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7410 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7411 .code
7412 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7413 value1.1,value1,,2
7414
7415 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7416 value two
7417
7418 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7419 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7420
7421 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7422 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7423 .endd
7424 You can
7425 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7426 results of LDAP lookups.
7427 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7428 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7429 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7430 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7431 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7432 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7433
7434
7435
7436
7437 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7438 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7439 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7440 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7441 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7442 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7443 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7444 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7445 .code
7446 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7447 .endd
7448 might return the string
7449 .code
7450 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7451 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7452 .endd
7453 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7454 .code
7455 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7456 .endd
7457 would just return
7458 .code
7459 Martin Guerre
7460 .endd
7461 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7462 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7463 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7464
7465
7466
7467 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7468 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7469 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7470 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7471 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7472 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7473 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7475 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7476 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7477 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7478 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7479 might be
7480 .code
7481 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7482 {$value}fail}
7483 .endd
7484 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7485 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7486 .code
7487 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7488 {$value}}
7489 .endd
7490 might be
7491 .code
7492 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7493 .endd
7494 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7495 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7496 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7497 .code
7498 Mister X
7499 .endd
7500 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7501 with a newline between the data for each row.
7502
7503
7504 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7505 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7506 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7507 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7508 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7509 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7510 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7511 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7512 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7513 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7514 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7515 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7516 information.
7517 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7518 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7519 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7520 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7521 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7522 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7523 .code
7524 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7525 .endd
7526 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7527 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7528 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7529 .code
7530 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7531 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7532 .endd
7533 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7534 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7535 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7536 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7537 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7538 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7539
7540 .new
7541 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7542 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7543 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7544 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7545 .wen
7546
7547 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7548 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7549 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7550 done by starting the query with
7551 .display
7552 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7553 .endd
7554 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7555 .olist
7556 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7557 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7558 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7559 taken from there.
7560 .next
7561 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7562 .endlist
7563 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7564 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7565 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7566
7567 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7568 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7569 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7570 like this:
7571 .code
7572 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7573 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7574 master/db/name/pw
7575 .endd
7576 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7577 .code
7578 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7579 .endd
7580 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7581 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7582 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7583 .code
7584 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7585 .endd
7586
7587
7588 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7589 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7590 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7591 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7592 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7593 .display
7594 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7595 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7596 .endd
7597 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7598 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7599
7600 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7601 the queries.
7602
7603 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7604 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7605
7606 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7607 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7608 is zero because no rows are affected.
7609
7610
7611 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7612 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7613 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7614 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7615 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7616 looks like this:
7617 .code
7618 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7619 .endd
7620 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7621 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7622 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7623
7624 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7625 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7626 affected.
7627
7628 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7629 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7630 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7631 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7632 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7633 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7634 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7635 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7636 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7637 .code
7638 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7639 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7640 .endd
7641 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7642 .code
7643 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7644 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7645 .endd
7646 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7647 quote, which it doubles.
7648
7649 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7650 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7651 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7652 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7653 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7654 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7655 option.
7656 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7657 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7658
7659
7660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7662
7663 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7664 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7665 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7666 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7667 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7668 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7669 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7670 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7671 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7672
7673 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7674 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7675 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7676 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7677
7678 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7679 support all the complexity available in
7680 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7681
7682
7683
7684 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7685 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7686 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7687 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7688 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7689 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7690 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7691 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7692
7693
7694 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7695 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7696 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7697
7698 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7699 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7700 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7701 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7702 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7703 .code
7704 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7705 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7706 .endd
7707 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7708 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7709 senders based on the receiving domain.
7710
7711
7712
7713
7714 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7715 .cindex "list" "negation"
7716 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7717 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7718 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7719 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7720 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7721 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7722
7723 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7724 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7725 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7726 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7727 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7728 .code
7729 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7730 .endd
7731 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7732 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7733 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7734 .code
7735 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7736 .endd
7737 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7738 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7739 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7740
7741 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7742 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7743 item.
7744
7745
7746
7747 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7748 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7749 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7750 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7751 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7752 file names are not allowed,
7753 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7754 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7755 lines:
7756
7757 .ilist
7758 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7759 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7760 .next
7761 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7762 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7763 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7764 .code
7765 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7766 .endd
7767 .endlist
7768
7769 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7770 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7771 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7772 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7773
7774 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7775 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7776 .code
7777 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7778 .endd
7779 and the file contains the lines
7780 .code
7781 !a.b.c
7782 *.b.c
7783 .endd
7784 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7785 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7786
7787
7788
7789 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7790 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7791 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7792 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7793 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7794 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7795 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7796 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7797
7798 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7799 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7800 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7801 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7802
7803
7804
7805
7806 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7807 .cindex "named lists"
7808 .cindex "list" "named"
7809 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7810 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7811 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7812 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7813 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7814 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7815 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7816 .code
7817 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7818 .endd
7819 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7820 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7821 configured with the line
7822 .code
7823 domains = +local_domains
7824 .endd
7825 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7826 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7827 .code
7828 dnslookup:
7829 driver = dnslookup
7830 domains = ! +local_domains
7831 transport = remote_smtp
7832 no_more
7833 .endd
7834 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7835 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7836 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7837 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7838 .code
7839 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7840 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7841 .endd
7842 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7843 .code
7844 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7845 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7846 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7847 .endd
7848 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7849 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7850 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7851 .code
7852 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7853 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7854 .endd
7855 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7856 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7857 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7858 .code
7859 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7860 .endd
7861 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7862 referenced lists if you can.
7863
7864 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7865 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7866 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7867 .code
7868 domains = +local_domains
7869 .endd
7870 on several of your routers
7871 or in several ACL statements,
7872 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7873 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7874 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7875 the same each time they are referenced.
7876
7877 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7878 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7879 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7880 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7881
7882
7883
7884 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7885 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7886 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7887 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7888 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7889 write
7890 .code
7891 ALIST = host1 : host2
7892 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7893 .endd
7894 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7895 .code
7896 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7897 .endd
7898 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7899 list, and write
7900 .code
7901 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7902 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7903 .endd
7904 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7905 .code
7906 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7907 .endd
7908
7909
7910 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7911 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7912 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7913 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7914 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7915 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7916 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7917 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7918 message. For example:
7919 .code
7920 domainlist special_domains = \
7921 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7922 .endd
7923 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7924 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7925 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7926 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7927 same list each time.
7928
7929 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7930 cache the result anyway. For example:
7931 .code
7932 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7933 .endd
7934 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7935 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7936
7937
7938
7939 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7940 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7941 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7942 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7943 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7944
7945 .ilist
7946 .cindex "primary host name"
7947 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7948 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7949 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7950 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7951 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7952 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7953 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7954 differ only in their names.
7955 .next
7956 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7957 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7958 .cindex "domain literal"
7959 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7960 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7961 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7962 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7963 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7964 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7965 .next
7966 .cindex "@mx_any"
7967 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7968 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7969 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7970 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7971 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7972 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7973 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7974 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7975 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7976 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7977 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7978
7979 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7980 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7981 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7982 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7983 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7984
7985 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7986 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7987 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7988 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7989 on a router). For example:
7990 .code
7991 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7992 .endd
7993 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7994 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7995
7996 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7997 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7998 contain negative items.
7999
8000 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8001 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8002 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8003 .code
8004 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8005 an.other.domain : ...
8006 .endd
8007 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8008 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8009 .code
8010 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8011 an.other.domain ? ...
8012 .endd
8013 .next
8014 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8015 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8016 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8017 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8018 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8019 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8020 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8021 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8022 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8023 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8024
8025 .next
8026 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8027 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8028 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8029 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8030 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8031 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8032 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8033 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8034 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8035
8036 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8037 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8038 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8039 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8040 expression by expansion, of course).
8041 .next
8042 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8043 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8044 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8045 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8046 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8047 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8048 .code
8049 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8050 .endd
8051 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8052 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8053 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8054 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8055 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8056 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8057 other statements in the same ACL.
8058
8059 .next
8060 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8061 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8062 .code
8063 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8064 .endd
8065 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8066 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8067
8068 .next
8069 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8070 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8071 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8072 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8073 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8074 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8075 expansion variable.
8076 .next
8077 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8078 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8079 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8080 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8081 .code
8082 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8083 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8084 .endd
8085 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8086 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8087 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8088 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8089 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8090 .next
8091 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8092 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8093 between the pattern and the domain.
8094 .endlist
8095
8096 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8097 .code
8098 domainlist funny_domains = \
8099 @ : \
8100 lib.unseen.edu : \
8101 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8102 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8103 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8104 nis;domains.byname : \
8105 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8106 .endd
8107 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8108 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8109 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8110 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8111 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8112 patterns earlier.
8113
8114
8115
8116 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8117 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8118 .cindex "list" "host list"
8119 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8120 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8121 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8122 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8123 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8124 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8125 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8126
8127
8128 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8129 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8130 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8131 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8132 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8133 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8134 not used.
8135
8136 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8137 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8138 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8139
8140
8141
8142 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8143 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8144 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8145 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8146 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8147 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8148 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8149 concerns.)
8150
8151 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8152 inspecting its IP address:
8153
8154 .ilist
8155 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8156 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8157 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8158 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8159 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8160 with the IP address of the subject host.
8161
8162 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8163 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8164 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8165 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8166 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8167
8168 .next
8169 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8170 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8171 domain name, as just described.
8172
8173 .next
8174 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8175 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8176 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8177 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8178 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8179 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8180 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8181 that can never match a client host.
8182
8183 .next
8184 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8185 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8186 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8187 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8188 .code
8189 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8190 accept hosts = @[]
8191 .endd
8192 .next
8193 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8194 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8195 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8196 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8197 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8198 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8199 significant end of the address.
8200
8201 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8202 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8203 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8204 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8205 .code
8206 192.168.23.236/31
8207 .endd
8208 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8209 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8210 matches.
8211
8212 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8213 .code
8214 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8215 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8216 .endd
8217 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8218 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8219 For example:
8220 .code
8221 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8222 .endd
8223 could make use of a file containing
8224 .code
8225 172.16.0.0/12
8226 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8227 .endd
8228 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8229 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8230 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8231 .code
8232 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8233 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8234 .endd
8235 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8236 list.
8237 .endlist
8238
8239
8240
8241 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8242 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8243 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8244 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8245 address, the pattern takes this form:
8246 .display
8247 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8248 .endd
8249 For example:
8250 .code
8251 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8252 .endd
8253 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8254 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8255 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8256 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8257 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8258 returned by the lookup is not used.
8259
8260 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8261 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8262 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8263 patterns of this form:
8264 .display
8265 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8266 .endd
8267 For example:
8268 .code
8269 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8270 .endd
8271 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8272 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8273 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8274 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8275 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8276
8277 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8278 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8279 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8280 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8281 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8282 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8283 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8284 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8285 addresses are always used.
8286
8287 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8288 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8289 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8290 configurations.
8291
8292 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8293 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8294 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8295 case the IP address is used on its own.
8296
8297
8298
8299 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8300 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8301 .cindex "unknown host name"
8302 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8303 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8304 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8305 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8306 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8307 above.)
8308
8309 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8310 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8311 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8312 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8313 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8314 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8315 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8316
8317 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8318 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8319
8320 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8321 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8322 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8323 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8324 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8325 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8326 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8327 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8328 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8329
8330 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8331 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8332
8333 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8334 .cindex "alias for host"
8335 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8336 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8337
8338 .ilist
8339 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8340 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8341 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8342 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8343 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8344 expression.
8345 .next
8346 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8347 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8348 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8349 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8350 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8351 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8352 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8353 example,
8354 .code
8355 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8356 .endd
8357 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8358 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8359 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8360 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8361 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8362 .code
8363 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8364 .endd
8365 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8366 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8367 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8368 required.
8369 .endlist
8370
8371
8372
8373
8374 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8375 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8376 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8377 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8378 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8379 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8380
8381 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8382 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8383
8384 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8385 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8386 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8387 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8388 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8389 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8390 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8391 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8392 not recognized in an indirected file).
8393
8394 .ilist
8395 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8396 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8397 .code
8398 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8399 .endd
8400 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8401 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8402
8403 .next
8404 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8405 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8406 example:
8407 .code
8408 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8409 192.168.4.5
8410 .endd
8411 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8412 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8413 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8414 .endlist
8415
8416 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8417 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8418 list.
8419
8420 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8421 "SECTmixwilhos"
8422 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8423
8424 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8425 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8426 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8427
8428 .ilist
8429 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8430 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8431 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8432 .code
8433 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8434 .endd
8435 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8436 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8437 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8438 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8439 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8440 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8441 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8442
8443 .next
8444 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8445 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8446 .code
8447 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8448 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8449 .endd
8450 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8451 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8452 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8453 this section.
8454 .endlist
8455
8456
8457 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8458 "SECTtemdnserr"
8459 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8460 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8461 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8462 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8463 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8464 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8465 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8466 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8467 host lists such as whitelists.
8468
8469
8470
8471 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8472 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8473 .cindex "unknown host name"
8474 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8475 If a pattern is of the form
8476 .display
8477 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8478 .endd
8479 for example
8480 .code
8481 dbm;/host/accept/list
8482 .endd
8483 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8484 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8485 is not used.
8486
8487 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8488 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8489 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8490 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8491 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8492 lookup, both using the same file.
8493
8494
8495
8496 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8497 If a pattern is of the form
8498 .display
8499 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8500 .endd
8501 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8502 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8503 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8504 .code
8505 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8506 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8507 .endd
8508 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8509 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8510 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8511 operator.
8512
8513 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8514 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8515 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8516
8517 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8518 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8519 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8520 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8521 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8522 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8523
8524
8525
8526
8527
8528 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8529 .cindex "list" "address list"
8530 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8531 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8532 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8533 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8534 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8535 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8536 using this option setting:
8537 .code
8538 senders = :
8539 .endd
8540 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8541 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8542 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8543 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8544
8545 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8546 example:
8547 .code
8548 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8549 .endd
8550 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8551 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8552 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8553 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8554 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8555 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8556 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8557 .code
8558 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8559 *@+hostile_domains:\
8560 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8561 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8562 .endd
8563 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8564 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8565 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8566 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8567 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8568
8569 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8570 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8571 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8572 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8573 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8574 .code
8575 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8576 .endd
8577
8578 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8579 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8580 senders:
8581
8582 .ilist
8583 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8584 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8585 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8586 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8587 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8588 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8589 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8590 .code
8591 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8592 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8593 .endd
8594 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8595 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8596
8597 .next
8598 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8599 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8600 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8601 example:
8602 .code
8603 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8604 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8605 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8606 .endd
8607 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8608 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8609 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8610 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8611
8612 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8613 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8614 panic log.
8615 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8616 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8617 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8618 default. For example, with this lookup:
8619 .code
8620 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8621 .endd
8622 the file could contains lines like this:
8623 .code
8624 user1@domain1.example
8625 *@domain2.example
8626 .endd
8627 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8628 that are tried is:
8629 .code
8630 nimrod@jaeger.example
8631 *@jaeger.example
8632 *
8633 .endd
8634 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8635 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8636
8637 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8638 .code
8639 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8640 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8641 .endd
8642 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8643 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8644 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8645 .endlist
8646
8647
8648 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8649 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8650 always fails.
8651
8652
8653 .ilist
8654 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8655 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8656 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8657 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8658 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8659 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8660 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8661 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8662 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8663
8664 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8665 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8666 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8667 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8668 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8669 with
8670 .code
8671 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8672 .endd
8673 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8674 .code
8675 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8676 .endd
8677 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8678
8679 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8680 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8681 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8682 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8683 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8684 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8685 .code
8686 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8687 spammer3 : spammer4
8688 .endd
8689 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8690 doubling.
8691
8692 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8693 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8694 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8695 might have entries like
8696 .code
8697 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8698 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8699 *: ^\d{8}$
8700 .endd
8701 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8702 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8703 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8704 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8705
8706 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8707 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8708 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8709
8710 .next
8711 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8712 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8713 can only return a single list of local parts.
8714 .endlist
8715
8716 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8717 in these two examples:
8718 .code
8719 senders = +my_list
8720 senders = *@+my_list
8721 .endd
8722 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8723 example it is a named domain list.
8724
8725
8726
8727
8728 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8729 .cindex "case of local parts"
8730 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8731 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8732 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8733 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8734 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8735 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8736 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8737 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8738 default.
8739
8740 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8741 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8742 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8743 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8744 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8745 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8746 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8747 case-independent.
8748
8749 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8750 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8751 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8752 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8753 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8754 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8755 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8756 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8757
8758
8759
8760 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8761 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8762 .cindex "local part" "list"
8763 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8764 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8765 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8766 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8767 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8768 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8769 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8770 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8771
8772 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8773 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8774 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8775 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8776 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8777 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8778 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8779 types.
8780 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8781
8782
8783
8784
8785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8787
8788 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8789 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8790 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8791 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8792
8793 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8794 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8795 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8796 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8797 escape character, as described in the following section.
8798
8799 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8800 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8801 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8802 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8803 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8804 reasons.
8805
8806
8807
8808 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8809 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8810 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8811 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8812 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8813 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8814 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8815 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8816
8817 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8818 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8819 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8820 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8821 .code
8822 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8823 .endd
8824 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8825 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8826 string.
8827
8828
8829
8830 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8831 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8832 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8833 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8834 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8835 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8836 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8837 encoding.
8838
8839 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8840 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8841 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8842
8843
8844 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8845 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8846 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8847 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8848 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8849 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8850 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8851 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8852 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8853 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8854 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8855 and &%nhash%&.
8856
8857 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8858 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8859 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8860
8861 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8862 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8863 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8864 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8865 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8866 .code
8867 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8868 .endd
8869 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8870 Exim message identifier. For example:
8871 .code
8872 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8873 .endd
8874 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8875 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8876
8877
8878 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8879 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8880 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8881 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8882 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8883 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8884 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8885 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8886 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8887 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8888 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8889 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8890 being expanded.
8891
8892
8893
8894
8895 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8896 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8897 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8898 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8899 white space is significant.
8900
8901 .vlist
8902 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8903 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8904 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8905 .code
8906 $local_part
8907 ${domain}
8908 .endd
8909 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8910 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8911 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8912 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8913 given, the expansion fails.
8914
8915 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8916 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8917 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8918 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8919 .code
8920 ${lc:$local_part}
8921 .endd
8922 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8923 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8924 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8925 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8926 string easier to understand.
8927
8928 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8929 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8930 expansion item below.
8931
8932
8933 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8934 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8935 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8936 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8937 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8938 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8939 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8940 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8941 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8942 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8943 the result of the expansion.
8944 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8945 the expansion result is an empty string.
8946 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8947
8948
8949 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8950 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8951 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8952 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8953 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8954 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8955 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8956 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8957 .display
8958 &`version `&
8959 &`serial_number `&
8960 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8961 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8962 &`notbefore `& time
8963 &`notafter `& time
8964 &`sig_algorithm `&
8965 &`signature `&
8966 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8967 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8968 &`crl_uri `& list
8969 .endd
8970 If the field is found,
8971 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8972 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8973 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8974 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8975
8976 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8977 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8978 extracted is used.
8979
8980 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8981
8982 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8983 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8984 not quite
8985 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8986 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8987 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8988 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8989 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8990 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
8991 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8992 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8993
8994 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8995 take an optional modifier of "int"
8996 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8997 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8998 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8999
9000 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9001 newline-separated by default,
9002 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9003 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9004 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9005
9006 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9007 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9008 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9009 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9010 if so the element tags are omitted.
9011
9012 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9013
9014 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9015 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9016 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9017 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9018 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9019 .code
9020 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9021 .endd
9022 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9023 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9024 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9025
9026 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9027 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9028 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9029 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9030 must have the following type:
9031 .code
9032 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9033 .endd
9034 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9035 function should return one of the following values:
9036
9037 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9038 into the expanded string that is being built.
9039
9040 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9041 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9042
9043 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9044 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9045
9046 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9047
9048 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9049 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9050 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9051
9052
9053 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9054 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9055 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9056 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9057 removed.
9058 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9059 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9060 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9061
9062 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9063 appear, for example:
9064 .code
9065 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9066 .endd
9067 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9068 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9069
9070 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9071 search failure.
9072 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9073 search success.
9074
9075
9076 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9077 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9078 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9079 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9080 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9081 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9082 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9083 form:
9084 .display
9085 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9086 .endd
9087 .vindex "&$value$&"
9088 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9089 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9090 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9091 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9092 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9093 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9094 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9095 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9096 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9097
9098 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9099 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9100 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9101 yield &"2001"&:
9102 .code
9103 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9104 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9105 .endd
9106 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9107 appear, for example:
9108 .code
9109 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9110 .endd
9111 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9112 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9113
9114
9115 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9116 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9117 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9118 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9119 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9120 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9121 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9122 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9123 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9124 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9125 <&'string3'&> as before.
9126
9127 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9128 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9129 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9130 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9131 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9132 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9133 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9134 provided. For example:
9135 .code
9136 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9137 .endd
9138 yields &"42"&, and
9139 .code
9140 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9141 .endd
9142 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9143 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9144
9145
9146 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9147 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9148 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9149 .vindex "&$item$&"
9150 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9151 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9152 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9153 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9154 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9155 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9156 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9157 .code
9158 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9159 .endd
9160 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9161 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9162
9163
9164 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9165 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9166 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9167 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9168 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9169 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9170
9171 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9172 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9173 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9174 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9175 .code
9176 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9177 .endd
9178 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9179 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9180 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9181 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9182 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9183 .code
9184 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9185 .endd
9186 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9187 letters appear. For example:
9188 .display
9189 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9190 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9191 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9192 .endd
9193
9194 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9195 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9196 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9197 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9198 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9199 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9200 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9201 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9202 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9203 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9204 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9205 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9206 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9207 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9208 .code
9209 $header_reply-to:
9210 .endd
9211 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9212 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9213 lines) may be present.
9214
9215 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9216 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9217
9218 .ilist
9219 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9220 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9221 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9222
9223 .next
9224 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9225 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9226 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9227 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9228 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9229 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9230 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9231 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9232
9233 .next
9234 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9235 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9236 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9237 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9238 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9239 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9240 .endlist ilist
9241
9242 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9243 command of the following form:
9244 .code
9245 headers charset "UTF-8"
9246 .endd
9247 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9248 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9249 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9250 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9251 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9252 ISO-8859-1.
9253
9254 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9255 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9256 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9257 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9258
9259 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9260 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9261 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9262 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9263 router or transport are not accessible.
9264
9265 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9266 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9267 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9268 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9269 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9270 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9271
9272 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9273 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9274 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9275 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9276 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9277 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9278 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9279 header.)
9280
9281 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9282 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9283 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9284 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9285 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9286 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9287 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9288 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9289
9290
9291 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9292 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9293 .cindex &%hmac%&
9294 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9295 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9296 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9297 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9298 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9299 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9300 present. For example:
9301 .code
9302 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9303 .endd
9304 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9305 produces:
9306 .code
9307 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9308 .endd
9309 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9310 an Exim configuration:
9311 .code
9312 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9313 .endd
9314 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9315 .code
9316 headers_add = \
9317 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9318 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9319 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9320 .endd
9321 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9322 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9323 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9324 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9325 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9326 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9327
9328
9329 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9330 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9331 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9332 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9333 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9334 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9335 .code
9336 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9337 .endd
9338 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9339 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9340 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9341 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9342 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9343
9344 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9345 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9346 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9347 .code
9348 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9349 .endd
9350 you can use
9351 .code
9352 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9353 .endd
9354
9355 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9356 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9357 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9358 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9359 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9360 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9361 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9362 some of the braces:
9363 .code
9364 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9365 .endd
9366 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9367 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9368 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9369
9370
9371 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9372 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9373 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9374 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9375 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9376 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9377 apart from an optional leading minus,
9378 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9379
9380 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9381 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9382
9383 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9384 If the number is negative, the fields are
9385 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9386 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9387 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9388
9389 If the modulus of the
9390 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9391 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9392
9393 For example:
9394 .code
9395 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9396 .endd
9397 yields &"42"&, and
9398 .code
9399 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9400 .endd
9401 yields &"result: 42"&.
9402
9403 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9404 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9405 extracted is used.
9406 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9407
9408
9409 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9410 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9411 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9412 described in the next item.
9413
9414 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9415 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9416 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9417 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9418 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9419 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9420 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9421 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9422 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9423
9424 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9425 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9426 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9427 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9428 out by the system administrator.
9429
9430 .vindex "&$value$&"
9431 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9432 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9433 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9434 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9435 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9436 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9437 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9438 original lookup fails.
9439
9440 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9441 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9442 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9443 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9444 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9445 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9446 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9447 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9448
9449 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9450 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9451 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9452 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9453
9454 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9455 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9456 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9457 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9458
9459 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9460 .code
9461 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9462 .endd
9463 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9464 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9465 .code
9466 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9467 {$value}fail}
9468 .endd
9469
9470
9471 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9472 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9473 .vindex "&$item$&"
9474 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9475 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9476 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9477 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9478 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9479 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9480 .code
9481 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9482 .endd
9483 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9484 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9485 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9486
9487 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9488 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9489 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9490 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9491 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9492 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9493 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9494 .code
9495 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9496 .endd
9497 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9498 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9499 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9500 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9501 example,
9502 .code
9503 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9504 .endd
9505 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9506
9507
9508
9509 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9510 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9511 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9512 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9513 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9514 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9515 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9516 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9517
9518 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9519 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9520 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9521 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9522 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9523 not its contents.
9524
9525 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9526 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9527 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9528
9529 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9530 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9531
9532
9533 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9534 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9535 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9536 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9537 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9538 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9539 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9540 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9541
9542 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9543 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9544 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9545 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9546 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9547 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9548 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9549 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9550 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9551 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9552
9553 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9554 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9555 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9556 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9557
9558 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9559 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9560 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9561 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9562 is the expansion of the third argument.
9563
9564 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9565 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9566 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9567
9568 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9569 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9570 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9571 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9572 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9573 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9574 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9575 newlines are left in the string.
9576 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9577 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9578 the string expansion fails.
9579
9580 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9581 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9582
9583
9584
9585 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9586 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9587 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9588 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9589 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9590 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9591 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9592 examples:
9593 .code
9594 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9595 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9596 .endd
9597 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9598 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9599 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9600 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9601 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9602 example:
9603 .code
9604 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9605 .endd
9606 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9607 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9608 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9609 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9610 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9611 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9612 .code
9613 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9614 .endd
9615 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9616 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9617 turns them into spaces:
9618 .code
9619 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9620 .endd
9621 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9622 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9623 addition, the following errors can occur:
9624
9625 .ilist
9626 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9627 .next
9628 Failure to connect the socket;
9629 .next
9630 Failure to write the request string;
9631 .next
9632 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9633 .endlist
9634
9635 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9636 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9637 errors occurs. For example:
9638 .code
9639 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9640 {socket failure}}
9641 .endd
9642 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9643 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9644 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9645 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9646 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9647
9648 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9649 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9650
9651
9652 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9653 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9654 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9655 .vindex "&$value$&"
9656 .vindex "&$item$&"
9657 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9658 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9659 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9660 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9661 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9662 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9663 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9664 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9665 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9666 .code
9667 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9668 .endd
9669 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9670 can be found:
9671 .code
9672 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9673 .endd
9674 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9675 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9676 expansion items.
9677
9678 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9679 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9680 expansion item above.
9681
9682 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9683 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9684 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9685 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9686 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9687 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9688 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9689 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9690 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9691
9692 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9693 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9694 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9695 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9696 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9697 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9698 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9699 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9700 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9701 character.
9702
9703 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9704 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9705 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9706 .vindex "&$value$&"
9707 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9708 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9709 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9710 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9711 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9712 &$value$&.
9713
9714 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9715 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9716 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9717 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9718
9719 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9720 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9721 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9722 troubleshoot:
9723 .code
9724 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9725 log_message = Output of id: $value
9726 .endd
9727 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9728 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9729 .code
9730 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9731 .endd
9732
9733 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9734 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9735 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9736 .code
9737 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9738 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9739 ...
9740 endif
9741 .endd
9742 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9743 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9744 commands.
9745
9746 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9747 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9748 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9749 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9750
9751 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9752 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9753
9754
9755 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9756 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9757 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9758 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9759 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9760 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9761 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9762 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9763 .code
9764 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9765 .endd
9766 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9767 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9768 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9769 .code
9770 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9771 .endd
9772 yields &"defabc"&, and
9773 .code
9774 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9775 .endd
9776 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9777 the regular expression from string expansion.
9778
9779
9780
9781 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9782 .cindex sorting "a list"
9783 .cindex list sorting
9784 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9785 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9786 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9787 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9788 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9789 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9790 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9791 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9792 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9793 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9794 to give values for comparison.
9795
9796 The item result is a sorted list,
9797 with the original list separator,
9798 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9799
9800 Examples:
9801 .code
9802 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9803 .endd
9804 sorts a list of numbers, and
9805 .code
9806 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9807 .endd
9808 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9809
9810
9811 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9812 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9813 .cindex "substring extraction"
9814 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9815 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9816 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9817 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9818 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9819 .code
9820 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9821 .endd
9822 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9823 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9824 omitted.
9825
9826 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9827 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9828 length required. For example
9829 .code
9830 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9831 .endd
9832 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9833 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9834 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9835 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9836
9837 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9838 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9839 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9840 .code
9841 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9842 .endd
9843 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9844 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9845 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9846 .code
9847 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9848 .endd
9849 yields an empty string, but
9850 .code
9851 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9852 .endd
9853 yields &"1"&.
9854
9855 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9856 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9857 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9858 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9859 .code
9860 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9861 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9862 .endd
9863 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9864
9865
9866
9867 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9868 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9869 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9870 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9871 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9872 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9873 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9874 replacement list. For example
9875 .code
9876 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9877 .endd
9878 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9879 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9880 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9881 place.
9882 .endlist
9883
9884
9885
9886 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9887 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9888 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9889 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9890 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9891 following operations can be performed:
9892
9893 .vlist
9894 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9895 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9896 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9897 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9898 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9899 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9900
9901
9902 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9903 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9904 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9905 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9906 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9907 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9908 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9909 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9910 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9911
9912 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9913 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9914 character. For example:
9915 .code
9916 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9917 .endd
9918 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9919 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9920 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9921 processing lists.
9922
9923 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9924 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9925 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9926 email address separator. For the example header line:
9927 .code
9928 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9929 .endd
9930 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9931 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9932 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9933 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9934 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9935 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9936 quoted.
9937 .code
9938 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9939 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9940 user@example.com
9941 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9942 Last:user@example.com
9943 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9944 user@example.com
9945 .endd
9946
9947 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9948 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9949 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9950 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9951 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9952 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9953 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9954 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9955 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9956
9957 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9958 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9959 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9960 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9961 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9962 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9963 string.
9964
9965
9966 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9967 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9968 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9969 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9970 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9971
9972
9973 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9975 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9976 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9977 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9978 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9979 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9980
9981
9982 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9983 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9984 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9985 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9986 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9987 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9988 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9989 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9990 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9991 C programming language):
9992 .table2 70pt 300pt
9993 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9994 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9995 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9996 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9997 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9998 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9999 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10000 .endtable
10001 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10002 space is permitted before or after operators.
10003
10004 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10005 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10006 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10007 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10008 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10009
10010 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10011 or 1024*1024*1024,
10012 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10013 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10014
10015 .display
10016 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10017 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10018 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10019 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10020 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10021 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10022 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10023 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10024 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10025 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10026 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10027 .endd
10028
10029 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10030 .code
10031 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10032 condition = \
10033 ${if and { \
10034 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10035 { \
10036 < \
10037 {$recipients_count} \
10038 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10039 } \
10040 }{yes}{no}}
10041 .endd
10042 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10043 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10044
10045
10046 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10047 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10048 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10049 example,
10050 .code
10051 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10052 .endd
10053 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10054 and then re-expands what it has found.
10055
10056
10057 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10058 .cindex "Unicode"
10059 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10060 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10061 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10062 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10063 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10064 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10065 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10066 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10067 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10068
10069 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10070 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10071 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10072 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10073 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10074 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10075 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10076
10077
10078 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10079 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10080 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10081 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10082 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10083 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10084 .code
10085 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10086 .endd
10087 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10088 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10089
10090
10091
10092 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10093 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10094 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10095 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10096 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10097 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10098
10099
10100
10101 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10102 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10103 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10104 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10105 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10106 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10107 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10108
10109
10110 .new
10111 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10112 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10113 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10114 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10115 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10116 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10117 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10118
10119 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10120 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10121 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10122 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10123 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10124 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10125 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10126 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10127 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10128 .wen
10129
10130
10131 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10132 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10133 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10134 .cindex "lower casing"
10135 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10136 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10137 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10138 .code
10139 ${lc:$local_part}
10140 .endd
10141
10142 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10143 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10144 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10145 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10146 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10147 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10148 .code
10149 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10150 .endd
10151 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10152 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10153 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10154
10155
10156 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10157 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10158 .cindex "list" "item count"
10159 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10160 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10161 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10162
10163
10164 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10165 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10166 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10167 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10168 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10169 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10170 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10171 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10172 matching list is returned.
10173
10174
10175 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10176 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10177 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10178 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10179 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10180 empty.
10181
10182
10183 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10184 .cindex "masked IP address"
10185 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10186 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10187 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10188 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10189 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10190 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10191 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10192 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10193 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10194 .code
10195 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10196 .endd
10197 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10198 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10199 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10200 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10201 .code
10202 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10203 .endd
10204 returns the string
10205 .code
10206 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10207 .endd
10208 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10209
10210
10211 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10212 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10213 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10214 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10215 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10216 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10217 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10218
10219
10220 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10221 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10222 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10223 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10224 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10225 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10226 .code
10227 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10228 .endd
10229 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10230
10231
10232 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10233 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10234 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10235 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10236 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10237 is an empty string or
10238 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10239 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10240 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10241 respectively For example,
10242 .code
10243 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10244 .endd
10245 becomes
10246 .code
10247 "ab\"*\"cd"
10248 .endd
10249 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10250 variable or a message header.
10251
10252 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10253 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10254 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10255 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10256 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10257 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10258 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10259
10260
10261 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10262 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10263 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10264 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10265 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10266 .code
10267 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10268 .endd
10269 returns
10270 .code
10271 two%20%5C2A%20two
10272 .endd
10273 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10274 yields an unchanged string.
10275
10276
10277 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10278 .cindex "random number"
10279 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10280 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10281 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10282 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10283 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10284 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10285 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10286 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10287 random().
10288
10289
10290 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10291 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10292 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10293 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10294 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10295 for DNS. For example,
10296 .code
10297 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10298 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10299 .endd
10300 returns
10301 .code
10302 4.2.0.192
10303 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10304 .endd
10305
10306
10307 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10308 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10309 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10310 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10311 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10312 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10313 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10314 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10315 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10316 characters
10317 .code
10318 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10319 .endd
10320 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10321 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10322 characters.
10323
10324
10325 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10326 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10327 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10328 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10329 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10330 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10331 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10332 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10333
10334 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10335 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10336 to use this operator as well.
10337
10338
10339
10340 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10341 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10342 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10343 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10344 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10345 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10346 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10347
10348
10349 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10350 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10351 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10352 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10353 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10354 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10355 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10356
10357
10358 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10359 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10360 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10361 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10362 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10363 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10364 certificate,
10365 and returns
10366 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10367 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10368
10369
10370 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10371 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10372 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10373 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10374 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10375 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10376 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10377 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10378 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10379 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10380 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10381 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10382 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10383
10384 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10385 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10386 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10387
10388 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10389 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10390 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10391 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10392 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10393
10394
10395
10396 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10397 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10398 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10399 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10400 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10401 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10402
10403
10404 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10405 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10406 .cindex "substring extraction"
10407 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10408 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10409 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10410 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10411 .code
10412 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10413 .endd
10414 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10415 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10416
10417 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10418 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10419 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10420 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10421 seconds.
10422
10423 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10424 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10425 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10426 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10427 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10428 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10429 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10430
10431 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10432 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10433 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10434 .cindex "upper casing"
10435 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10436 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10437 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10438
10439 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10440 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10441 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10442 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10443 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10444 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10445 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10446 .endlist
10447
10448
10449
10450
10451
10452
10453 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10454 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10455 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10456 while expanding strings:
10457
10458 .vlist
10459 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10460 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10461 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10462 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10463 condition.
10464
10465 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10466 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10467 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10468 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10469 are:
10470 .display
10471 &`= `& equal
10472 &`== `& equal
10473 &`> `& greater
10474 &`>= `& greater or equal
10475 &`< `& less
10476 &`<= `& less or equal
10477 .endd
10478 For example:
10479 .code
10480 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10481 .endd
10482 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10483 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10484 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10485 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10486 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10487 zero.
10488
10489 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10490 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10491 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10492
10493
10494 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10495 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10496 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10497 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10498 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10499 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10500 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10501 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10502 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10503 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10504 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10505 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10506 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10507 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10508
10509 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10510 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10511 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10512 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10513 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10514 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10515 false if zero.
10516 An empty string is treated as false.
10517 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10518 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10519 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10520
10521 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10522 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10523 For example:
10524 .code
10525 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10526 .endd
10527
10528
10529 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10530 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10531 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10532 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10533 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10534 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10535 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10536 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10537
10538 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10539
10540 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10542 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10543 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10544 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10545 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10546 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10547 included in the binary.
10548
10549 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10550 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10551 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10552 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10553 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10554 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10555 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10556 string in LDAP form is:
10557 .code
10558 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10559 .endd
10560 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10561 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10562 .code
10563 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10564 .endd
10565 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10566 supported:
10567
10568 .ilist
10569 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10570 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10571 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10572 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10573 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10574 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10575 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10576 comparison fails.
10577
10578 .next
10579 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10580 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10581 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10582 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10583 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10584 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10585
10586 .next
10587 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10588 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10589 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10590 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10591 whatever its length.
10592
10593 .next
10594 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10595 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10596 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10597 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10598 .endlist
10599 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10600 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10601 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10602 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10603 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10604 support &[crypt16()]&.
10605
10606 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10607 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10608 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10609 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10610 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10611
10612 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10613 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10614 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10615
10616 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10617 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10618 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10619 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10620 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10621
10622 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10623 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10624 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10625 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10626 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10627 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10628 .code
10629 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10630 .endd
10631 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10632 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10633
10634 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10635 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10636 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10637 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10638 exists in the message. For example,
10639 .code
10640 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10641 .endd
10642 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10643 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10644
10645 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10646 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10647 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10648 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10649 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10650 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10651 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10652 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10653 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10654
10655 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10656 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10657 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10658 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10659 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10660 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10661 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10662 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10663
10664 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10665 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10666 .cindex "first delivery"
10667 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10668 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10669 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10670 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10671
10672
10673 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10674 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10675 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10676 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10677 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10678 .vindex "&$item$&"
10679 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10680 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10681 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10682 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10683 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10684 .ilist
10685 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10686 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10687 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10688 .next
10689 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10690 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10691 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10692 .endlist
10693 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10694 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10695 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10696 list separator is changed to a comma:
10697 .code
10698 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10699 .endd
10700 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10701 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10702
10703 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10704
10705
10706 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10707 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10708 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10709 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10710 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10711 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10712 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10713 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10714 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10715 case-independent.
10716
10717 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10718 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10719 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10720 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10721 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10722 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10723 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10724 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10725 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10726 case-independent.
10727
10728 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10729 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10730 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10731 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10732 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10733 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10734 is true.
10735
10736 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10737 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10738 .code
10739 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10740 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10741 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10742 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10743 .endd
10744
10745 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10746 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10747 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10748 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10749 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10750 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10751 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10752 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10753 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10754 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10755 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10756
10757 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10758 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10759 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10760 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10761 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10762
10763 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10764 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10765 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10766 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10767 .code
10768 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10769 .endd
10770 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10771
10772 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10773 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10774 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10775 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10776 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10777 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10778 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10779 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10780 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10781 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10782 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10783 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10784 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10785 this can be used.
10786
10787
10788 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10789 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10790 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10791 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10792 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10793 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10794 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10795 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10796 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10797 case-independent.
10798
10799 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10800 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10802 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10803 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10804 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10805 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10806 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10807 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10808 case-independent.
10809
10810
10811 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10812 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10813 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10814 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10815 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10816 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10817 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10818 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10819 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10820 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10821 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10822 For example,
10823 .code
10824 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10825 .endd
10826 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10827 backslashes is also required.
10828
10829 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10830 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10831 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10832 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10833 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10834 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10835
10836 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10837 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10838 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10839 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10840 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10841 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10842 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10843 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10844
10845 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10846 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10847 See &*match_local_part*&.
10848
10849 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10850 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10851 See &*match_local_part*&.
10852
10853 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10854 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10855 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10856 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10857 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10858 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10859 .code
10860 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10861 .endd
10862 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10863
10864 .ilist
10865 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10866 .next
10867 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10868 .next
10869 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10870 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10871 in a single test such as
10872 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10873 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10874 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10875 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10876 .code
10877 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10878 .endd
10879 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10880 .next
10881 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10882 .next
10883 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10884 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10885 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10886 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10887 masks. For example:
10888 .code
10889 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10890 .endd
10891 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10892 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10893 address mask, for example:
10894 .code
10895 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10896 .endd
10897 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10898 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10899 .code
10900 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10901 .endd
10902 .endlist ilist
10903
10904 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10905 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10906
10907 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10908
10909 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10910 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10911 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10912 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10913 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10914 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10915 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10916 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10917 example is:
10918 .code
10919 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10920 .endd
10921 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10922 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10923 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10924 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10925 .code
10926 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10927 .endd
10928 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10929 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10930 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10931 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10932 caselessly.
10933
10934 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10935 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10936
10937 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10938 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10939 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10940 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10941
10942 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10943 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10944 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10945 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10946 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10947 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10948 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10949 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10950 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10951 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10952 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10953 .code
10954 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10955 .endd
10956 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10957 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10958
10959 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10960 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10961 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10962 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10963 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10964 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10965 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10966
10967 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10968 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10969 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10970 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10971 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10972 .code
10973 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10974 .endd
10975 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10976 .code
10977 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10978 .endd
10979 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10980 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10981 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10982 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10983 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10984 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10985 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10986 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10987
10988
10989 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10990 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10991 .cindex "Cyrus"
10992 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10993 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10994 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10995 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10996 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10997 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10998
10999 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11000 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11001 building Exim. For example:
11002 .code
11003 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11004 .endd
11005 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11006 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11007 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11008 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11009
11010 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11011 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11012 configuration, you might have this:
11013 .code
11014 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11015 .endd
11016 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11017 .code
11018 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11019 .endd
11020 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11021 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11022 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11023 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11024 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11025 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11026
11027
11028 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11029 .cindex "Radius"
11030 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11031 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11032 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11033 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11034 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11035 support.
11036
11037 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11038 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11039 this library, you need to set
11040 .code
11041 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11042 .endd
11043 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11044 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11045 .code
11046 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11047 .endd
11048 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11049 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11050 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11051
11052 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11053 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11054 the authentication is successful. For example:
11055 .code
11056 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11057 .endd
11058
11059
11060 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11061 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11062 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11063 .cindex "Cyrus"
11064 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11065 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11066 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11067 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11068 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11069 by a process that is not running as root.
11070
11071 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11072 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11073 building Exim. For example:
11074 .code
11075 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11076 .endd
11077 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11078 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11079 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11080
11081 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11082 two are mandatory. For example:
11083 .code
11084 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11085 .endd
11086 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11087 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11088 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11089 .endlist vlist
11090
11091
11092
11093 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11094 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11095 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11096 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11097 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11098 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11099 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11100
11101
11102 .vlist
11103 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11104 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11105 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11106 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11107 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11108 For example,
11109 .code
11110 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11111 .endd
11112 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11113 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11114 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11115
11116 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11117 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11118 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11119 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11120 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11121 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11122 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11123 parsed but not evaluated.
11124 .endlist
11125 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11126
11127
11128
11129
11130 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11131 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11132 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11133 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11134 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11135
11136 .vlist
11137 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11138 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11139 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11140 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11141 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11142 In the expansion condition case
11143 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11144 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11145 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11146 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11147 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11148 matching condition.
11149
11150 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11151 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11152 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11153 any unused variables being made empty.
11154
11155 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11156 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11157 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11158 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11159 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11160 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11161 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11162 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11163 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11164 during subsequent delivery.
11165
11166 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11167 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11168 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11169 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11170 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11171 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11172 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11173 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11174 delivery.
11175
11176 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11177 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11178 this variable has the number of arguments.
11179
11180 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11181 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11182 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11183 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11184 be preserved by coding like this:
11185 .code
11186 warn !verify = sender
11187 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11188 .endd
11189 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11190 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11191 failure.
11192
11193 .vitem &$address_data$&
11194 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11195 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11196 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11197 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11198 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11199 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11200 user filter files.
11201
11202 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11203 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11204 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11205 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11206 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11207 from the child's routing.
11208
11209 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11210 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11211 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11212 address.
11213
11214 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11215 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11216 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11217
11218 .vitem &$address_file$&
11219 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11220 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11221 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11222 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11223 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11224 .code
11225 /home/r2d2/savemail
11226 .endd
11227 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11228 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11229 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11230 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11231 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11232 to the relevant file.
11233
11234 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11235 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11236 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11237 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11238
11239 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11240 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11241 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11242 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11243
11244 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11245 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11246 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11247 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11248 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11249 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11250 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11251 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11252 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11253 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11254 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11255 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11256 command line option.
11257
11258 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11259 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11260 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11261 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11262 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11263 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11264 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11265 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11266 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11267 the ACL's as well.
11268
11269
11270 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11271 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11272 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11273 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11274 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11275 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11276 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11277 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11278 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11279 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11280 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11281
11282 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11283 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11284 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11285 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11286 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11287
11288
11289 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11290 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11291 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11292 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11293 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11294 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11295 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11296 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11297 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11298 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11299 an undefined mechanism.
11300
11301 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11302 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11303 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11304 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11305 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11306 the ACL malware condition.
11307
11308 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11309 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11310 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11311 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11312 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11313 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11314
11315 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11316 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11317 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11318 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11319 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11320 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11321 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11322
11323 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11324 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11325 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11326 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11327 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11328
11329 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11330 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11331 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11332 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11333 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11334
11335 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11336 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11337 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11338 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11339 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11340 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11341 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11342
11343 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11344 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11345 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11346 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11347 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11348 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11349 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11350
11351 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11352 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11353 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11354 address that was connected to.
11355
11356 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11357 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11358 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11359 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11360 compilations of the same version of the program.
11361
11362 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11363 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11364 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11365 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11366 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11367 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11368
11369 .vitem &$config_file$&
11370 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11371 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11372
11373 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11374 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11375 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11376 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11377 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11378
11379 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11380 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11381 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11382 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11383 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11384
11385 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11386 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11387 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11388 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11389 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11390 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11391 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11392 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11393 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11394 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11395 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11396 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11397 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11398 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11399 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11400 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11401 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11402 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11403 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11404 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11405 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11406
11407 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11408 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11409 When a message has been received this variable contains
11410 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11411 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11412
11413 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11414 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11415 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11416 &$dnslist_value$&
11417 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11418 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11419 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11420 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11421 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11422 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11423 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11424 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11425 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11426
11427 .vitem &$domain$&
11428 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11429 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11430 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11431 case for &$domain$&.
11432
11433 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11434 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11435 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11436 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11437
11438 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11439 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11440 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11441 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11442 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11443 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11444
11445 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11446 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11447 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11448
11449 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11450
11451 .ilist
11452 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11453 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11454 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11455 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11456 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11457 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11458 the &(smtp)& transport.
11459
11460 .next
11461 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11462 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11463 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11464 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11465
11466 .next
11467 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11468 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11469 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11470 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11471 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11472 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11473
11474 .next
11475 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11476 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11477 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11478 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11479 .endlist
11480
11481
11482 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11483 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11484 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11485 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11486 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11487 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11488 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11489 used.
11490
11491 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11492 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11493 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11494 to nothing.
11495
11496 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11497 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11498 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11499
11500 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11501 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11502 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11503
11504 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11505 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11506 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11507
11508 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11509 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11510 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11511 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11512 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11513 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11514
11515 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11516 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11517 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11518 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11519 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11520
11521 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11522 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11523 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11524 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11525 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11526
11527 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11528 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11529 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11530 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11531 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11532
11533 .vitem &$home$&
11534 .vindex "&$home$&"
11535 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11536 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11537 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11538 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11539 by a setting on the transport itself.
11540
11541 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11542 of the environment variable HOME.
11543
11544 .vitem &$host$&
11545 .vindex "&$host$&"
11546 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11547 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11548 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11549 to local and remote transports.
11550
11551 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11552 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11553 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11554 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11555 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11556 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11557 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11558 is connected.
11559
11560 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11561 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11562 client is connected.
11563
11564
11565 .vitem &$host_address$&
11566 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11567 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11568 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11569 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11570
11571 .vitem &$host_data$&
11572 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11573 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11574 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11575 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11576 .code
11577 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11578 message = $host_data
11579 .endd
11580 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11581 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11582 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11583 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11584 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11585 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11586 variables is set to &"1"&.
11587
11588 .ilist
11589 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11590 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11591
11592 .next
11593 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11594 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11595 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11596 .endlist ilist
11597
11598 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11599 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11600 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11601 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11602 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11603 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11604 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11605 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11606 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11607 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11608
11609 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11610 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11611 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11612
11613 .vitem &$host_port$&
11614 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11615 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11616 for an outbound connection.
11617
11618
11619 .vitem &$inode$&
11620 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11621 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11622 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11623 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11624 a unique name for the file.
11625
11626 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11627 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11628 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11629
11630 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11631 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11632 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11633
11634 .vitem &$item$&
11635 .vindex "&$item$&"
11636 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11637 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11638 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11639 empty.
11640
11641 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11642 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11643 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11644 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11645 lookup.
11646
11647 .vitem &$load_average$&
11648 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11649 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11650 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11651 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11652
11653 .vitem &$local_part$&
11654 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11655 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11656 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11657 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11658 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11659
11660 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11661 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11662 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11663 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11664 once.
11665
11666 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11667 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11668 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11669 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11670 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11671 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11672
11673 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11674 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11675 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11676 &$address_pipe$&).
11677
11678 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11679 local part of the recipient address.
11680
11681 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11682 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11683 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11684
11685 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11686 the addresses
11687 .code
11688 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11689 abc\:xyz@test.example
11690 .endd
11691 the value of &$local_part$& is
11692 .code
11693 abc:xyz
11694 .endd
11695 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11696 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11697 have:
11698 .code
11699 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11700 .endd
11701 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11702 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11703 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11704
11705 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11706 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11707 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11708 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11709 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11710 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11711 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11712
11713 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11714 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11715 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11716 variable expands to nothing.
11717
11718 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11719 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11720 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11721 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11722 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11723
11724 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11725 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11726 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11727 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11728 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11729
11730 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11731 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11732 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11733 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11734
11735 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11736 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11737 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11738
11739 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11740 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11741 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11742 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11743 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11744 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11745 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11746 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11747
11748 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11749 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11750 This contains the expanded value of the
11751 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11752 been read.
11753
11754 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11755 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11756 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11757 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11758 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11759 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11760
11761 .vitem &$log_space$&
11762 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11763 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11764 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11765 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11766 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11767 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11768
11769
11770 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11771 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11772 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11773 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11774 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11775 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11776 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11777 and &"yes"& if it was.
11778 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11779 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11780 as authenticated data.
11781
11782 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11783 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11784 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11785 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11786 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11787 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11788 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11789 variable is empty.
11790
11791 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11792 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11793 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11794 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11795 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11796
11797 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11798 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11799 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11800 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11801 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11802 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11803 character(s).
11804
11805 .vitem &$message_age$&
11806 .cindex "message" "age of"
11807 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11808 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11809 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11810 delivery attempt.
11811
11812 .vitem &$message_body$&
11813 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11814 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11815 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11816 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11817 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11818 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11819 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11820 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11821 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11822
11823 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11824 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11825 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11826 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11827 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11828
11829 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11830 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11831 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11832 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11833 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11834 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11835 &$message_body$&.
11836
11837 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11838 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11839 .cindex "message body" "size"
11840 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11841 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11842 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11843 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11844 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11845
11846 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11847 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11848 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11849 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11850 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11851 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11852 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11853 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11854
11855 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11856 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11857 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11858 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11859 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11860 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11861
11862 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11863 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11864 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11865 contents of header lines is done.
11866
11867 .vitem &$message_id$&
11868 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11869
11870 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11871 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11872 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11873 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11874 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11875 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11876 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11877 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11878 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11879 from the body is not counted.
11880
11881 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11882 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11883 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11884 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11885 header and the body).
11886
11887 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11888 .code
11889 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11890 condition = \
11891 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11892 .endd
11893 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11894 message has not yet been received.
11895
11896 .vitem &$message_size$&
11897 .cindex "size" "of message"
11898 .cindex "message" "size"
11899 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11900 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11901 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11902 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11903 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11904 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11905 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11906 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11907 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11908
11909 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11910 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11911 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11912 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11913
11914 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11915 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11916 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11917 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11918
11919 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11920 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11921 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11922
11923 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11924 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11925 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11926 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11927 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11928 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11929 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11930 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11931 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11932 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11933
11934 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11935 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11936 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11937
11938 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11939 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11940 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11941 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11942 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11943 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11944 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11945 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11946 the original address.
11947
11948 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11949 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11950 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11951 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11952 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11953
11954 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11955 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11956 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11957
11958 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11959 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11960 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11961 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11962 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11963 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11964 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11965 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11966 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11967
11968 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11969 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11970 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11971 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11972 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11973 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11974 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11975 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11976 user.
11977
11978 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11979 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11980 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11981 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11982
11983 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11984 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11985 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11986 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11987
11988 .vitem &$pid$&
11989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11990 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11991 This variable contains the current process id.
11992
11993 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11994 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11995 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11996 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11997 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11998 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11999 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12000 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12001 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12002 variable"& error if encountered.
12003
12004 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12005 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12006 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12007 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12008 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12009 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12010 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12011
12012
12013 .new
12014 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12015 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12016 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12017 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12018 .wen
12019
12020 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12021 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12022 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12023 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12024
12025 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12026 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12027 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12028 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12029
12030 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12031 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12032 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12033 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12034
12035 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12036 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12037 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12038
12039 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12040 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12041 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12042 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12043
12044 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12045 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12046 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12047 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12048 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12049
12050 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12051 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12052 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12053 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12054 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12055 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12056
12057 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12058 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12059 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12060 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12061 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12062
12063 .vitem &$received_count$&
12064 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12065 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12066 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12067 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12068 delivering.
12069
12070 .vitem &$received_for$&
12071 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12072 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12073 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12074 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12075 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12076
12077 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12078 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12079 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12080 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12081 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12082 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12083 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12084 option.
12085
12086 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12087 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12088 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12089 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12090 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12091 time.
12092 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12093
12094 .vitem &$received_port$&
12095 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12096 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12097
12098 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12099 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12100 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12101 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12102 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12103 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12104 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12105 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12106 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12107
12108 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12109 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12110 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12111 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12112 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12113 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12114
12115 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12116 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12117 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12118
12119 .vitem &$received_time$&
12120 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12121 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12122 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12123
12124 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12125 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12126 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12127 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12128 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12129 .display
12130 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12131 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12132 .endd
12133 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12134 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12135 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12136 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12137
12138 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12139 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12140 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12141 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12142
12143 .ilist
12144 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12145 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12146
12147 .next
12148 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12149
12150 .next
12151 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12152 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12153 MAIL).
12154
12155 .next
12156 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12157 .next
12158
12159 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12160 .endlist
12161
12162 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12163 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12164
12165 .vitem &$recipients$&
12166 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12167 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12168 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12169 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12170 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12171 cases:
12172
12173 .olist
12174 In a system filter file.
12175 .next
12176 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12177 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12178 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12179 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12180 .next
12181 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12182 .endlist
12183
12184
12185 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12186 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12187 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12188 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12189 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12190 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12191
12192
12193 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12194 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12195 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12196 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12197
12198 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12199 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12200 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12201 these variables contain the
12202 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12203
12204
12205 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12206 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12207 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12208 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12209 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12210 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12211 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12212
12213 .vitem &$return_path$&
12214 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12215 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12216 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12217 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12218 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12219 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12220 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12221 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12222 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12223 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12224 envelope sender.
12225
12226 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12227 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12228 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12229
12230 .vitem &$router_name$&
12231 .cindex "router" "name"
12232 .cindex "name" "of router"
12233 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12234 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12235
12236 .vitem &$runrc$&
12237 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12238 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12239 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12240 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12241 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12242 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12243 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12244 another.
12245
12246 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12247 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12248 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12249 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12250 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12251 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12252 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12253 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12254
12255 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12256 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12257 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12258 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12259 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12260 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12261
12262 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12263 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12264 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12265 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12266 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12267 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12268 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12269 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12270
12271 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12272 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12273 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12274
12275 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12276 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12277 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12278
12279 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12280 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12281 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12282 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12283 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12284 this:
12285 .display
12286 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12287 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12288 .endd
12289 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12290 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12291 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12292 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12293
12294 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12295 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12296 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12297 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12298 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12299 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12300 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12301 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12302 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12303 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12304 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12305 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12306 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12307
12308 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12309 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12310 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12311 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12312 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12313
12314 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12315 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12316 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12317 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12318 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12319 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12320
12321 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12322 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12323 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12324 this variable contains that
12325 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12326
12327 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12328 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12329 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12330 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12331 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12332 &$authenticated_id$&.
12333
12334 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12335 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12336 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12337 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12338 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12339 resolver library states that both
12340 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12341 other times, this variable is false.
12342
12343 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12344 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12345 library, by setting:
12346 .code
12347 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12348 .endd
12349
12350 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12351 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12352
12353 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12354 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12355
12356
12357 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12358 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12359 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12360 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12361 other means, this variable is empty.
12362
12363 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12364 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12365 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12366 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12367 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12368 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12369 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12370
12371 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12372 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12373 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12374 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12375
12376 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12377 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12378 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12379 is set to &"1"&.
12380
12381 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12382 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12383 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12384 following are true:
12385
12386 .ilist
12387 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12388 .next
12389 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12390 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12391 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12392 .next
12393 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12394 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12395 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12396 .next
12397 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12398 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12399 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12400 .next
12401 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12402 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12403 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12404 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12405 .code
12406 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12407 .endd
12408 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12409 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12410 .endlist
12411
12412
12413 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12414 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12415 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12416 number that was used on the remote host.
12417
12418 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12419 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12420 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12421 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12422 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12423 called Exim.
12424
12425 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12426 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12427 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12428 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12429
12430 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12431 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12432 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12433 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12434 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12435 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12436 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12437 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12438 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12439 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12440 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12441 the parentheses.
12442
12443 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12444 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12445 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12446 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12447 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12448
12449 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12450 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12451 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12452 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12453 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12454
12455 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12456 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12457 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12458 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12459 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12460 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12461 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12462
12463 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12464 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12465 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12466 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12467 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12468
12469 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12470 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12471 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12472 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12473 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12474 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12475
12476 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12477 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12478 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12479 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12480 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12481 .code
12482 MAIL FROM:<>
12483 MAIL FROM: <>
12484 .endd
12485 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12486 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12487 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12488 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12489
12490 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12491 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12492 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12493 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12494 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12495 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12496 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12497
12498 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12499 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12500 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12501 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12502 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12503 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12504 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12505 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12506 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12507 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12508 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12509
12510 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12511 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12512 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12513 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12514 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12515 message is junk mail.
12516
12517 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12518 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12519 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12520 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12521
12522
12523 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12524 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12525 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12526
12527 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12528 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12529 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12530 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12531 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12532 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12533
12534 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12535 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12536 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12537 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12538 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12539 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12540 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12541 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12542 .code
12543 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12544 .endd
12545 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12546
12547
12548 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12549 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12550 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12551 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12552 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12553 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12554
12555 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12556 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12557 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12558 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12559 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12560 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12561 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12562 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12563
12564 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12565 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12566 the outbound.
12567
12568 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12569 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12570 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12571 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12572 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12573 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12574
12575 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12576 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12577 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12578 inbound connection when the message was received.
12579 It is only useful as the argument of a
12580 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12581 or a &%def%& condition.
12582
12583 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12584 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12585 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12586 inbound connection when the message was received.
12587 It is only useful as the argument of a
12588 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12589 or a &%def%& condition.
12590 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12591 which is not the leaf.
12592
12593 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12594 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12595 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12596 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12597 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12598 or a &%def%& condition.
12599
12600 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12601 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12602 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12603 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12604 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12605 or a &%def%& condition.
12606 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12607 which is not the leaf.
12608
12609 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12610 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12611 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12612 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12613
12614 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12615 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12616 the outbound.
12617
12618 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12619 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12620 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12621 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12622 and &"0"& otherwise.
12623
12624 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12625 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12626 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12627 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12628 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12629 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12630 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12631 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12632 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12633
12634 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12635 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12636 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12637
12638 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12639 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12640 This variable is
12641 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12642 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12643 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12644 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12645
12646 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12647 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12648 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12649 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12650 .code
12651 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12652 1 No response to request
12653 2 Response not verified
12654 3 Verification failed
12655 4 Verification succeeded
12656 .endd
12657
12658 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12659 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12660 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12661 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12662 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12663
12664 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12665 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12666 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12667 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12668 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12669 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12670 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12671 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12672 which is not the leaf.
12673
12674 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12675 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12676 the outbound.
12677
12678 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12679 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12680 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12681 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12682 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12683 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12684 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12685 which is not the leaf.
12686
12687 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12688 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12689 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12690 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12691 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12692 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12693 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12694 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12695 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12696 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12697 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12698
12699 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12700 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12701 the outbound.
12702
12703 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12704 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12705 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12706 During outbound
12707 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12708 the transport.
12709
12710 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12711 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12712 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12713 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12714
12715 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12716 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12717 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12718
12719 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12720 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12721 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12722
12723 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12724 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12725 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12726 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12727 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12728 values for those that are behind (west).
12729
12730 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12731 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12732 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12733 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12734
12735 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12736 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12737 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12738 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12739 flag.
12740
12741 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12742 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12743 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12744 -0500.
12745
12746 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12747 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12748 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12749 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12750
12751 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12752 .cindex "transport" "name"
12753 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12754 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12755 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12756
12757 .vitem &$value$&
12758 .vindex "&$value$&"
12759 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12760 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12761 &*reduce*& expansion.
12762
12763 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12764 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12765 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12766 or for cutthrough delivery,
12767 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12768 Otherwise, empty.
12769
12770 .vitem &$version_number$&
12771 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12772 The version number of Exim.
12773
12774 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12775 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12776 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12777 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12778
12779 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12780 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12781 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12782 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12783 .endlist
12784 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12785
12786
12787
12788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12790
12791 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12792 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12793 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12794 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12795 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12796 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12797 the line
12798 .code
12799 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12800 .endd
12801 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12802
12803
12804 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12805 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12806 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12807 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12808 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12809 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12810 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12811 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12812 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12813
12814 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12815 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12816 should usually be something like
12817 .code
12818 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12819 .endd
12820 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12821 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12822 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12823 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12824 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12825 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12826 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12827 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12828 two ways:
12829
12830 .ilist
12831 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12832 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12833 a startup when Exim is entered.
12834 .next
12835 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12836 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12837 .endlist
12838
12839 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12840 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12841
12842
12843 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12844 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12845 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12846 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12847 forms:
12848 .code
12849 ${perl{foo}}
12850 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12851 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12852 .endd
12853 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12854 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12855 with an error message of the form
12856 .code
12857 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12858 .endd
12859 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12860 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12861 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12862 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12863 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12864 that was passed to &%die%&.
12865
12866
12867 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12868 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12869 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12870 the Perl code
12871 .code
12872 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12873 .endd
12874 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12875 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12876 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12877
12878 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12879 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12880 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12881 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12882
12883 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12884 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12885 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12886 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12887 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12888 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12889 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12890
12891
12892 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12893 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12894 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12895 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12896 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12897 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12898 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12899 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12900 avoided, but the output is lost.
12901
12902 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12903 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12904 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12905 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12906 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12907 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12908 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12909 .code
12910 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12911 .endd
12912 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12913 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12914 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12915 as the first subroutine argument.
12916 .ecindex IIDperl
12917
12918
12919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12921
12922 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12923 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12924 "Starting the daemon"
12925 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12926 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12927 .cindex "network interface"
12928 .cindex "interface" "network"
12929 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12930 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12931 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12932 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12933 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12934 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12935 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12936 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12937 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12938 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12939 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12940
12941 .olist
12942 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12943 and ports to listen on.
12944 .next
12945 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12946 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12947 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12948 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12949 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12950 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12951 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12952 as an error situation.
12953 .next
12954 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12955 for the outgoing connection.
12956 .endlist
12957
12958
12959 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12960 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12961 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12962 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12963 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12964
12965 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12966 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12967 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12968 chapter describes how they operate.
12969
12970 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12971 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12972
12973
12974
12975 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12976 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12977 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12978 following options:
12979
12980 .ilist
12981 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12982 or service names.
12983 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12984 .next
12985 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12986 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12987 .endlist
12988
12989 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12990 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12991 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12992 colons. For example:
12993 .code
12994 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12995 192.168.23.65 ; \
12996 ::1 ; \
12997 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12998 .endd
12999 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13000 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13001
13002 .olist
13003 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13004 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13005 .code
13006 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13007 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13008 .endd
13009 .next
13010 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13011 with a colon separator, for example:
13012 .code
13013 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13014 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13015 .endd
13016 .endlist
13017
13018 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13019 default setting contains just one port:
13020 .code
13021 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13022 .endd
13023 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13024 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13025 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13026 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13027 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13028
13029
13030
13031 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13032 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13033 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13034 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13035 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13036 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13037 .code
13038 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13039 .endd
13040 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13041 .code
13042 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13043 .endd
13044 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13045
13046
13047
13048 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13049 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13050 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13051 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13052 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13053 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13054 exim.
13055
13056 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13057 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13058 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13059 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13060 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13061 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13062 .code
13063 -oX 1225
13064 .endd
13065 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13066 whereas
13067 .code
13068 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13069 .endd
13070 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13071 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13072 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13073
13074
13075
13076 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13077 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13078 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13079 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13080 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13081 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13082 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13083 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13084 list of port numbers or service names,
13085 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13086 common use of this option is expected to be
13087 .code
13088 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13089 .endd
13090 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13091 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13092 this way when a daemon is started.
13093
13094 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13095 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13096 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13097 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13098 connections via the daemon.)
13099
13100
13101
13102
13103 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13104 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13105 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13106 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13107 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13108 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13109 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13110 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13111 .code
13112 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13113 .endd
13114 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13115 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13116 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13117 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13118 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13119 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13120 .code
13121 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13122 .endd
13123 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13124 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13125 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13126 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13127 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13128
13129 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13130 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13131 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13132 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13133 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13134 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13135 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13136 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13137 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13138 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13139 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13140 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13141
13142 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13143 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13144 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13145 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13146 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13147
13148
13149
13150 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13151 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13152 .code
13153 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13154 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13155 .endd
13156 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13157 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13158 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13159 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13160
13161 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13162 .code
13163 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13164 .endd
13165 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13166 .code
13167 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13168 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13169 .endd
13170 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13171 IPv4 loopback address only:
13172 .code
13173 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13174 .endd
13175 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13176 .code
13177 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13178 .endd
13179 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13180
13181
13182
13183 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13184 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13185 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13186 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13187 treated as local.
13188
13189 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13190 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13191 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13192 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13193
13194 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13195 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13196 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13197 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13198 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13199 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13200 used for listening. Consider this example:
13201 .code
13202 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13203 192.168.53.235 ; \
13204 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13205
13206 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13207 .endd
13208 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13209 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13210 Exim is routing.
13211
13212 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13213 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13214 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13215 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13216 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13217 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13218 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13219 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13220
13221
13222
13223 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13224 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13225 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13226 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13227 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13228 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13229 details.
13230
13231
13232
13233
13234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13236
13237 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13238 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13239 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13240 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13241
13242 .ilist
13243 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13244 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13245 .next
13246 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13247 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13248 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13249 .next
13250 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13251 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13252 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13253 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13254 settings.
13255 .endlist
13256
13257 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13258 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13259 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13260 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13261 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13262 listed in more than one group.
13263
13264 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13265 .table2
13266 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13267 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13268 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13269 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13270 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13271 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13272 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13273 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13274 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13275 .endtable
13276
13277
13278 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13279 .table2
13280 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13281 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13282 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13283 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13284 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13285 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13286 .endtable
13287
13288
13289
13290 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13291 .table2
13292 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13293 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13294 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13295 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13296 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13297 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13298 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13299 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13300 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13301 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13302 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13303 .endtable
13304
13305
13306
13307 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13308 .table2
13309 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13310 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13311 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13312 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13313 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13314 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13315 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13316 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13317 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13318 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13319 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13320 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13321 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13322 .endtable
13323
13324
13325
13326 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13327 .table2
13328 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13329 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13330 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13331 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13332 .endtable
13333
13334
13335
13336 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13337 .table2
13338 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13339 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13340 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13341 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13342 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13343 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13344 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13345 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13346 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13347 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13348 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13349 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13350 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13351 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13352 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13353 .endtable
13354
13355
13356
13357 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13358 .table2
13359 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13360 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13361 .endtable
13362
13363
13364
13365 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13366 .table2
13367 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13368 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13369 .endtable
13370
13371
13372
13373 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13374 .table2
13375 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13376 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13377 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13378 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13379 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13380 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13381 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13382 .endtable
13383
13384
13385
13386 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13387 .table2
13388 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13389 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13390 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13391 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13392 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13393 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13394 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13395 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13396 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13397 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13398 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13399 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13400 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13401 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13402 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13403 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13404 connection"
13405 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13406 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13407 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13408 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13409 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13410 .endtable
13411
13412
13413
13414 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13415 .table2
13416 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13417 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13418 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13419 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13420 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13421 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13422 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13423 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13424 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13425 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13426 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13427 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13428 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13429 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13430 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13431 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13432 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13433 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13434 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13435 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13436 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13437 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13438 words""&"
13439 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13440 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13441 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13442 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13443 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13444 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13445 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13446 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13447 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13448 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13449 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13450 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13451 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13452 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13453 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13454 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13455 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13456 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13457 .endtable
13458
13459
13460
13461 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13462 .table2
13463 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13464 item"
13465 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13466 item"
13467 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13468 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13469 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13470 .endtable
13471
13472
13473
13474 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13475 .table2
13476 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13477 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13478 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13479 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13480 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13481 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13482 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13483 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13484 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13485 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13486 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13487 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13488 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13489 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13490 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13491 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13492 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13493 .endtable
13494
13495
13496
13497 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13498 .table2
13499 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13500 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13501 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13502 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13503 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13504 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13505 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13506 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13507 .endtable
13508
13509
13510
13511 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13512 .table2
13513 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13514 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13515 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13516 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13517 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13518 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13519 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13520 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13521 .endtable
13522
13523
13524
13525
13526 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13527 .table2
13528 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13529 .endtable
13530
13531
13532
13533
13534
13535 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13536 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13537
13538 .table2
13539 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13540 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13541 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13542 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13543 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13544 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13545 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13546 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13547 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13548 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13549 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13550 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13551 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13552 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13553 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13554 connection"
13555 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13556 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13557 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13558 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13559 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13560 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13561 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13562 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13563 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13564 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13565 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13566 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13567 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13568 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13569 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13570 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13571 .endtable
13572
13573
13574
13575 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13576 .table2
13577 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13578 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13579 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13580 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13581 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13582 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13583 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13584 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13585 .endtable
13586
13587
13588
13589 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13590 .table2
13591 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13592 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13593 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13594 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13595 words""&"
13596 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13597 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13598 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13599 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13600 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13601 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13602 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13603 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13604 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13605 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13606 .endtable
13607
13608
13609
13610 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13611 .table2
13612 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13613 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13614 directory"
13615 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13616 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13617 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13618 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13619 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13620 .endtable
13621
13622
13623
13624 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13625 .table2
13626 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13627 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13628 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13629 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13630 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13631 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13632 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13633 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13634 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13635 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13636 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13637 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13638 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13639 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13640 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13641 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13642 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13643 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13644 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13645 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13646 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13647 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13648 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13649 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13650 .endtable
13651
13652
13653
13654 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13655 .table2
13656 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13657 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13658 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13659 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13660 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13661 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13662 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13663 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13664 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13665 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13666 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13667 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13668 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13669 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13670 .endtable
13671
13672
13673
13674 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13675 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13676 &dagger;.
13677
13678 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13679 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13680 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13681 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13682 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13683 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13684 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13685 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13686 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13687
13688 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13689 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13690 It now defaults to true.
13691 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13692 .display
13693 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13694 .endd
13695
13696 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13697 .code
13698 log_selector = +8bitmime
13699 .endd
13700
13701 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13702 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13703 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13704 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13705 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13706 further details.
13707
13708 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13709 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13710 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13711 SMTP messages.
13712
13713 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13714 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13715 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13716 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13717 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13718
13719 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13720 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13721 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13722 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13723 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13724
13725 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13726 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13727 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13728 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13729
13730 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13731 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13732 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13733 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13734 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13735
13736 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13737 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13738 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13739 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13740 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13741 This option defines the ACL that,
13742 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13743 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13744 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13745 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13746
13747 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13748 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13749 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13750 of a received message.
13751 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13752
13753 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13754 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13755 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13756 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13757
13758 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13759 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13760 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13761 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13762
13763 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13764 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13765 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13766 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13767 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13768
13769
13770 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13771 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13772 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13773 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13774
13775 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13776 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13777 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13778 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13779 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13780
13781 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13782 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13783 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13784 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13785 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13786
13787 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13788 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13789 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13790 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13791 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13792
13793 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13794 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13795 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13796 further details.
13797
13798 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13799 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13800 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13801 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13802
13803 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13804 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13805 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13806 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13807
13808 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13809 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13810 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13811 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13812
13813 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13814 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13815 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13816 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13817
13818 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13819 .cindex "admin user"
13820 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13821 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13822 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13823 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13824 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13825 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13826 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13827
13828 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13829 .cindex "domain literal"
13830 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13831 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13832 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13833 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13834
13835 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13836 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13837 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13838 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13839 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13840 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13841 the local host's IP addresses.
13842
13843
13844 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13845 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13846 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13847 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13848 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13849 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13850 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13851 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13852 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13853
13854 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13855 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13856 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13857 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13858 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13859 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13860 experiment if they wish.
13861
13862 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13863 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13864 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13865 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13866 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13867 suitable setting is:
13868 .code
13869 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13870 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13871 .endd
13872 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13873 .code
13874 dns_check_names_pattern =
13875 .endd
13876 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13877
13878
13879 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13880 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13881 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13882 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13883 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13884 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13885 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13886 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13887 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13888 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13889 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13890
13891 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13892 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13893 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13894 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13895 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13896 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13897
13898 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13899 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13900 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13901 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13902 .code
13903 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13904 .endd
13905 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13906 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13907 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13908 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13909
13910
13911 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13912 .cindex "thawing messages"
13913 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13914 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13915 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13916 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13917 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13918 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13919
13920 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13921 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13922 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13923
13924
13925 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13926 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13927 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13928 .code
13929 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13930 .endd
13931 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13932 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13933
13934
13935 .option bi_command main string unset
13936 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13937 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13938 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13939 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13940 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13941
13942
13943 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13944 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13945 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13946 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13947 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13948 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13949
13950
13951 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13952 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13953 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13954 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13955
13956 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13957 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13958 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13959 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13960 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13961 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13962 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13963 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13964 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13965 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13966
13967 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13968 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13969 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13970 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13971
13972
13973 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13974 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13975 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13976 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13977 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13978 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13979 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13980 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13981 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13982
13983 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13984 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13985 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13986 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13987 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13988 messages.
13989
13990 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13991 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13992 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13993 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13994 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13995 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13996 connection. A typical setting might be:
13997 .code
13998 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13999 .endd
14000 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14001 .code
14002 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14003 .endd
14004 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14005 address.
14006
14007 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14008 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14009 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14010 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14011 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14012 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14013
14014
14015 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14016 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14017 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14018 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14019
14020
14021 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14022 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14023 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14024 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14025
14026
14027 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14028 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14029 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14030 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14031
14032
14033 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14034 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14035 callout verification. The default value is
14036 .code
14037 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14038 .endd
14039 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14040
14041
14042 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14043 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14044
14045
14046 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14047 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14048
14049 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14050 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14051 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14052 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14053 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14054 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14055 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14056 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14057 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14058 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14059
14060
14061 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14062 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14063
14064
14065 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14066 .cindex "checking disk space"
14067 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14068 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14069 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14070 message is accepted.
14071
14072 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14073 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14074 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14075 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14076 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14077 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14078 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14079 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14080
14081
14082 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14083 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14084 .code
14085 check_spool_space = 10M
14086 check_spool_inodes = 100
14087 .endd
14088 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14089 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14090 transit.
14091
14092 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14093 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14094 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14095
14096 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14097 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14098 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14099 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14100 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14101 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14102
14103 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14104 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14105
14106 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14107 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14108 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14109
14110 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14111 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14112 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14113 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14114 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14115 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14116
14117 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14118 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14119 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14120 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14121 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14122 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14123 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14124
14125 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14126 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14127
14128 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14129 .cindex "warning of delay"
14130 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14131 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14132 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14133 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14134 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14135 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14136 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14137 with
14138 .code
14139 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14140 .endd
14141 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14142 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14143 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14144 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14145 .code
14146 delay_warning = 6h
14147 .endd
14148 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14149 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14150 .code
14151 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14152 .endd
14153 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14154 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14155 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14156
14157 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14158 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14159 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14160 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14161 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14162 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14163 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14164 not sent. The default is:
14165 .code
14166 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14167 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14168 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14169 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14170 } {no}{yes}}
14171 .endd
14172 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14173 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14174 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14175 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14176
14177 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14178 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14179 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14180 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14181 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14182 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14183 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14184 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14185
14186 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14187 .cindex "load average"
14188 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14189 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14190 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14191 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14192 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14193
14194
14195 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14196 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14197 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14198 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14199 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14200 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14201 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14202 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14203
14204 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14205 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14206 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14207 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14208 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14209 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14210 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14211 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14212
14213 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14214 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14215 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14216 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14217
14218
14219 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14220 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14221 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14222 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14223 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14224 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14225 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14226
14227
14228 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14229 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14230 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14231 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14232 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14233 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14234
14235
14236 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14237 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14238 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14239 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14240 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14241 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14242 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14243 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14244 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14245 by a setting such as this:
14246 .code
14247 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14248 .endd
14249 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14250 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14251 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14252 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14253 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14254 options are applied after this global option.
14255
14256 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14257 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14258 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14259 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14260 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14261 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14262 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14263 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14264 value of this option. The default pattern is
14265 .code
14266 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14267 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14268 .endd
14269 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14270 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14271 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14272 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14273 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14274 empty string.
14275
14276 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14277 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14278 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14279
14280 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14281 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14282 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14283 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14284
14285
14286 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14287 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14288 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14289 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14290 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14291 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14292
14293 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14294
14295
14296 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14297 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14298 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14299 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14300 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14301 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14302 domain matches this list.
14303
14304 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14305 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14306 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14307
14308
14309 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14310 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14311 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14312 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14313 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14314 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14315 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14316 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14317 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14318 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14319 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14320 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14321 to set in them.
14322 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14323
14324
14325 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14326 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14327
14328
14329 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14330 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14331 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14332 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14333 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14334 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14335 match with this expanded domain list.
14336
14337 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14338 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14339 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14340 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14341 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14342 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14343
14344 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14345 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14346 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14347
14348 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14349 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14350 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14351 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14352 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14353
14354 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14355 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14356 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14357 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14358 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14359 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14360 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14361 on.
14362
14363 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14364
14365
14366 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14367 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14368 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14369 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14370
14371 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14372 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14373 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14374 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14375 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14376 and accepted from, these hosts.
14377 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14378 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14379 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14380 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14381 are sent.
14382
14383 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14384 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14385 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14386 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14387 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14388 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14389 .code
14390 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14391 .endd
14392 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14393 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14394
14395 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14396 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14397 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14398 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14399 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14400 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14401 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14402 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14403 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14404
14405
14406 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14407 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14408 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14409 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14410 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14411 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14412 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14413 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14414 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14415
14416 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14417 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14418 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14419 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14420 are examined. For example:
14421 .code
14422 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14423 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14424 postmaster@mydomain.example
14425 .endd
14426 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14427 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14428 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14429 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14430 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14431 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14432 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14433
14434
14435 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14436 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14437 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14438 .display
14439 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14440 .endd
14441 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14442 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14443 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14444 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14445 overrides the default.
14446
14447 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14448 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14449 and warning messages. For example:
14450 .code
14451 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14452 .endd
14453 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14454 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14455 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14456 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14457 not used.
14458
14459
14460 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14461 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14462 .cindex "Exim group"
14463 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14464 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14465 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14466 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14467 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14468 security issues.
14469
14470
14471 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14472 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14473 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14474 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14475 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14476 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14477 other place.
14478 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14479 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14480 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14481 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14482
14483
14484 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14485 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14486 .cindex "Exim user"
14487 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14488 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14489 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14490 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14491
14492 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14493 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14494 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14495 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14496
14497
14498 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14499 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14500 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14501 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14502
14503
14504 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14505 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14506
14507 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14508 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14509 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14510 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14511 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14512 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14513 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14514 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14515 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14516 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14517 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14518 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14519 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14520 addresses.
14521
14522
14523 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14524 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14525 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14526 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14527 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14528 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14529 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14530 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14531 retries.
14532
14533 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14534 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14535 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14536 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14537
14538
14539
14540 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14541 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14542 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14543 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14544 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14545 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14546 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14547 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14548 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14549 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14550 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14551 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14552 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14553 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14554 logging that you require.
14555
14556
14557 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14558 .cindex "HP-UX"
14559 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14560 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14561 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14562 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14563 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14564 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14565 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14566 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14567
14568 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14569 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14570 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14571 user's name.
14572
14573 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14574 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14575 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14576 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14577 .code
14578 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14579 gecos_name = $1
14580 .endd
14581
14582 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14583 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14584
14585
14586 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14587 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14588 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14589 implementations of TLS.
14590
14591
14592 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14593 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14594 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14595
14596 See
14597 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14598 for documentation.
14599
14600
14601
14602 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14603 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14604 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14605 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14606 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14607 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14608
14609
14610
14611 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14612 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14613 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14614 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14615 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14616 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14617 sections are rejected.
14618
14619
14620 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14621 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14622 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14623 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14624 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14625 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14626 zero means &"no limit"&.
14627
14628
14629
14630
14631 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14632 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14633 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14634 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14635 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14636 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14637 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14638 if you want to do semantic checking.
14639 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14640 set.
14641
14642
14643 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14644 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14645 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14646 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14647 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14648 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14649 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14650 .code
14651 helo_allow_chars = _
14652 .endd
14653 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14654
14655
14656 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14657 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14658 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14659 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14660 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14661 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14662 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14663 do.
14664
14665
14666 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14667 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14668 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14669 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14670 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14671 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14672 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14673 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14674 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14675 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14676 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14677 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14678
14679 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14680 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14681 EHLO command either:
14682
14683 .ilist
14684 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14685 .next
14686 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14687 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14688 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14689 calling host address, or
14690 .next
14691 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14692 .endlist
14693
14694 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14695 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14696 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14697
14698 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14699 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14700 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14701
14702 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14703 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14704 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14705 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14706 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14707 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14708 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14709 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14710 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14711 error.
14712
14713 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14714 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14715 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14716 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14717 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14718 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14719 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14720 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14721 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14722
14723 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14724 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14725 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14726 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14727 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14728
14729 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14730 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14731 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14732 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14733
14734
14735 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14736 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14737 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14738 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14739 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14740 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14741 default configuration file contains
14742 .code
14743 host_lookup = *
14744 .endd
14745 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14746 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14747
14748 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14749 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14750 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14751
14752 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14753 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14754 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14755 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14756 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14757 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14758
14759
14760 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14761 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14762 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14763 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14764 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14765 if you want.
14766
14767 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14768 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14769 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14770 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14771
14772
14773
14774 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14775 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14776 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14777 as soon as the connection is made.
14778 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14779 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14780 connections immediately.
14781
14782 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14783 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14784 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14785 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14786 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14787
14788
14789 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14790 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14791 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14792 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14793 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14794 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14795 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14796 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14797 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14798 .code
14799 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14800 .endd
14801 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14802
14803
14804
14805 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14806 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14807 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14808 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14809 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14810 records
14811 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14812 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14813
14814 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14815 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14816 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14817 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14818 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14819 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14820 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14821
14822
14823 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14824 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14825 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14826 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14827 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14828
14829
14830
14831 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14832 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14833 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14834 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14835 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14836 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14837
14838 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14839 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14840 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14841 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14842 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14843 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14844 for frozen messages. For example,
14845 .code
14846 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14847 .endd
14848 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14849 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14850 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14851 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14852 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14853 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14854
14855
14856 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14857 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14858 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14859 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14860 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14861 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14862 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14863 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14864 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14865 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14866
14867
14868 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14869 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14870
14871
14872 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14873 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14874 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14875 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14876 logged.
14877
14878
14879 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14880 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14881 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14882 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14883 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14884 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14885 and constrained to be a directory.
14886
14887
14888 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14889 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14890 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14891 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14892 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14893 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14894 and constrained to be a file.
14895
14896
14897 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14898 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14899 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14900 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14901 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14902
14903
14904 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14905 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14906 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14907 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14908 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14909 identity to be proven.
14910
14911
14912 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14913 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14914 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14915 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14916 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14917
14918
14919 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14920 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14921 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14922 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14923 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14924 with LDAP support.
14925
14926
14927 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14928 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14929 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14930 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14931 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14932 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14933 to hard/demand.
14934
14935
14936 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14937 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14938 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14939 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14940 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14941 of SSL-on-connect.
14942 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14943 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14944
14945
14946 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14947 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14948 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14949 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14950 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14951 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14952 has been built with LDAP support.
14953
14954
14955
14956 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14957 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14958 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14959 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14960 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14961 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14962 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14963
14964 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14965 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14966 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14967
14968 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14969 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14970 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14971 and the default qualify domain.
14972
14973 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14974 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14975 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14976 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14977
14978 .cindex "envelope sender"
14979 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14980 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14981 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14982
14983 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14984 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14985 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14986
14987
14988
14989
14990 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14991 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14992 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14993 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14994 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14995 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14996 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14997 example, if
14998 .code
14999 local_from_prefix = *-
15000 .endd
15001 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15002 .code
15003 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15004 .endd
15005 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15006 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15007 qualify domain.
15008
15009
15010 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15011 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15012
15013
15014 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15015 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15016 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15017 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15018 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15019 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15020 &%local_interfaces%& is
15021 .code
15022 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15023 .endd
15024 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15025 .code
15026 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15027 .endd
15028
15029 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15030 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15031 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15032 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15033 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15034 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15035 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15036 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15037
15038
15039
15040 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15041 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15042 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15043 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15044 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15045 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15046 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15047 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15048
15049
15050
15051
15052 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15053 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15054 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15055 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15056 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15057 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15058 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15059 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15060 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15061 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15062 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15063 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15064 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15065 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15066 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15067
15068
15069
15070 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15071 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15072 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15073 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15074 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15075 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15076 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15077 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15078 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15079 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15080 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15081 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15082 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15083 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15084 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15085
15086
15087 .option log_selector main string unset
15088 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15089 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15090 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15091 minus characters. For example:
15092 .code
15093 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15094 .endd
15095 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15096 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15097
15098
15099 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15100 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15101 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15102 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15103 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15104 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15105 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15106 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15107 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15108 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15109 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15110 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15111 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15112
15113
15114 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15115 .cindex "too many open files"
15116 .cindex "open files, too many"
15117 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15118 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15119 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15120 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15121 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15122 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15123 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15124 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15125 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15126 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15127 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15128 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15129
15130
15131 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15132 .cindex "length of login name"
15133 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15134 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15135 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15136 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15137 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15138 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15139
15140
15141 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15142 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15143 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15144 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15145 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15146 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15147 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15148 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15149
15150
15151 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15152 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15153 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15154 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15155 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15156 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15157 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15158
15159
15160 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15161 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15162 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15163 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15164 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15165 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15166 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15167 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15168 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15169 empty string, the option is ignored.
15170
15171
15172 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15173 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15174 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15175 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15176 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15177 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15178 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15179 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15180 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15181 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15182 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15183 colons will become hyphens.
15184
15185
15186 .option message_logs main boolean true
15187 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15188 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15189 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15190 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15191 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15192 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15193 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15194 which is not affected by this option.
15195
15196
15197 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15198 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15199 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15200 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15201 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15202 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15203 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15204 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15205 optionally followed by K or M.
15206
15207 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15208 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15209 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15210 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15211 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15212
15213 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15214 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15215 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15216 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15217 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15218 message that an individual transport can process.
15219
15220 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15221 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15222 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15223 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15224 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15225 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15226 some problems may result.
15227
15228 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15229 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15230 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15231
15232
15233 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15234 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15235 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15236 .code
15237 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15238 .endd
15239 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15240 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15241 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15242 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15243 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15244
15245
15246 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15247 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15248 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15249 contains a full description of this facility.
15250
15251
15252
15253 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15254 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15255 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15256 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15257 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15258
15259
15260 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15261 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15262 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15263 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15264 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15265 safety precaution.
15266
15267 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15268 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15269 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15270 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15271 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15272
15273 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15274 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15275 example is
15276 .code
15277 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15278 .endd
15279 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15280 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15281 transport driver.
15282
15283
15284 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15285 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15286 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15287 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15288 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15289
15290 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15291 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15292 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15293 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15294 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15295 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15296 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15297
15298 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15299 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15300 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15301 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15302 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15303
15304 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15305
15306 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15307 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15308 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15309 some now infamous attacks.
15310
15311 Examples:
15312 .code
15313 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15314 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15315 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15316
15317 # Disable older protocol versions:
15318 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15319 .endd
15320
15321 Possible options may include:
15322 .ilist
15323 &`all`&
15324 .next
15325 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15326 .next
15327 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15328 .next
15329 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15330 .next
15331 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15332 .next
15333 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15334 .next
15335 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15336 .next
15337 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15338 .next
15339 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15340 .next
15341 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15342 .next
15343 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15344 .next
15345 &`no_compression`&
15346 .next
15347 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15348 .next
15349 &`no_sslv2`&
15350 .next
15351 &`no_sslv3`&
15352 .next
15353 &`no_ticket`&
15354 .next
15355 &`no_tlsv1`&
15356 .next
15357 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15358 .next
15359 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15360 .next
15361 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15362 .next
15363 &`single_dh_use`&
15364 .next
15365 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15366 .next
15367 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15368 .next
15369 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15370 .next
15371 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15372 .next
15373 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15374 .next
15375 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15376 .endlist
15377
15378 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15379 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15380 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15381 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15382 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15383 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15384
15385
15386 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15387 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15388 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15389 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15390 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15391
15392
15393 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15394 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15395 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15396 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15397 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15398 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15399 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15400 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15401 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15402 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15403 an ACL.
15404
15405 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15406 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15407 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15408 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15409 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15410 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15411 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15412
15413
15414 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15415 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15416 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15417
15418
15419 .option perl_startup main string unset
15420 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15421 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15422
15423
15424 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15425 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15426 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15427 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15428 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15429 PostgreSQL support.
15430
15431
15432 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15433 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15434 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15435 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15436 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15437 to the host name:
15438 .code
15439 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15440 .endd
15441 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15442 spool directory.
15443 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15444 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15445 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15446
15447
15448 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15449 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15450 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15451 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15452 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15453 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15454 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15455 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15456 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15457
15458
15459 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15460 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15461 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15462 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15463 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15464 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15465 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15466 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15467
15468 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15469 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15470 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15471 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15472 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15473 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15474 volume of mail. Use with care!
15475
15476
15477 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15478 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15479 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15480 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15481 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15482 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15483 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15484 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15485 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15486 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15487
15488 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15489 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15490 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15491 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15492 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15493 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15494
15495
15496 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15497 .cindex "printing characters"
15498 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15499 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15500 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15501 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15502 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15503 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15504 characters.
15505
15506 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15507 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15508 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15509 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15510 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15511 standards.
15512
15513
15514 .option process_log_path main string unset
15515 .cindex "process log path"
15516 .cindex "log" "process log"
15517 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15518 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15519 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15520 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15521 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15522 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15523 different spool directories.
15524
15525
15526 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15527 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15528 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15529 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15530 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15531 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15532 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15533
15534
15535 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15536 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15537 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15538 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15539 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15540 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15541 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15542 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15543 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15544
15545 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15546 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15547 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15548 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15549 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15550 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15551 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15552
15553
15554 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15555 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15556 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15557
15558
15559
15560 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15561 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15562 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15563 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15564 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15565 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15566 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15567 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15568
15569
15570 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15571 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15572 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15573 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15574 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15575
15576
15577 .option queue_only main boolean false
15578 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15579 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15580 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15581 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15582 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15583 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15584
15585 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15586 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15587 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15588 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15589
15590
15591 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15592 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15593 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15594 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15595 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15596 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15597 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15598 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15599 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15600 .code
15601 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15602 .endd
15603 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15604 &_/some/file_& exists.
15605
15606
15607 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15608 .cindex "load average"
15609 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15610 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15611 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15612 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15613 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15614 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15615 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15616 false.
15617
15618 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15619 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15620 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15621 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15622
15623
15624 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15625 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15626 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15627 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15628 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15629 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15630 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15631 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15632 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15633 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15634 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15635 re-evaluated for each message.
15636
15637
15638 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15639 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15640 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15641 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15642 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15643 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15644
15645
15646 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15647 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15648 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15649 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15650 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15651 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15652 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15653 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15654 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15655 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15656 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15657 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15658 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15659
15660
15661
15662 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15663 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15664 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15665 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15666 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15667 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15668 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15669 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15670 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15671
15672 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15673 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15674 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15675 the daemon's command line.
15676
15677 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15678 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15679 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15680 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15681 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15682 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15683 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15684 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15685 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15686 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15687 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15688 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15689 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15690 &%queue_domains%&.
15691
15692
15693 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15694 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15695 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15696 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15697 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15698 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15699 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15700
15701 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15702 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15703 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15704 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15705 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15706 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15707 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15708 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15709 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15710 header lines. The default setting is:
15711
15712 .code
15713 received_header_text = Received: \
15714 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15715 {${if def:sender_ident \
15716 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15717 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15718 by $primary_hostname \
15719 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15720 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15721 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15722 ${if def:sender_address \
15723 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15724 id $message_exim_id\
15725 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15726 .endd
15727
15728 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15729 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15730 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15731 header lines such as the following:
15732 .code
15733 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15734 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15735 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15736 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15737 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15738 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15739 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15740 .endd
15741 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15742 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15743 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15744 message was accepted.
15745
15746
15747 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15748 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15749 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15750 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15751 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15752 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15753 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15754 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15755
15756
15757 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15758 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15759 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15760 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15761 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15762 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15763 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15764 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15765 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15766 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15767 option was not set.
15768
15769
15770 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15771 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15772 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15773 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15774 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15775 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15776 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15777 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15778 done.
15779
15780 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15781 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15782 RCPT commands in a single message.
15783
15784
15785 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15786 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15787 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15788 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15789 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15790 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15791 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15792
15793
15794 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15795 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15796 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15797 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15798 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15799 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15800 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15801 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15802 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15803 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15804 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15805 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15806 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15807 tagged with its process id.
15808
15809 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15810 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15811 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15812 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15813 is received.
15814
15815 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15816 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15817 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15818 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15819 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15820 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15821 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15822 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15823 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15824 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15825 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15826
15827 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15828 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15829 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15830 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15831
15832
15833 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15834 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15835 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15836 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15837 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15838 .code
15839 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15840 .endd
15841 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15842 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15843
15844
15845 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15846 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15847 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15848 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15849 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15850 past failures.
15851
15852
15853 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15854 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15855 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15856 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15857 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15858 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15859 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15860 the default value.
15861
15862
15863 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15864 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15865 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15866 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15867 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15868 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15869 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15870 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15871 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15872 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15873
15874
15875 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15876 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15877
15878
15879 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15880 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15881 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15882 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15883 an item in the list.
15884 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15885 for the system.
15886
15887 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15888 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15889 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15890 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15891 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15892
15893
15894 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15895 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15896 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15897 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15898 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15899 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15900 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15901 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15902 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15903 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15904
15905
15906 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15907 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15908 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15909 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15910 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15911 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15912 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15913
15914
15915
15916 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15917 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15918 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15919 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15920 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15921 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15922 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15923 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15924 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15925 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15926 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15927
15928
15929
15930 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15931 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15932 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15933 .cindex "inetd"
15934 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15935 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15936 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15937 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15938 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15939 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15940
15941 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15942 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15943 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15944 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15945
15946
15947 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15948 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15949 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15950 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15951 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15952 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15953 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15954 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15955
15956 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15957 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15958 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15959 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15960 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15961 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15962 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15963 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15964
15965
15966 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15967 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15968 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15969 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15970 live with.
15971
15972
15973 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15974 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15975 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15976 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15977 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15978 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15979 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15980 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15981 . the option name to split.
15982
15983 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15984 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15985 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15986 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15987 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15988 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15989 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15990 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15991 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15992 seen).
15993
15994
15995 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15996 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15997 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15998 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15999 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16000 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16001 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16002 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16003 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16004 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16005 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16006
16007 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16008 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16009 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16010 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16011 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16012 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16013
16014
16015
16016 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16017 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16018 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16019 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16020 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16021 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16022 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16023 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16024 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16025 to all messages received in the same connection.
16026
16027 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16028 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16029 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16030 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16031
16032
16033 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16034
16035 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16036 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16037 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16038 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16039 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16040 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16041 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16042 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16043 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16044 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16045 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16046 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16047 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16048
16049
16050 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16051 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16052 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16053 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16054 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16055 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16056 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16057 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16058 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16059 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16060 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16061 individual host.
16062
16063 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16064 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16065 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16066 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16067
16068
16069 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16070 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16071 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16072 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16073 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16074 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16075 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16076 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16077 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16078
16079 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16080 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16081 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16082 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16083
16084 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16085 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16086 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16087 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16088 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16089 For example:
16090 .code
16091 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16092 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16093 .endd
16094
16095 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16096 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16097 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16098 &%helo_data%& value.
16099
16100 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16101 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16102 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16103 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16104 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16105 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16106 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16107 .code
16108 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16109 $version_number $tod_full
16110 .endd
16111 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16112 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16113 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16114 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16115 multiline response).
16116
16117
16118 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16119 .cindex "checking disk space"
16120 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16121 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16122 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16123 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16124 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16125 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16126 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16127
16128
16129 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16130 .cindex "connection backlog"
16131 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16132 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16133 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16134 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16135 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16136 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16137 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16138 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16139 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16140 attacks by SYN flooding.
16141
16142
16143 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16144 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16145 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16146 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16147 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16148 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16149 fewer, but they still exist.
16150
16151 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16152 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16153 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16154 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16155 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16156 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16157 does detect many instances.
16158
16159 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16160 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16161 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16162 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16163
16164
16165
16166 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16167 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16168 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16169 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16170 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16171 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16172 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16173 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16174 example:
16175 .code
16176 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16177 $sender_host_address
16178 .endd
16179 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16180 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16181 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16182 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16183 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16184 the command.
16185
16186
16187 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16188 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16189 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16190 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16191 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16192
16193
16194 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16195 .cindex "load average"
16196 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16197 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16198 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16199 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16200 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16201 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16202
16203
16204
16205 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16206 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16207 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16208 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16209 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16210 .code
16211 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16212 .endd
16213 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16214 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16215 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16216 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16217 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16218
16219 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16220 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16221 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16222 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16223 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16224 not count towards the limit.
16225
16226
16227
16228 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16229 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16230 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16231 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16232 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16233 that subvert web
16234 clients
16235 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16236 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16237
16238
16239
16240 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16241 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16242 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16243 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16244 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16245 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16246 recipients.
16247
16248 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16249 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16250 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16251 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16252
16253 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16254 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16255 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16256 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16257 values:
16258
16259 .ilist
16260 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16261 .next
16262 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16263 fractional parts are allowed here.
16264 .next
16265 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16266 .next
16267 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16268 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16269 .endlist
16270
16271 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16272 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16273 .code
16274 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16275 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16276 .endd
16277 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16278 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16279 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16280 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16281
16282
16283 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16284 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16285
16286
16287 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16288 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16289
16290
16291 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16292 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16293 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16294 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16295 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16296 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16297 the message is abandoned.
16298 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16299 .code
16300 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16301 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16302 .endd
16303 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16304 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16305
16306 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16307 expanded before use and may depend on
16308 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16309
16310
16311 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16312 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16313 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16314 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16315 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16316 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16317
16318
16319 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16320 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16321 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16322
16323
16324 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16325 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16326 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16327 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16328 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16329 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16330 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16331 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16332 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16333 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16334 .code
16335 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16336 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16337 .endd
16338
16339 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16340 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16341 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16342 The default value is
16343 .code
16344 127.0.0.1 783
16345 .endd
16346 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16347
16348
16349
16350 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16351 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16352 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16353 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16354 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16355 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16356 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16357 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16358 arrival of the message.
16359
16360 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16361 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16362 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16363 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16364 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16365
16366 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16367 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16368 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16369 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16370 automatically deleted.
16371
16372 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16373 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16374 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16375 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16376 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16377 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16378 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16379 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16380 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16381
16382
16383 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16384 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16385 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16386 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16387 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16388 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16389 &$primary_hostname$&.
16390
16391 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16392 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16393 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16394 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16395 as failures in the configuration file.
16396
16397 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16398 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16399
16400 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16401 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16402 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16403 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16404
16405 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16406 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16407 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16408 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16409 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16410 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16411
16412 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16413 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16414 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16415 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16416 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16417 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16418 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16419
16420
16421 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16422 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16423 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16424 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16425 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16426 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16427 domain causes a syntax error.
16428 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16429 syntax checking.
16430
16431
16432 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16433 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16434 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16435 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16436 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16437 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16438 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16439 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16440 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16441 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16442 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16443 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16444
16445
16446 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16447 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16448 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16449 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16450 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16451 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16452 details of Exim's logging.
16453
16454
16455
16456 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16457 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16458 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16459 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16460 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16461
16462
16463
16464 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16465 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16466 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16467 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16468 details of Exim's logging.
16469
16470
16471 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16472 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16473 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16474 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16475 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16476 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16477 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16478 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16479 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16480 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16481 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16482
16483
16484 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16485 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16486 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16487 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16488 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16489 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16490
16491
16492 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16493 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16494 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16495 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16496 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16497
16498 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16499 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16500 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16501 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16502 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16503
16504 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16505 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16506 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16507 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16508 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16509 contains the pipe command.
16510
16511
16512 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16513 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16514 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16515 is used in a system filter.
16516
16517
16518 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16519 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16520 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16521 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16522 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16523 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16524 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16525 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16526 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16527 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16528
16529 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16530 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16531 transport option overrides.
16532
16533
16534 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16535 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16536 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16537 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16538 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16539 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16540 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16541 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16542 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16543 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16544 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16545 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16546 TCP_NODELAY.
16547
16548
16549 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16550 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16551 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16552 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16553 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16554 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16555 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16556 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16557 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16558 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16559
16560 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16561 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16562 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16563
16564
16565 .option timezone main string unset
16566 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16567 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16568 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16569 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16570 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16571 .code
16572 timezone = UTC
16573 .endd
16574 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16575 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16576 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16577 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16578 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16579 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16580
16581
16582 .new
16583 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16584 .wen
16585 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16586 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16587 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16588 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16589 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16590 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16591 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16592 .new
16593 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16594 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16595 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16596 .wen
16597
16598
16599 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16600 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16601 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16602 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16603 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16604 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16605 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16606
16607 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16608 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16609 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16610 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16611
16612 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16613 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16614 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16615 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16616
16617 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16618 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16619 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16620 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16621 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16622
16623 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16624
16625
16626 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16627 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16628 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16629 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16630 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16631 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16632
16633 The value must be at least 1024.
16634
16635 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16636 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16637 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16638
16639 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16640 number.
16641
16642 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16643 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16644 larger prime than requested.
16645
16646
16647 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16648 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16649 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16650 to be used by Exim.
16651
16652 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16653 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16654 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16655 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16656 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16657 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16658 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16659
16660 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16661 loaded by Exim.
16662
16663 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16664 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16665 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16666 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16667
16668 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16669 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16670 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16671 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16672
16673 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16674 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16675 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16676 "ike23".
16677
16678 The available primes are:
16679 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16680 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16681 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16682
16683 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16684 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16685
16686 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16687 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16688 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16689 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16690 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16691 userbase.
16692
16693 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16694 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16695 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16696 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16697 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16698 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16699 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16700
16701
16702 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16703 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16704 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16705 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16706
16707 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16708 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16709 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16710 which tell the library to choose.
16711
16712 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16713
16714
16715 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16716 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16717 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16718 This option
16719 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16720 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16721 Certificate Authority.
16722
16723 .new
16724 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16725 .wen
16726
16727
16728 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16729 .cindex SSMTP
16730 .cindex SMTPS
16731 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16732 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16733 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16734 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16735
16736
16737
16738 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16739 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16740 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16741 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16742 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16743 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16744 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16745
16746 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16747
16748
16749 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16750 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16751 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16752 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16753 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16754 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16755 TLS session.
16756
16757
16758 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16759 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16760 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16761 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16762 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16763 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16764 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16765 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16766 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16767 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16768 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16769
16770
16771 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16772 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16773 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16774 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16775
16776
16777 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16778 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16779 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16780 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16781 word "system"
16782 or the absolute path to
16783 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16784 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16785
16786 The "system" value for the option will use a
16787 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16788 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16789 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16790 must be specified.
16791
16792 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16793 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16794
16795 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16796 explicitly
16797 either by file or directory
16798 are added to those given by the system default location.
16799
16800 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16801 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16802 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16803 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16804 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16805 use the explicit directory version.
16806
16807 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16808
16809 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16810 being unset.
16811
16812
16813 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16814 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16815 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16816 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16817 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16818 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16819 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16820 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16821
16822 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16823 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16824 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16825 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16826 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16827 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16828 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16829
16830 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16831 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16832 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16833 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16834 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16835 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16836 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16837 certificate"&.
16838
16839 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16840 certificates.
16841
16842
16843 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16844 .cindex "trusted groups"
16845 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16846 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16847 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16848 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16849 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16850 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16851 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16852 are trusted.
16853
16854 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16855 .cindex "trusted users"
16856 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16857 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16858 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16859 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16860 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16861 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16862 Exim user are trusted.
16863
16864 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16865 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16866 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16867 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16868 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16869 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16870 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16871 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16872 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16873 &%-F%& option.
16874
16875 .option unknown_username main string unset
16876 See &%unknown_login%&.
16877
16878 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16879 .cindex "trusted users"
16880 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16881 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16882 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16883 .cindex "envelope sender"
16884 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16885 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16886 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16887 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16888 is used) is ignored.
16889
16890 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16891 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16892 .code
16893 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16894 .endd
16895 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16896 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16897 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16898 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16899 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16900 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16901 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16902 followed by a hyphen
16903 by a setting like this:
16904 .code
16905 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16906 .endd
16907 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16908 restriction, you can use
16909 .code
16910 untrusted_set_sender = *
16911 .endd
16912 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16913 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16914 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16915 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16916 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16917 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16918 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16919 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16920
16921 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16922 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16923 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16924 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16925 sender address.
16926
16927
16928 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16929 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16930 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16931 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16932 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16933 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16934 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16935 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16936 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16937 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16938 .code
16939 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16940 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16941 .endd
16942 The pattern can be seen by running
16943 .code
16944 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16945 .endd
16946 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16947 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16948 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16949 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16950 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16951 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16952
16953
16954 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16955 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16956
16957
16958 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16959 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16960 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16961 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16962 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16963 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16964 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16965 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16966
16967
16968 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16969 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16970 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16971 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16972 .ecindex IIDconfima
16973 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16974
16975
16976
16977
16978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16980
16981 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16982 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16983 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16984 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16985 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16986
16987 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16988 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16989 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16990 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16991 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16992
16993
16994
16995 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16996 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16997 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16998 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16999 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17000 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17001 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17002
17003 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17004 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17005 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17006 routers, and the eventual transport.
17007
17008 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17009 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17010 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17011 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17012 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17013
17014 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17015 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17016 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17017 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17018 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17019
17020 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17021 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17022 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17023 .code
17024 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17025 .endd
17026 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17027 .code
17028 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17029 .endd
17030 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17031 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17032
17033 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17034 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17035 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17036 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17037 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17038 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17039 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17040
17041
17042
17043 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17044 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17045 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17046 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17047 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17048 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17049 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17050 routing.
17051
17052
17053
17054 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17055 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17056 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17057 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17058 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17059 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17060 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17061 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17062 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17063 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17064 you could put:
17065 .code
17066 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17067 .endd
17068 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17069 and
17070 .code
17071 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17072 .endd
17073 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17074 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17075 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17076 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17077
17078
17079 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17080 .cindex "case of local parts"
17081 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17082 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17083 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17084 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17085 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17086 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17087 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17088 more details.
17089
17090 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17091 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17092 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17093 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17094 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17095 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17096 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17097 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17098 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17099
17100 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17101 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17102 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17103 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17104
17105
17106
17107 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17108 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17109 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17110 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17111 .vindex "&$home$&"
17112 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17113 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17114 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17115 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17116 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17117 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17118 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17119 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17120 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17121 the router is skipped.
17122
17123 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17124 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17125 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17126 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17127 setting to achieve this. For example:
17128 .code
17129 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17130 .endd
17131 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17132 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17133 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17134
17135
17136
17137 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17138 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17139 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17140 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17141 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17142 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17143 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17144 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17145
17146 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17147 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17148
17149 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17150 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17151
17152 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17153 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17154 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17155 .code
17156 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17157 .endd
17158 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17159 .code
17160 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17161 .endd
17162
17163 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17164 .code
17165 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17166 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17167 condition = foobar
17168 .endd
17169
17170 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17171 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17172 be specified using &%condition%&.
17173
17174 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17175 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17176 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17177 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17178 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17179 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17180 Router rules processing behavior.
17181
17182 This is best illustrated in an example:
17183 .code
17184 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17185 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17186
17187 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17188 true {yes} {no}}
17189
17190 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17191 {yes} {no}}
17192 .endd
17193 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17194 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17195 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17196 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17197 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17198 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17199 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17200 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17201
17202 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17203 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17204 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17205 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17206 string characters.
17207
17208 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17209 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17210 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17211 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17212 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17213
17214
17215 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17216 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17217 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17218 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17219 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17220 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17221 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17222 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17223 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17224 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17225 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17226 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17227 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17228 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17229
17230
17231
17232 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17233 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17234 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17235 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17236 transport option of the same name.
17237
17238 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17239 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17240 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17241 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17242 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17243 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17244 the dnssec request bit set.
17245 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17246
17247 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17248 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17249 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17250 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17251 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17252 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17253 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17254 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17255 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17256
17257
17258 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17259 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17260 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17261 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17262 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17263 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17264 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17265 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17266
17267
17268
17269 .option driver routers string unset
17270 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17271 to be used.
17272
17273
17274 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17275 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17276 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17277 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17278 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17279 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17280 Not effective on redirect routers.
17281
17282
17283
17284 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17285 .cindex "envelope sender"
17286 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17287 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17288 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17289 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17290 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17291 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17292 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17293
17294 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17295 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17296 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17297 setting.
17298
17299 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17300 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17301 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17302 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17303
17304 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17305 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17306 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17307 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17308 settings:
17309 .code
17310 errors_to =
17311 errors_to = ""
17312 .endd
17313 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17314 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17315 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17316 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17317 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17318
17319 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17320 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17321 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17322 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17323 setting &%return_path%&.
17324
17325 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17326 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17327 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17328
17329
17330
17331 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17332 .cindex "address" "testing"
17333 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17334 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17335 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17336 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17337 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17338 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17339 on for the system alias file.
17340 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17341 are evaluated.
17342
17343 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17344 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17345 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17346
17347
17348
17349 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17350 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17351 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17352 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17353
17354
17355
17356 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17357 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17358 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17359
17360
17361
17362 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17363 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17364 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17365
17366
17367
17368 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17369 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17370 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17371 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17372 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17373 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17374 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17375 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17376 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17377
17378 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17379 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17380 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17381 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17382 transport for further details.
17383
17384
17385 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17386 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17387 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17388 .cindex "transport" "local"
17389 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17390 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17391 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17392 process.
17393 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17394 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17395 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17396 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17397 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17398
17399
17400
17401 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17402 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17403 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17404 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17405 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17406 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17407 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17408 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17409 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17410 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17411 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17412 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17413 &"see"& the added header lines.
17414
17415 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17416 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17417 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17418 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17419
17420 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17421 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17422
17423 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17424 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17425
17426 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17427 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17428 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17429 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17430 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17431 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17432 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17433 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17434 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17435 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17436
17437
17438
17439 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17440 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17441 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17442 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17443 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17444 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17445 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17446 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17447 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17448 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17449 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17450 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17451 &"see"& the original header lines.
17452
17453 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17454 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17455 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17456 errors.
17457
17458 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17459 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17460
17461 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17462 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17463
17464 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17465 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17466 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17467 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17468
17469 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17470 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17471 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17472
17473
17474
17475 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17476 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17477 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17478 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17479 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17480 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17481 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17482 like
17483 .code
17484 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17485 .endd
17486 by setting
17487 .code
17488 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17489 .endd
17490 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17491 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17492 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17493 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17494 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17495 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17496
17497 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17498 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17499 .code
17500 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17501 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17502 .endd
17503 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17504 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17505
17506 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17507 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17508 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17509 domain that is being routed.
17510
17511 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17512 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17513 checked.
17514
17515 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17516 .cindex "additional groups"
17517 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17518 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17519 .cindex "transport" "local"
17520 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17521 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17522 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17523 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17524 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17525
17526
17527
17528 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17529 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17530 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17531 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17532 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17533 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17534 evaluated.
17535
17536 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17537 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17538 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17539 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17540 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17541 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17542 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17543 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17544 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17545
17546 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17547 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17548 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17549 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17550 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17551 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17552 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17553 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17554 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17555 the relevant transport.
17556
17557 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17558 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17559 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17560 callout.
17561
17562 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17563 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17564 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17565 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17566 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17567 .code
17568 real_localuser:
17569 driver = accept
17570 local_part_prefix = real-
17571 check_local_user
17572 transport = local_delivery
17573 .endd
17574 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17575 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17576 .code
17577 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17578 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17579 .endd
17580
17581 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17582 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17583 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17584 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17585
17586
17587 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17588 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17589
17590
17591
17592 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17593 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17594 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17595 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17596 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17597 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17598 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17599 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17600 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17601 &%username-foo%&.
17602
17603
17604 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17605 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17606
17607
17608
17609 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17610 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17611 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17612 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17613 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17614 are evaluated, and
17615 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17616 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17617 example:
17618 .code
17619 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17620 .endd
17621 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17622 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17623 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17624 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17625 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17626 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17627 each virtual domain:
17628 .code
17629 postmaster:
17630 driver = redirect
17631 local_parts = postmaster
17632 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17633 .endd
17634
17635
17636 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17637 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17638 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17639 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17640 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17641 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17642 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17643 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17644 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17645 redirect addresses.
17646
17647
17648
17649 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17650 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17651 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17652 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17653 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17654 delivery to be deferred.
17655
17656 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17657 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17658 .oindex "&%self%&"
17659 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17660 means of the setting
17661 .code
17662 self = pass
17663 .endd
17664 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17665 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17666 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17667
17668 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17669 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17670 controls what happens next.
17671
17672
17673 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17674 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17675 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17676 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17677 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17678 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17679 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17680 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17681
17682 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17683 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17684 applies to all of them.
17685
17686
17687
17688 .option pass_router routers string unset
17689 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17690 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17691 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17692 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17693 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17694 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17695 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17696 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17697 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17698 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17699
17700
17701
17702 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17703 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17704 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17705 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17706 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17707 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17708
17709 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17710 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17711 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17712 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17713
17714
17715
17716 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17717 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17718 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17719 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17720 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17721 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17722 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17723
17724 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17725 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17726 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17727 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17728
17729 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17730 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17731 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17732 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17733 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17734
17735 .cindex "NFS"
17736 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17737 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17738 unavailable.
17739
17740 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17741 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17742 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17743 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17744 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17745 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17746 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17747 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17748
17749 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17750 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17751 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17752 operates as follows:
17753
17754 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17755 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17756 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17757 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17758 used. For example:
17759 .code
17760 require_files = mail:/some/file
17761 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17762 .endd
17763 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17764 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17765
17766 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17767 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17768 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17769 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17770
17771 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17772 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17773 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17774 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17775 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17776
17777 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17778 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17779 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17780 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17781 check again in that process.
17782
17783 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17784 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17785 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17786 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17787 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17788 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17789 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17790 .code
17791 require_files = +/some/file
17792 .endd
17793 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17794 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17795 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17796
17797
17798
17799 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17800 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17801 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17802 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17803 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17804 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17805 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17806 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17807 latter kind.
17808
17809 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17810 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17811 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17812 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17813 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17814 same name.
17815
17816 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17817 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17818 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17819
17820
17821
17822 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17823 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17824 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17825 .vindex "&$home$&"
17826 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17827 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17828 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17829 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17830 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17831 cause the router to defer.
17832
17833 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17834 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17835 place.
17836 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17837 are evaluated.)
17838 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17839 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17840
17841 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17842 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17843 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17844 of these values that is set:
17845
17846 .ilist
17847 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17848 .next
17849 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17850 .next
17851 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17852 .next
17853 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17854 .endlist
17855
17856 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17857 router, but not for the transport.
17858
17859
17860
17861 .option self routers string freeze
17862 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17863 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17864 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17865 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17866 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17867 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17868 of remote hosts.
17869 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17870 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17871 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17872 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17873 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17874
17875 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17876 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17877 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17878 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17879 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17880 cases:
17881
17882 .vlist
17883 .vitem &%defer%&
17884 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17885
17886 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17887 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17888 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17889 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17890
17891 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17892 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17893 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17894 rewritten.
17895
17896 .vitem &%pass%&
17897 .oindex "&%more%&"
17898 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17899 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17900 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17901 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17902 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17903 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17904 combination
17905 .code
17906 self = pass
17907 no_more
17908 .endd
17909 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17910 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17911 be passed to the next router.
17912
17913 .vitem &%fail%&
17914 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17915
17916 .vitem &%send%&
17917 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17918 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17919 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17920 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17921 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17922 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17923 .endlist
17924
17925
17926
17927 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17928 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17929 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17930 address matches something on the list.
17931 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17932 are evaluated.
17933
17934 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17935 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17936 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17937 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17938 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17939 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17940 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17941 matters.
17942
17943
17944 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17945 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17946 .cindex "packet radio"
17947 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17948 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17949 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17950 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17951 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17952 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17953 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17954 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17955
17956 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17957 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17958 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17959 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17960 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17961 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17962 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17963 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17964 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17965 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17966 .code
17967 translate_ip_address = \
17968 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17969 {$value}fail}}
17970 .endd
17971 The file would contain lines like
17972 .code
17973 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17974 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17975 .endd
17976 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17977 are doing.
17978
17979
17980
17981 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17982 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17983 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17984 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17985 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17986 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17987 delivery is deferred.
17988
17989 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17990 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17991 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17992
17993
17994
17995 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17996 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17997 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17998 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17999 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18000 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18001 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18002 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18003 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18004 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18005 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18006 environment.
18007
18008
18009
18010
18011 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18012 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18013 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18014 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18015 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18016 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18017 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18018 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18019 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18020 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18021
18022 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18023 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18024 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18025 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18026 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18027
18028 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18029 environment.
18030
18031
18032
18033
18034 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18035 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18036 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18037 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18038 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18039 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18040 delivery to be deferred.
18041
18042 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18043 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18044 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18045 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18046 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18047 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18048
18049 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18050 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18051 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18052 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18053 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18054 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18055 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18056 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18057
18058 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18059 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18060 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18061 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18062 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18063 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18064 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18065 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18066 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18067 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18068
18069 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18070 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18071 subsequent routers.
18072
18073
18074 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18075 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18076 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18077 .cindex "transport" "local"
18078 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18079 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18080 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18081 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18082 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18083 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18084 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18085 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18086 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18087 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18088 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18089 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18090
18091
18092
18093 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18094 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18095 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18096
18097
18098 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18099 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18100 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18101 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18102 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18103 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18104 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18105 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18106 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18107 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18108
18109 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18110 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18111 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18112 user or group.
18113
18114
18115 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18116 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18117 addresses,
18118 delivering in cutthrough mode
18119 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18120 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18121 are evaluated.
18122 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18123
18124
18125 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18126 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18127 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18128 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18129 are evaluated.
18130 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18131 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18132 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18133
18134
18135
18136
18137
18138
18139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18141
18142 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18143 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18144 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18145 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18146 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18147 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18148 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18149 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18150 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18151 .code
18152 localusers:
18153 driver = accept
18154 domains = mydomain.example
18155 check_local_user
18156 transport = local_delivery
18157 .endd
18158 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18159 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18160 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18161 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18162
18163
18164
18165
18166
18167
18168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18170
18171 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18172 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18173 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18174 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18175 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18176 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18177
18178 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18179 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18180 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18181 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18182 records.
18183
18184 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18185 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18186 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18187 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18188 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18189 generic option, the router declines.
18190
18191 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18192 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18193 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18194
18195 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18196 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18197 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18198 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18199 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18200 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18201
18202
18203 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18204 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18205 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18206 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18207 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18208 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18209
18210 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18211 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18212 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18213 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18214 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18215 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18216 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18217 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18218 case routing fails.
18219
18220
18221 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18222 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18223 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18224 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18225 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18226
18227 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18228 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18229
18230 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18231 .ilist
18232 The domain does not exist in DNS
18233 .next
18234 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18235 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18236 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18237 .next
18238 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18239 .next
18240 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18241 .next
18242 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18243 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18244 .next
18245 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18246 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18247 .next
18248 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18249 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18250 .next
18251 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18252 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18253 .endlist
18254
18255
18256
18257
18258 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18259 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18260 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18261
18262 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18263 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18264 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18265 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18266 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18267 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18268 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18269
18270
18271 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18272 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18273 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18274 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18275 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18276 required. For example,
18277 .code
18278 check_srv = smtp
18279 .endd
18280 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18281 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18282 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18283 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18284 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18285 normal way.
18286
18287 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18288 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18289 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18290 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18291 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18292 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18293
18294 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18295 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18296 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18297 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18298 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18299 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18300 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18301 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18302
18303 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18304 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18305
18306
18307
18308
18309 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18310 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18311 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18312 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18313 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18314 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18315 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18316 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18317 also being queued.
18318
18319
18320 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18321 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18322 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18323 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18324 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18325 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18326 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18327 setting:
18328 .code
18329 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18330 .endd
18331 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18332 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18333 the address record.
18334
18335
18336 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18337 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18338 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18339 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18340
18341
18342
18343
18344 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18345 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18346 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18347 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18348 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18349 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18350 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18351 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18352 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18353 &'resolv.conf'&.
18354
18355
18356
18357 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18358 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18359 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18360 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18361 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18362 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18363 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18364 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18365 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18366 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18367 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18368
18369 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18370 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18371 sense.
18372
18373 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18374 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18375 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18376 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18377 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18378 header rewriting.
18379
18380
18381 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18382 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18383 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18384 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18385 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18386 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18387 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18388 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18389
18390 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18391 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18392 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18393 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18394 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18395 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18396 without processing them independently,
18397 provided the following conditions are met:
18398
18399 .ilist
18400 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18401 &%headers_remove%&.
18402 .next
18403 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18404 the domain.
18405 .endlist
18406
18407
18408
18409
18410 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18411 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18412 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18413 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18414 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18415 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18416 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18417 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18418 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18419 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18420
18421 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18422 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18423 local wildcard.
18424
18425
18426
18427 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18428 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18429 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18430 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18431
18432
18433
18434
18435 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18436 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18437 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18438 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18439 if
18440 .code
18441 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18442 .endd
18443 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18444 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18445 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18446 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18447 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18448 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18449
18450
18451 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18452 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18453 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18454 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18455 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18456
18457 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18458 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18459 such as that implied by
18460 .code
18461 domains = @mx_any
18462 .endd
18463 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18464 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18465 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18466 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18467
18468
18469
18470
18471
18472
18473
18474
18475
18476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18478
18479 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18480 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18481 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18482 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18483 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18484 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18485 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18486 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18487 router handles the address
18488 .code
18489 root@[192.168.1.1]
18490 .endd
18491 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18492 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18493 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18494 .code
18495 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18496 .endd
18497 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18498 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18499
18500 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18501 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18502 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18503 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18504
18505 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18506 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18507 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18508 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18509
18510
18511
18512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18514
18515 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18516 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18517 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18518 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18519 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18520 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18521 must set
18522 .code
18523 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18524 .endd
18525 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18526
18527 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18528 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18529 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18530 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18531 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18532 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18533 must not be specified for it.
18534
18535 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18536 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18537 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18538 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18539 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18540 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18541 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18542
18543
18544 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18545 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18546 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18547 delivery to the address is deferred.
18548
18549
18550 .option port iplookup integer 0
18551 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18552 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18553 call.
18554
18555
18556 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18557 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18558 protocols is to be used.
18559
18560
18561 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18562 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18563 default value is:
18564 .code
18565 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18566 .endd
18567 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18568 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18569
18570
18571 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18572 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18573 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18574 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18575 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18576 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18577 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18578 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18579
18580
18581 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18582 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18583 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18584 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18585 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18586 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18587 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18588 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18589 following could be used:
18590 .code
18591 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18592 reroute = $local_part@$1
18593 .endd
18594
18595 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18596 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18597 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18598 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18599
18600
18601
18602
18603 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18605
18606 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18607 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18608 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18609 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18610 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18611 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18612 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18613 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18614 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18615 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18616
18617 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18618 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18619 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18620 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18621 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18622 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18623 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18624
18625 .vindex "&$host$&"
18626 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18627 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18628 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18629 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18630 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18631 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18632 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18633 text string.
18634
18635 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18636 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18637 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18638 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18639 below, following the list of private options.
18640
18641
18642 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18643
18644 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18645 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18646
18647 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18648 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18649
18650 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18651 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18652 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18653 of the following values:
18654 .code
18655 decline
18656 defer
18657 fail
18658 freeze
18659 ignore
18660 pass
18661 .endd
18662 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18663 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18664 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18665 &%pass_router%&),
18666 .oindex "&%more%&"
18667 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18668 router only if &%more%& is true.
18669
18670 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18671 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18672 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18673 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18674
18675 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18676 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18677 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18678
18679
18680 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18681 .cindex "randomized host list"
18682 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18683 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18684 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18685 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18686 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18687 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18688 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18689 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18690
18691 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18692 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18693 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18694 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18695 .code
18696 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18697 .endd
18698 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18699 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18700 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18701 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18702 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18703
18704
18705 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18706 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18707 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18708 example:
18709 .code
18710 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18711 .endd
18712 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18713 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18714 deferred.
18715
18716
18717 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18718 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18719 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18720 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18721
18722
18723 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18724 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18725 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18726 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18727 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18728 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18729 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18730 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18731
18732 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18733 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18734 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18735 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18736 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18737 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18738 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18739 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18740
18741
18742
18743
18744 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18745 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18746 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18747 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18748 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18749 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18750 .display
18751 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18752 .endd
18753 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18754 no options:
18755 .code
18756 route_list = \
18757 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18758 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18759 .endd
18760 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18761 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18762 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18763 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18764 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18765 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18766 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18767 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18768 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18769 in a &%route_list%&).
18770
18771 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18772 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18773 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18774 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18775
18776
18777
18778 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18779 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18780 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18781 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18782 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18783 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18784 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18785 like this:
18786 .code
18787 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18788 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18789 .endd
18790 This data can be accessed by setting
18791 .code
18792 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18793 .endd
18794 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18795 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18796 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18797 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18798 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18799
18800
18801
18802
18803 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18804 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18805 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18806 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18807 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18808 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18809 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18810
18811 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18812 variables are set during its expansion:
18813
18814 .ilist
18815 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18816 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18817 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18818 .code
18819 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18820 .endd
18821 .next
18822 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18823 .next
18824 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18825
18826 .next
18827 .vindex "&$value$&"
18828 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18829 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18830 .code
18831 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18832 .endd
18833 .endlist
18834
18835 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18836 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18837
18838
18839
18840 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18841 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18842 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18843 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18844 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18845 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18846
18847 .ilist
18848 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18849 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18850 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18851 .code
18852 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18853 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18854 .endd
18855 .next
18856 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18857 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18858 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18859 number follows. For example:
18860 .code
18861 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18862 .endd
18863 .endlist
18864
18865 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18866 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18867 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18868 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18869 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18870 transport.
18871
18872 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18873 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18874 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18875 records in the DNS. For example:
18876 .code
18877 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18878 .endd
18879 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18880 example:
18881 .code
18882 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18883 .endd
18884 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18885 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18886 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18887 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18888 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18889 happens is controlled by the
18890 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18891 &%self%& option of the router.
18892
18893 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18894 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18895 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18896 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18897 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18898 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18899 defined by MX preferences.
18900
18901 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18902 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18903 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18904
18905 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18906 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18907 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18908 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18909
18910 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18911 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18912 router.
18913
18914 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18915 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18916 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18917
18918 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18919 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18920
18921
18922
18923 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18924 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18925 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18926 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18927 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18928 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18929 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18930
18931 .ilist
18932 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18933 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18934 .next
18935 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18936 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18937 .next
18938 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18939 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18940 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18941 .next
18942 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18943 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18944 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18945 .endlist
18946
18947 For example:
18948 .code
18949 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18950 domain2 host4:host5
18951 .endd
18952 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18953 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18954 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18955 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18956 call.
18957
18958 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18959 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18960 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18961 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18962 function called.
18963
18964
18965
18966 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18967 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18968
18969 .vindex "&$host$&"
18970 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18971 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18972
18973
18974
18975 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18976 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18977 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18978
18979 .ilist
18980 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18981 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18982 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18983 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18984 .code
18985 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18986 .endd
18987 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18988 your first router something like this:
18989 .code
18990 smart_route:
18991 driver = manualroute
18992 domains = !+local_domains
18993 transport = remote_smtp
18994 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18995 .endd
18996 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18997 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18998 they are tried in order
18999 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19000 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19001 .code
19002 smart_route:
19003 driver = manualroute
19004 transport = remote_smtp
19005 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19006 .endd
19007 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19008 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19009 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19010 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19011 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19012 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19013 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19014 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19015
19016 .next
19017 .cindex "mail hub example"
19018 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19019 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19020 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19021 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19022 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19023 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19024 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19025 lookup is easier to manage.
19026
19027 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19028 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19029 example:
19030 .code
19031 hub_route:
19032 driver = manualroute
19033 transport = remote_smtp
19034 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19035 .endd
19036 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19037 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19038 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19039 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19040 domain can be used to find the host:
19041 .code
19042 through_firewall:
19043 driver = manualroute
19044 transport = remote_smtp
19045 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19046 .endd
19047 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19048 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19049 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19050 next router.
19051
19052 .next
19053 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19054 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19055 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19056 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19057 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19058 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19059 .code
19060 save_in_file:
19061 driver = manualroute
19062 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19063 route_list = saved.domain.example
19064 .endd
19065 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19066 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19067 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19068 .code
19069 save_in_file:
19070 driver = manualroute
19071 route_list = \
19072 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19073 *.saved.domain2.example \
19074 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19075 batch_pipe
19076 .endd
19077 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19078 .vindex "&$host$&"
19079 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19080 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19081 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19082 the address if the lookup fails.
19083
19084 .next
19085 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19086 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19087 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19088 one way it can be done:
19089 .code
19090 # Transport
19091 uucp:
19092 driver = pipe
19093 user = nobody
19094 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19095 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19096 return_fail_output = true
19097
19098 # Router
19099 uucphost:
19100 transport = uucp
19101 driver = manualroute
19102 route_data = \
19103 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19104 .endd
19105 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19106 .code
19107 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19108 .endd
19109 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19110 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19111 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19112 .endlist
19113 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19114 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19115
19116
19117
19118
19119
19120
19121
19122
19123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19125
19126 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19127 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19128 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19129 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19130 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19131 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19132 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19133 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19134 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19135 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19136 options:
19137 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19138
19139 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19140 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19141 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19142 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19143 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19144
19145
19146 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19147 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19148 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19149 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19150 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19151 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19152
19153
19154 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19155 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19156 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19157 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19158 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19159 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19160 not set, a value for the gid also.
19161
19162 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19163 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19164 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19165 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19166 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19167 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19168 gid.
19169
19170
19171 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19172 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19173 before running the command.
19174
19175
19176 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19177 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19178 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19179 timeout.
19180
19181
19182 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19183 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19184 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19185 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19186 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19187
19188 .ilist
19189 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19190 below).
19191 .next
19192 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19193 &%no_more%& is set.
19194 .next
19195 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19196 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19197 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19198 included in the SMTP response.
19199 .next
19200 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19201 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19202 included in any SMTP response.
19203 .next
19204 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19205 .next
19206 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19207 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19208 .next
19209 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19210 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19211 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19212 .endlist
19213
19214 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19215 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19216 the page):
19217 .code
19218 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19219 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19220 .endd
19221 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19222 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19223 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19224 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19225
19226 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19227 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19228 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19229 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19230 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19231
19232 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19233 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19234 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19235 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19236 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19237
19238 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19239 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19240 variable. For example, this return line
19241 .code
19242 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19243 .endd
19244 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19245 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19246 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19247 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19248
19249
19250
19251
19252 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19253 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19254
19255 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19256 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19257 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19258 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19259 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19260 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19261 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19262 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19263 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19264 redirected in several different ways:
19265
19266 .ilist
19267 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19268 independently.
19269 .next
19270 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19271 .next
19272 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19273 .next
19274 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19275 .next
19276 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19277 .next
19278 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19279 .next
19280 It can be discarded.
19281 .endlist
19282
19283 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19284 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19285 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19286 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19287
19288 If success DSNs have been requested
19289 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19290 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19291 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19292
19293
19294
19295 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19296 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19297 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19298 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19299 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19300 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19301 .code
19302 system_aliases:
19303 driver = redirect
19304 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19305 .endd
19306 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19307 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19308 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19309 cause delivery to be deferred.
19310
19311 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19312 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19313 .code
19314 userforward:
19315 driver = redirect
19316 check_local_user
19317 file = $home/.forward
19318 no_verify
19319 .endd
19320 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19321 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19322 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19323 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19324 comments.
19325
19326
19327
19328 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19329 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19330 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19331 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19332
19333 .ilist
19334 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19335 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19336 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19337 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19338 .next
19339 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19340 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19341 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19342 saves some resources.
19343 .endlist
19344
19345
19346
19347
19348
19349
19350 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19351 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19352 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19353 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19354 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19355
19356 .ilist
19357 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19358 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19359 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19360 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19361 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19362 document is intended for use by end users.
19363 .next
19364 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19365 described in the next section.
19366 .endlist
19367
19368 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19369 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19370 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19371 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19372 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19373
19374
19375
19376 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19377 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19378 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19379 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19380 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19381 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19382 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19383 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19384 commas or newlines.
19385 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19386 quotes.
19387
19388 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19389 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19390 next newline character is ignored.
19391
19392 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19393 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19394 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19395 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19396 removed.
19397
19398 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19399 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19400 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19401 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19402 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19403 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19404 setting:
19405 .code
19406 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19407 .endd
19408
19409
19410 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19411 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19412 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19413 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19414 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19415 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19416 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19417 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19418 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19419 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19420 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19421
19422 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19423 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19424 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19425 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19426 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19427 .code
19428 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19429 .endd
19430 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19431 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19432 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19433 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19434 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19435 synonymously.
19436
19437 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19438 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19439 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19440 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19441 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19442
19443 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19444 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19445 contains:
19446 .code
19447 Sam.Reman: spqr
19448 .endd
19449 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19450 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19451 this forward file:
19452 .code
19453 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19454 .endd
19455 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19456 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19457 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19458 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19459 should really contain
19460 .code
19461 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19462 .endd
19463 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19464 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19465 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19466
19467
19468
19469 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19470 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19471 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19472
19473 .ilist
19474 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19475 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19476 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19477 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19478 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19479 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19480 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19481
19482 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19483 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19484 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19485 in double quotes, for example:
19486 .code
19487 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19488 .endd
19489 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19490 quote just the command. An item such as
19491 .code
19492 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19493 .endd
19494 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19495
19496 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19497 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19498 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19499 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19500 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19501 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19502 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19503 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19504 an &%accept%& router.
19505
19506 .next
19507 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19508 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19509 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19510 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19511 .code
19512 /home/world/minbari
19513 .endd
19514 is treated as a file name, but
19515 .code
19516 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19517 .endd
19518 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19519 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19520 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19521 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19522
19523 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19524 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19525
19526 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19527 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19528 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19529 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19530
19531 .next
19532 .cindex "included address list"
19533 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19534 If an item is of the form
19535 .code
19536 :include:<path name>
19537 .endd
19538 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19539 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19540 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19541 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19542 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19543 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19544 .code
19545 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19546 .endd
19547 It must be given as
19548 .code
19549 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19550 .endd
19551 .next
19552 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19553 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19554 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19555 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19556 .cindex "black hole"
19557 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19558 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19559 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19560 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19561
19562 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19563 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19564 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19565 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19566 &_/dev/null_&.
19567
19568 .next
19569 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19570 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19571 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19572 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19573 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19574 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19575 redirection items of the form
19576 .code
19577 :defer:
19578 :fail:
19579 .endd
19580 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19581 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19582 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19583 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19584 .code
19585 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19586 .endd
19587 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19588 of a
19589 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19590 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19591 default.
19592 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19593 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19594 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19595
19596 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19597 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19598 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19599 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19600 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19601 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19602 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19603 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19604 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19605 ignored.
19606
19607 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19608 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19609 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19610 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19611
19612 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19613 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19614 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19615 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19616 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19617
19618 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19619 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19620 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19621 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19622 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19623 rules still apply.
19624
19625 .next
19626 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19627 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19628 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19629 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19630 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19631 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19632 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19633 .endlist
19634
19635
19636 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19637 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19638 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19639 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19640 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19641 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19642 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19643 aliasing scheme of the type
19644 .code
19645 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19646 localpart1: pipe
19647 localpart2: pipe
19648 .endd
19649 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19650 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19651 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19652 such as
19653 .code
19654 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19655 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19656 .endd
19657 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19658 the pipes are distinct.
19659
19660
19661
19662 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19663 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19664 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19665 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19666 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19667 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19668 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19669 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19670 can be used to avoid this.
19671
19672
19673 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19674 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19675 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19676 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19677 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19678 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19679 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19680
19681
19682
19683 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19684
19685 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19686 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19687
19688
19689 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19690 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19691 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19692
19693
19694 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19695 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19696 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19697 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19698
19699
19700 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19701 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19702 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19703 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19704 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19705 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19706 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19707
19708 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19709 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19710
19711
19712 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19713 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19714 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19715 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19716 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19717
19718
19719
19720 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19721 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19722 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19723 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19724 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19725 let ordinary users do.
19726
19727
19728
19729 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19730 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19731 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19732 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19733 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19734 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19735
19736 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19737 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19738 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19739 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19740 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19741 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19742 .code
19743 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19744 .endd
19745 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19746 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19747 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19748 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19749 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19750 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19751 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19752 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19753
19754
19755 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19756 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19757 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19758 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19759 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19760 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19761 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19762 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19763
19764
19765
19766 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19767 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19768 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19769 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19770 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19771 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19772
19773
19774 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19775 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19776 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19777 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19778 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19779 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19780
19781 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19782 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19783 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19784 .code
19785 data = #Exim filter\n\
19786 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19787 .endd
19788 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19789 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19790 choice into a newline.
19791
19792
19793 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19794 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19795 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19796 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19797 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19798
19799
19800 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19801 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19802 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19803 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19804 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19805 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19806 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19807 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19808
19809 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19810 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19811 runs a check on the containing directory,
19812 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19813 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19814 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19815 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19816 not, the router declines.
19817
19818
19819 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19820 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19821 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19822 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19823 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19824 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19825 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19826
19827
19828 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19829 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19830 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19831 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19832 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19833
19834
19835 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19836 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19837 redirection list.
19838
19839
19840 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19841 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19842 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19843
19844
19845
19846
19847 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19848 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19849 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19850 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19851 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19852 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19853 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19854 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19855 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19856
19857
19858 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19859 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19860 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19861 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19862 functions.
19863
19864 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19865 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19866 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19867 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19868
19869 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19870 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19871 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19872 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19873 &_.forward_& files).
19874
19875
19876 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19877 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19878 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19879
19880
19881 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19882 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19883 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19884 of the embedded Perl support.
19885
19886
19887 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19888 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19889 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19890
19891
19892 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19893 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19894 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19895
19896
19897 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19898 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19899 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19900 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19901 &%one_time%& is set.
19902
19903
19904 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19905 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19906 to make use of &%run%& items.
19907
19908
19909 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19910 If this option is true, items of the form
19911 .code
19912 :include:<path name>
19913 .endd
19914 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19915
19916
19917 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19918 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19919 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19920 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19921 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19922
19923
19924 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19925 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19926 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19927
19928
19929 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19930 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19931 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19932 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19933 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19934
19935
19936
19937
19938 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19939 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19940 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19941 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19942 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19943 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19944 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19945
19946
19947 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19948 .cindex "EACCES"
19949 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19950 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19951 file did not exist.
19952
19953
19954 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19955 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19956 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19957 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19958 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19959
19960 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19961 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19962 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19963 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19964 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19965 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19966 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19967 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19968
19969
19970
19971 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19972 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19973 redirection list must start with this directory.
19974
19975
19976 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19977 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19978 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19979
19980
19981 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19982 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19983 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19984 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19985 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19986 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19987 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19988 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19989 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19990 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19991 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19992 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19993 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19994 before they subscribed.
19995
19996 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19997 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19998 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19999 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20000 attempt.
20001
20002 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20003 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20004 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20005 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20006
20007 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20008 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20009 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20010
20011 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20012 &%one_time%&.
20013
20014 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20015 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20016 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20017 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20018 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20019 expansion.
20020
20021
20022 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20023 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20024 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20025 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20026 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20027 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20028 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20029 See &%check_owner%& above.
20030
20031
20032 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20033 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20034 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20035 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20036
20037
20038 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20039 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20040 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20041 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20042 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20043 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20044 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20045
20046
20047 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20048 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20049 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20050 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20051 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20052 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20053 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20054 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20055
20056 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20057 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20058 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20059 addresses.
20060
20061 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20062 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20063 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20064 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20065 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20066 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20067 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20068 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20069 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20070 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20071
20072
20073 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20074 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20075 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20076 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20077 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20078 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20079
20080
20081 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20082 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20083 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20084 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20085 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20086 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20087
20088
20089 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20090 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20091 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20092 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20093 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20094
20095
20096 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20097 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20098 :subaddress part of an address.
20099
20100 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20101 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20102 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20103 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20104
20105
20106 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20107 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20108 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20109 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20110 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20111 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20112 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20113
20114
20115
20116 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20117 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20118 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20119 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20120 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20121 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20122 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20123 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20124 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20125 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20126 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20127 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20128 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20129 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20130 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20131 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20132
20133 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20134 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20135 the following routers.
20136
20137 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20138 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20139 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20140 so it is passed to the following routers.
20141
20142 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20143 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20144 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20145 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20146
20147 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20148 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20149 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20150 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20151 .code
20152 userforward:
20153 driver = redirect
20154 allow_filter
20155 check_local_user
20156 file = $home/.forward
20157 file_transport = address_file
20158 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20159 reply_transport = address_reply
20160 no_verify
20161 skip_syntax_errors
20162 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20163 syntax_errors_text = \
20164 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20165 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20166 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20167 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20168 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20169 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20170 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20171 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20172 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20173 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20174 .endd
20175 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20176 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20177 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20178 .code
20179 real_localuser:
20180 driver = accept
20181 check_local_user
20182 local_part_prefix = real-
20183 transport = local_delivery
20184 .endd
20185 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20186 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20187 .code
20188 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20189 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20190 .endd
20191
20192
20193 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20194 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20195
20196
20197 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20198 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20199 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20200 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20201
20202
20203
20204
20205
20206
20207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20209
20210 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20211 "Environment for local transports"
20212 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20213 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20214 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20215 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20216 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20217 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20218 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20219
20220 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20221 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20222 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20223 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20224
20225 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20226 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20227 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20228 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20229 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20230
20231
20232
20233 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20234 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20235 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20236 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20237 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20238 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20239 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20240 time.
20241
20242 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20243 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20244 .code
20245 my_transport:
20246 driver = pipe
20247 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20248 .endd
20249 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20250 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20251 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20252 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20253
20254
20255
20256
20257 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20258 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20259 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20260 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20261 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20262 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20263 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20264 group (set by the transport). For example:
20265 .code
20266 # Routers ...
20267 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20268 local_users:
20269 driver = accept
20270 check_local_user
20271 transport = group_delivery
20272
20273 # Transports ...
20274 # This transport overrides the group
20275 group_delivery:
20276 driver = appendfile
20277 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20278 group = mail
20279 .endd
20280 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20281 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20282 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20283 set.
20284
20285 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20286 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20287 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20288 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20289 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20290 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20291
20292 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20293 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20294 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20295 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20296 original gid is also used.
20297
20298 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20299 following that is set is used:
20300
20301 .ilist
20302 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20303 .next
20304 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20305 .next
20306 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20307 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20308 .next
20309 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20310 .next
20311 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20312 the uid is the creator's uid;
20313 .next
20314 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20315 .endlist
20316
20317 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20318 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20319 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20320 The first of the following that is set is used:
20321
20322 .ilist
20323 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20324 .next
20325 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20326 .next
20327 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20328 .next
20329 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20330 .next
20331 The Exim uid.
20332 .endlist
20333
20334 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20335 &%never_users%& list.
20336
20337
20338
20339
20340
20341 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20342 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20343 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20344 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20345 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20346 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20347 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20348 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20349 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20350 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20351
20352 .ilist
20353 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20354 .next
20355 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20356 .next
20357 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20358 .next
20359 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20360 .endlist
20361
20362 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20363
20364 .ilist
20365 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20366 .next
20367 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20368 .endlist
20369
20370
20371 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20372 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20373 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20374
20375
20376
20377 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20378 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20379 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20380 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20381 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20382 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20383 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20384 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20385 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20386 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20387 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20388 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20389 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20390 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20391
20392
20393
20394
20395
20396
20397
20398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20400
20401 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20402 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20403 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20404 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20405 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20406
20407
20408 .option body_only transports boolean false
20409 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20410 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20411 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20412 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20413 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20414 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20415 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20416 automatically suppress them.
20417
20418
20419 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20420 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20421 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20422 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20423 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20424 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20425
20426
20427 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20428 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20429 deliveries by the transport or for any
20430 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20431 what you are doing.
20432
20433
20434 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20435 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20436 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20437 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20438 transport is run.
20439 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20440 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20441 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20442 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20443 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20444 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20445 one.
20446 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20447 transport and the router that called it.
20448
20449 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20450 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20451 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20452 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20453 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20454 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20455 safely be resent to other recipients.
20456
20457
20458 .option driver transports string unset
20459 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20460 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20461
20462
20463 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20464 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20465 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20466 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20467 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20468 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20469 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20470 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20471 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20472 resent to other recipients.
20473
20474
20475 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20476 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20477 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20478 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20479 &%user%& (see below).
20480
20481
20482 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20483 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20484 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20485 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20486 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20487 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20488 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20489 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20490 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20491 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20492 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20493
20494 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20495 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20496
20497
20498 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20499 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20500 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20501 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20502 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20503 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20504 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20505 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20506
20507
20508 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20509 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20510 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20511 This option specifies a list of header names,
20512 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20513 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20514 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20515 routers.
20516 Each list item is separately expanded.
20517 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20518 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20519 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20520
20521 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20522 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20523
20524 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20525 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20526 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20527
20528
20529
20530 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20531 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20532 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20533 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20534 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20535 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20536 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20537 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20538 example,
20539 .code
20540 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20541 x@y w@z
20542 .endd
20543 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20544 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20545 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20546 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20547 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20548 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20549 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20550 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20551 change envelope recipients at this time.
20552
20553
20554 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20555 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20556 .vindex "&$home$&"
20557 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20558 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20559 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20560 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20561 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20562 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20563 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20564 deferred.
20565
20566
20567 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20568 .cindex "additional groups"
20569 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20570 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20571 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20572 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20573 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20574
20575
20576 .new
20577 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20578 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20579 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20580 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20581 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20582 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20583 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20584 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20585
20586 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20587 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20588 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20589 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20590 Obviously there is scope for
20591 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20592 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20593
20594 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20595 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20596 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20597 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20598 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20599 .wen
20600
20601
20602 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20603 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20604 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20605 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20606 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20607 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20608 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20609 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20610 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20611 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20612 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20613 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20614 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20615 delivered.
20616
20617
20618
20619 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20620 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20621 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20622 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20623 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20624 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20625 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20626 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20627 that contains
20628 .code
20629 local_part_prefix = *-
20630 .endd
20631 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20632 is delivered with
20633 .code
20634 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20635 .endd
20636 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20637 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20638 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20639 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20640 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20641
20642
20643 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20644 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20645 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20646 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20647 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20648 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20649 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20650 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20651 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20652
20653 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20654 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20655 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20656 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20657
20658 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20659 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20660 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20661
20662
20663 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20664 .cindex "envelope sender"
20665 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20666 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20667 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20668 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20669 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20670 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20671 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20672 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20673 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20674
20675 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20676 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20677
20678 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20679 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20680 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20681 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20682 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20683 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20684 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20685
20686 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20687 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20688 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20689 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20690 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20691
20692
20693
20694 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20695 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20696 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20697 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20698 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20699 have easy access to it.
20700
20701 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20702 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20703 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20704 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20705 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20706 recipients.
20707
20708
20709 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20710 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20711
20712
20713 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20714 .cindex "shadow transport"
20715 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20716 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20717 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20718
20719 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20720 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20721 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20722 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20723 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20724 cause a log line to be written.
20725
20726 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20727 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20728 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20729 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20730 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20731 of the form
20732 .code
20733 ST=<shadow transport name>
20734 .endd
20735 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20736 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20737 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20738 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20739 headers that some sites insist on.
20740
20741
20742 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20743 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20744 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20745 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20746 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20747 individual users or via a system filter.
20748 .new
20749 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20750 .wen
20751
20752 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20753 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20754 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20755 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20756 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20757
20758 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20759 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20760 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20761 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20762 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20763 &(pipe)& transports.
20764
20765 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20766 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20767 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20768 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20769 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20770
20771 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20772 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20773 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20774 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20775
20776 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20777 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20778 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20779 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20780 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20781 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20782
20783 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20784 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20785 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20786 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20787 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20788 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20789 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20790 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20791
20792 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20793 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20794 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20795 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20796 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20797 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20798 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20799 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20800 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20801 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20802
20803 .vindex "&$host$&"
20804 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20805 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20806 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20807 which the message is being sent. For example:
20808 .code
20809 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20810 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20811 .endd
20812
20813 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20814 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20815 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20816 .ilist
20817 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20818 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20819 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20820 example:
20821 .code
20822 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20823 .endd
20824 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20825 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20826 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20827 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20828 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20829 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20830 .next
20831 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20832 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20833 arguments. Consider this example:
20834 .code
20835 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20836 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20837 .endd
20838 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20839 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20840 .code
20841 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20842 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20843 .endd
20844 .endlist
20845
20846 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20847 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20848 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20849 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20850 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20851 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20852 bounced from a transport filter.
20853
20854 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20855 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20856 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20857
20858
20859 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20860 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20861 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20862 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20863 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20864 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20865 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20866 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20867 becomes a temporary error.
20868
20869
20870 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20871 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20872 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20873 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20874 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20875 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20876 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20877 option is not set.
20878
20879 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20880 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20881 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20882
20883 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20884 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20885 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20886 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20887 retry data.
20888 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20889 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20890 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20891
20892
20893
20894
20895
20896
20897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20899
20900 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20901 "Address batching"
20902 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20903 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20904 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20905 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20906 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20907 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20908 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20909
20910 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20911 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20912 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20913 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20914 local transport, for example:
20915
20916 .ilist
20917 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20918 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20919 recipients saves space.
20920 .next
20921 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20922 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20923 .next
20924 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20925 to a scanner program or
20926 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20927 acceptable.
20928 .endlist
20929
20930 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20931 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20932 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20933
20934 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20935 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20936 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20937 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20938 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20939 to certain conditions:
20940
20941 .ilist
20942 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20943 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20944 batching is possible.
20945 .next
20946 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20947 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20948 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20949 .next
20950 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20951 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20952 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20953 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20954 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20955 from taking place.
20956 .next
20957 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20958 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20959 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20960 be the same.
20961 .endlist
20962
20963 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20964 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20965 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20966 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20967 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20968 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20969 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20970 .code
20971 check_string = "."
20972 escape_string = ".."
20973 .endd
20974 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20975 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20976 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20977
20978 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20979 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20980 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20981 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20982 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20983 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20984
20985 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20986 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20987 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20988 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20989 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20990 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20991 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20992 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20993 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20994
20995
20996
20997
20998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20999 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21000
21001 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21002 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21003 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21004 .cindex "directory creation"
21005 .cindex "creating directories"
21006 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21007 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21008 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21009 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21010 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21011 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21012 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21013 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21014 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21015 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21016
21017 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21018 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21019 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21020 included.
21021
21022 .cindex "quota" "system"
21023 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21024 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21025 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21026
21027 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21028 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21029 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21030 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21031
21032 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21033 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21034 private options.
21035
21036 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21037 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21038 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21039 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21040 option).
21041
21042
21043
21044 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21045 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21046 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21047 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21048 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21049
21050 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21051 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21052 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21053 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21054 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21055 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21056 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21057 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21058 operation. There are two cases:
21059
21060 .ilist
21061 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21062 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21063 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21064 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21065 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21066 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21067 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21068 .next
21069 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21070 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21071 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21072 .endlist
21073
21074
21075 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21076 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21077 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21078 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21079 form:
21080 .code
21081 save folder23
21082 .endd
21083 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21084 .code
21085 require "fileinto";
21086 fileinto "folder23";
21087 .endd
21088 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21089 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21090 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21091 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21092 way of handling this requirement:
21093 .code
21094 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21095 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21096 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21097 {$address_file} \
21098 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21099 }} \
21100 }
21101 .endd
21102 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21103 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21104 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21105
21106 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21107 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21108 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21109 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21110 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21111 path to the transport.
21112
21113 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21114 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21115
21116
21117
21118
21119 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21120 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21121
21122
21123
21124 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21125 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21126 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21127 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21128 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21129 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21130 delivery is deferred.
21131
21132
21133 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21134 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21135 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21136 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21137 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21138 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21139 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21140 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21141
21142
21143 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21144 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21145 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21146 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21147 file.
21148
21149
21150 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21151 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21152
21153
21154 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21155 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21156 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21157 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21158 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21159
21160
21161 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21162 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21163 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21164 process is running.
21165
21166
21167 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21168 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21169 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21170 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21171 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21172 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21173 contains is significant.
21174
21175 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21176 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21177 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21178 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21179 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21180
21181 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21182 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21183 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21184 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21185 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21186 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21187 .code
21188 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21189 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21190 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21191 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21192 .endd
21193 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21194 .cindex "directory creation"
21195 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21196 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21197 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21198
21199 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21200 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21201 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21202 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21203 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21204
21205
21206
21207 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21208 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21209 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21210 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21211 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21212 beneath.
21213
21214 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21215 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21216 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21217 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21218 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21219 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21220 &%file_must_exist%&.
21221
21222
21223 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21224 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21225 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21226 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21227
21228 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21229 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21230 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21231 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21232 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21233
21234
21235 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21236 .cindex "base62"
21237 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21238 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21239 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21240 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21241 .code
21242 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21243 .endd
21244 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21245 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21246 option.
21247
21248
21249 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21250 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21251 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21252
21253
21254 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21255 See &%check_string%& above.
21256
21257
21258 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21259 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21260 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21261 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21262 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21263 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21264 &%file%&.
21265
21266 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21267 .cindex "locking files"
21268 .cindex "lock files"
21269 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21270 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21271
21272 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21273 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21274 examples:
21275 .code
21276 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21277 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21278 file = $home/inbox
21279 .endd
21280 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21281 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21282 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21283 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21284 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21285 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21286
21287
21288
21289 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21290 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21291 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21292 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21293 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21294 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21295 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21296 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21297 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21298 this added to it:
21299 .code
21300 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21301 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21302 .endd
21303 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21304 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21305 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21306 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21307 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21308 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21309 delivery is deferred.
21310
21311
21312 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21313 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21314 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21315 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21316
21317
21318 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21319 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21320 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21321 .cindex "locking files"
21322 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21323 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21324 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21325 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21326 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21327 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21328 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21329 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21330
21331 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21332 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21333 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21334 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21335
21336 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21337 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21338 retries is
21339 .code
21340 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21341 .endd
21342 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21343 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21344 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21345
21346 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21347 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21348 .code
21349 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21350 .endd
21351
21352 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21353 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21354 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21355 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21356
21357
21358 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21359 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21360 for details of locking.
21361
21362
21363 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21364 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21365 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21366
21367
21368 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21369 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21370 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21371
21372
21373 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21374 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21375 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21376 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21377 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21378
21379
21380 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21381 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21382 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21383 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21384 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21385 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21386 external source that maintains the data.
21387
21388
21389 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21390 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21391 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21392 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21393 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21394 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21395 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21396 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21397
21398
21399
21400 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21401 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21402 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21403 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21404 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21405 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21406 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21407 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21408 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21409 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21410
21411
21412 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21413 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21414 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21415 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21416 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21417 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21418 calculation. The default value is:
21419 .code
21420 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21421 .endd
21422 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21423 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21424 &_Trash_&
21425 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21426 .code
21427 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21428 .endd
21429 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21430 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21431 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21432 directly into that directory.
21433
21434
21435 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21436 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21437 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21438
21439
21440 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21441 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21442 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21443
21444
21445 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21446 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21447 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21448 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21449 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21450 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21451 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21452 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21453
21454 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21455 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21456 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21457 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21458 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21459 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21460 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21461 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21462 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21463 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21464
21465
21466 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21467 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21468 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21469 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21470 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21471 below for further details.
21472
21473
21474 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21475 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21476 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21477
21478
21479 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21480 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21481 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21482
21483
21484 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21485 .cindex "locking files"
21486 .cindex "file" "locking"
21487 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21488 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21489 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21490 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21491 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21492 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21493 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21494
21495 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21496 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21497 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21498 combination:
21499 .code
21500 mbx_format = true
21501 message_prefix =
21502 message_suffix =
21503 .endd
21504 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21505 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21506 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21507 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21508 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21509 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21510 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21511 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21512
21513 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21514 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21515 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21516 append messages to it.
21517
21518
21519 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21520 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21521 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21522 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21523 in which case it is:
21524 .code
21525 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21526 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21527 .endd
21528 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21529 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21530
21531 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21532 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21533 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21534 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21535 setting
21536 .code
21537 message_suffix =
21538 .endd
21539 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21540 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21541
21542 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21543 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21544 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21545 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21546 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21547 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21548 value, and this option is ignored.
21549
21550
21551 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21552 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21553 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21554 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21555 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21556
21557
21558 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21559 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21560 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21561 on users about incoming mail.
21562
21563
21564 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21565 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21566 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21567 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21568 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21569 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21570 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21571 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21572 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21573
21574 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21575 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21576 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21577
21578 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21579 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21580 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21581 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21582 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21583 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21584
21585 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21586 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21587 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21588 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21589 be handled.
21590
21591 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21592
21593 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21594 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21595 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21596 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21597 system quota failures.
21598
21599 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21600 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21601 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21602 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21603 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21604 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21605 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21606 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21607 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21608 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21609
21610
21611 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21612 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21613 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21614 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21615 delivery directory.
21616
21617
21618 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21619 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21620 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21621 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21622 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21623 &"no quota"&.
21624
21625
21626 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21627 See &%quota%& above.
21628
21629
21630 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21631 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21632 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21633 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21634 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21635 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21636 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21637
21638 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21639 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21640 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21641 the file length to the file name. For example:
21642 .code
21643 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21644 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21645 .endd
21646 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21647 number of lines in the message.
21648
21649 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21650 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21651 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21652
21653 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21654
21655
21656 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21657 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21658 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21659 .code
21660 quota_warn_message = "\
21661 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21662 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21663 This message is automatically created \
21664 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21665 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21666 a warning threshold that is\n\
21667 set by the system administrator.\n"
21668 .endd
21669
21670
21671 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21672 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21673 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21674 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21675 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21676 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21677 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21678 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21679 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21680 sign. For example:
21681 .code
21682 quota = 10M
21683 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21684 .endd
21685 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21686 percent sign is ignored.
21687
21688 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21689 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21690 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21691 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21692 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21693 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21694 .code
21695 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21696 .endd
21697 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21698 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21699 option.
21700
21701 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21702 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21703 percentage.
21704
21705
21706 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21707 .cindex "envelope sender"
21708 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21709 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21710 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21711 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21712 for details of batch SMTP.
21713
21714
21715 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21716 .cindex "carriage return"
21717 .cindex "linefeed"
21718 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21719 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21720 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21721 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21722
21723 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21724 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21725 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21726 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21727 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21728 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21729
21730
21731 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21732 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21733 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21734 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21735 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21736 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21737
21738
21739 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21740 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21741 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21742 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21743 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21744
21745 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21746 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21747 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21748 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21749
21750 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21751 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21752 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21753 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21754 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21755 error.
21756
21757 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21758 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21759
21760
21761 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21762 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21763 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21764 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21765 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21766 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21767 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21768
21769 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21770 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21771 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21772 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21773 file corruption.
21774
21775 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21776 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21777 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21778
21779
21780 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21781 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21782 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21783 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21784 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21785 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21786 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21787 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21788 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21789
21790 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21791 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21792 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21793 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21794
21795
21796
21797
21798 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21799 .cindex "appending to a file"
21800 .cindex "file" "appending"
21801 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21802
21803 .ilist
21804 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21805 return is given.
21806
21807 .next
21808 .cindex "directory creation"
21809 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21810 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21811 &%directory_mode%& option.
21812
21813 .next
21814 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21815 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21816 transport.
21817
21818 .next
21819 .cindex "file" "locking"
21820 .cindex "locking files"
21821 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21822 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21823 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21824
21825 .olist
21826 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21827 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21828 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21829 .next
21830 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21831 .next
21832 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21833 Unlink the hitching post name.
21834 .next
21835 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21836 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21837 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21838 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21839 .next
21840 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21841 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21842 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21843 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21844 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21845 it before trying again.
21846 .endlist olist
21847
21848 .next
21849 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21850 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21851 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21852
21853 .next
21854 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21855 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21856 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21857 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21858 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21859 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21860 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21861 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21862 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21863 checked.
21864
21865 .next
21866 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21867 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21868 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21869 delivery is deferred.
21870
21871 .next
21872 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21873 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21874 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21875 permissions.
21876
21877 .next
21878 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21879 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21880 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21881
21882 .next
21883 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21884 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21885 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21886
21887 .next
21888 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21889 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21890 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21891 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21892 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21893 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21894 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21895 that prevents link following.
21896
21897 .next
21898 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21899 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21900 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21901 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21902 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21903
21904 .next
21905 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21906
21907 .next
21908 .cindex "file" "locking"
21909 .cindex "locking files"
21910 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21911 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21912 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21913 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21914 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21915 .code
21916 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21917 .endd
21918 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21919 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21920 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21921
21922 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21923 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21924 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21925
21926 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21927 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21928 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21929 delivery is deferred.
21930
21931 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21932 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21933 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21934 immediately. It retries up to
21935 .code
21936 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21937 .endd
21938 times (rounded up).
21939 .endlist
21940
21941 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21942 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21943
21944
21945 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21946 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21947 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21948 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21949 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21950 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21951 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21952 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21953 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21954 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21955
21956 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21957 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21958 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21959 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21960 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21961 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21962 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21963
21964 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21965 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21966 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21967 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21968
21969
21970 .cindex "maildir format"
21971 .cindex "mailstore format"
21972 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21973 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21974 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21975 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21976 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21977
21978 .cindex "directory creation"
21979 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21980 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21981 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21982 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21983 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21984 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21985 deferred.
21986
21987
21988
21989 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21990 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21991 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21992 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21993 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21994 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21995 &_new_& subdirectory.
21996
21997 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21998 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21999 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22000 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22001 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22002 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22003 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22004
22005 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22006 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22007 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22008 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22009 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22010 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22011 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22012 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22013
22014 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22015 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22016 folders. Consider this example:
22017 .code
22018 maildir_format = true
22019 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22020 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22021 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22022 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22023 .endd
22024 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22025 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22026 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22027 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22028 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22029 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22030
22031 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22032 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22033 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22034 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22035 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22036
22037 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22038 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22039 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22040
22041 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22042 .cindex "maildir++"
22043 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22044 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22045 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22046 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22047 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22048 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22049 amount of space used.
22050
22051 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22052 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22053 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22054 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22055 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22056 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22057
22058
22059
22060
22061 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22062 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22063 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22064 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22065 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22066 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22067
22068
22069 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22070 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22071 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22072 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22073 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22074 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22075 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22076 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22077 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22078 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22079 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22080 backwards compatibility).
22081
22082 For one common implementation, you might set:
22083 .code
22084 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22085 .endd
22086 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22087
22088 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22089 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22090 &[stat()]& each message file.
22091
22092
22093 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22094 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22095 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22096 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22097 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22098 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22099 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22100 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22101 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22102
22103 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22104 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22105 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22106 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22107 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22108 need to know the quota.
22109
22110 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22111 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22112
22113 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22114 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22115 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22116 details.
22117
22118
22119 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22120 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22121 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22122 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22123 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22124 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22125 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22126 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22127
22128 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22129 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22130 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22131 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22132 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22133 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22134
22135 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22136 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22137 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22138 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22139 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22140 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22141
22142 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22143 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22144 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22145 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22146
22147
22148 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22149 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22150 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22151 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22152 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22153 .code
22154 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22155 .endd
22156 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22157 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22158 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22159 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22160 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22161
22162
22163
22164
22165
22166
22167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22169
22170 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22171 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22172 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22173 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22174 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22175 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22176 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22177 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22178
22179 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22180 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22181 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22182 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22183 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22184
22185
22186 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22187 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22188 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22189 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22190 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22191
22192 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22193 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22194 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22195 transport is run as a consequence of a
22196 &%mail%&
22197 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22198 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22199 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22200 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22201 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22202 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22203
22204 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22205 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22206 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22207 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22208
22209 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22210 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22211 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22212 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22213 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22214 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22215 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22216
22217 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22218 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22219 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22220 the transport defers.
22221 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22222 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22223
22224 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22225 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22226 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22227 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22228
22229 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22230 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22231 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22232 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22233 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22234 problems. They are just discarded.
22235
22236
22237
22238 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22239 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22240
22241 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22242 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22243 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22244
22245
22246 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22247 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22248 when the message is specified by the transport.
22249
22250
22251 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22252 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22253 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22254 string comes first.
22255
22256
22257 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22258 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22259 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22260
22261
22262 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22263 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22264 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22265
22266
22267 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22268 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22269 specified by the transport.
22270
22271
22272 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22273 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22274 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22275 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22276
22277
22278 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22279 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22280 the message is specified by the transport.
22281
22282
22283 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22284 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22285 used.
22286
22287
22288 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22289 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22290 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22291 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22292 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22293
22294
22295
22296 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22297 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22298 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22299 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22300
22301 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22302 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22303 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22304 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22305 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22306 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22307 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22308 infinity.
22309
22310 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22311 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22312 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22313 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22314 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22315
22316 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22317 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22318 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22319 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22320 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22321 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22322
22323
22324 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22325 See &%once%& above.
22326
22327
22328 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22329 See &%once%& above.
22330 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22331
22332
22333 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22334 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22335 specified by the transport.
22336
22337
22338 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22339 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22340 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22341 configuration option.
22342
22343
22344 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22345 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22346 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22347 automatic responses. For example:
22348 .code
22349 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22350 .endd
22351 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22352 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22353 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22354 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22355 small.
22356
22357
22358
22359 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22360 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22361 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22362 the text comes first.
22363
22364
22365 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22366 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22367 when the message is specified by the transport.
22368 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22369 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22370
22371
22372
22373
22374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22376
22377 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22378 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22379 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22380 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22381 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22382 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22383 specified command
22384 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22385 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22386 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22387 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22388 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22389 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22390 .code
22391 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22392 .endd
22393 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22394 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22395 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22396 as follows:
22397
22398 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22399 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22400
22401
22402 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22403 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22404 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22405 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22406 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22407
22408
22409 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22410 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22411 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22412 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22413 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22414 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22415 LMTP protocol.
22416
22417 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22418 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22419 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22420 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22421 in its response to the LHLO command.
22422
22423 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22424 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22425 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22426 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22427
22428
22429 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22430 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22431 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22432 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22433 LMTP transport:
22434 .code
22435 lmtp:
22436 driver = lmtp
22437 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22438 batch_max = 20
22439 user = exim
22440 .endd
22441 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22442 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22443
22444
22445
22446 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22447 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22448
22449 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22450 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22451 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22452 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22453 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22454 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22455 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22456 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22457 following ways:
22458
22459 .ilist
22460 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22461 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22462 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22463 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22464 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22465 .next
22466 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22467 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22468 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22469 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22470 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22471 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22472 that are routed to the transport.
22473 .next
22474 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22475 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22476 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22477 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22478 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22479 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22480 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22481 .endlist
22482
22483
22484 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22485 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22486 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22487
22488 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22489 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22490 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22491 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22492 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22493 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22494 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22495
22496
22497 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22498 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22499 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22500 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22501 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22502 .new
22503 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22504 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22505 .wen
22506
22507
22508
22509
22510 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22511 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22512 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22513 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22514 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22515 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22516 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22517 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22518 &"local delivery failed"&.
22519
22520 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22521 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22522 will be sent as normal.
22523
22524 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22525 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22526 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22527 apply in this case.
22528
22529 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22530 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22531 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22532 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22533
22534 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22535 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22536 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22537 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22538 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22539 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22540 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22541 &%temp_errors%&.
22542
22543
22544
22545 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22546 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22547 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22548 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22549 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22550 run.
22551
22552 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22553 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22554 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22555 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22556
22557 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22558 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22559 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22560 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22561 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22562 .code
22563 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22564 .endd
22565 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22566 arguments. You have to write
22567 .code
22568 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22569 .endd
22570 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22571 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22572 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22573 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22574 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22575 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22576 example:
22577 .code
22578 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22579 .endd
22580
22581 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22582 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22583 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22584 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22585 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22586 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22587 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22588 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22589 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22590 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22591
22592 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22593 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22594 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22595 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22596 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22597 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22598 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22599 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22600
22601 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22602 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22603 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22604 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22605 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22606 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22607 control what is done with it.
22608
22609 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22610 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22611 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22612 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22613 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22614 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22615 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22616 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22617 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22618 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22619 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22620
22621
22622
22623 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22624 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22625 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22626 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22627 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22628 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22629 environment.
22630 .display
22631 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22632 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22633 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22634 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22635 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22636 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22637 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22638 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22639 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22640 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22641 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22642 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22643 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22644 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22645 &`USER `& see below
22646 .endd
22647 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22648 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22649 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22650 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22651 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22652 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22653 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22654
22655 .cindex "HOST"
22656 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22657 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22658 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22659 the router.
22660
22661 .cindex "HOME"
22662 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22663 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22664 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22665 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22666
22667
22668 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22669 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22670
22671
22672
22673 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22674 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22675 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22676 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22677 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22678 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22679 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22680 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22681 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22682 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22683 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22684 example, if
22685 .code
22686 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22687 .endd
22688 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22689 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22690 &%use_shell%& is set.
22691
22692
22693 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22694 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22695
22696
22697 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22698 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22699 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22700
22701
22702 .option check_string pipe string unset
22703 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22704 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22705 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22706 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22707 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22708 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22709 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22710 ignored.
22711
22712
22713 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22714 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22715 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22716 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22717 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22718 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22719 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22720
22721
22722 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22723 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22724 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22725 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22726 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22727 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22728 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22729
22730
22731 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22732 See &%check_string%& above.
22733
22734
22735 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22736 .cindex "exec failure"
22737 .cindex "failure of exec"
22738 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22739 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22740 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22741 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22742 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22743
22744
22745 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22746 .cindex "signal exit"
22747 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22748 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22749 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22750 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22751
22752
22753 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22754 .cindex "force command"
22755 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22756 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22757 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22758 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22759 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22760 command. For example:
22761 .code
22762 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22763 force_command
22764 .endd
22765
22766 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22767 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22768 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22769
22770
22771 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22772 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22773 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22774 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22775 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22776 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22777
22778 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22779 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22780
22781
22782 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22783 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22784 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22785 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22786 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22787 written to the main log.
22788
22789
22790 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22791 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22792 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22793 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22794 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22795 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22796 be set.
22797
22798
22799 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22800 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22801 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22802 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22803 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22804
22805
22806 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22807 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22808 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22809 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22810 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22811 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22812 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22813 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22814
22815
22816 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22817 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22818 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22819 .code
22820 message_prefix = \
22821 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22822 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22823 .endd
22824 .cindex "Cyrus"
22825 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22826 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22827 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22828 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22829 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22830 setting
22831 .code
22832 message_prefix =
22833 .endd
22834 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22835 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22836
22837
22838 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22839 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22840 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22841 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22842 .code
22843 message_suffix =
22844 .endd
22845 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22846 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22847
22848
22849 .option path pipe string "see below"
22850 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22851 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22852 .code
22853 /bin:/usr/bin
22854 .endd
22855 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22856 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22857 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22858
22859
22860 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22861 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22862 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22863 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22864 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22865 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22866 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22867 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22868 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22869
22870
22871 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22872 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22873 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22874 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22875 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22876 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22877 accept the message is used.
22878
22879
22880 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22881 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22882 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22883 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22884 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22885 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22886
22887
22888 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22889 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22890 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22891 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22892 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22893 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22894 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22895
22896
22897
22898 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22899 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22900 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22901 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22902 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22903 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22904 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22905 of them may be set.
22906
22907
22908
22909 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22910 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22911 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22912 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22913 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22914 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22915 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22916 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22917 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22918 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22919 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22920 and 73, respectively.
22921
22922
22923 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22924 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22925 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22926 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22927 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22928 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22929 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22930
22931 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22932 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22933 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22934 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22935 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22936 delivery to be deferred.
22937
22938 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22939 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22940
22941
22942 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22943 .cindex "envelope sender"
22944 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22945 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22946 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22947 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22948 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22949
22950 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22951 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22952 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22953 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22954 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22955 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22956 class database.
22957
22958
22959 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22960 .cindex "carriage return"
22961 .cindex "linefeed"
22962 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22963 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22964 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22965 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22966
22967 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22968 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22969 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22970 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22971 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22972
22973
22974 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22975 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22976 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22977 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22978 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22979 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22980 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22981 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22982 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22983 its &%-c%& option.
22984
22985
22986
22987 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22988 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22989 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22990 .cindex "external local delivery"
22991 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22992 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22993 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22994 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22995 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22996 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22997 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22998 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22999 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23000 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23001 .code
23002 # transport
23003 procmail_pipe:
23004 driver = pipe
23005 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23006 return_path_add
23007 delivery_date_add
23008 envelope_to_add
23009 check_string = "From "
23010 escape_string = ">From "
23011 umask = 077
23012 user = $local_part
23013 group = mail
23014
23015 # router
23016 procmail:
23017 driver = accept
23018 check_local_user
23019 transport = procmail_pipe
23020 .endd
23021 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23022 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23023 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23024 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23025 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23026 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23027
23028 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23029 .code
23030 IFS=" "
23031 .endd
23032 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23033 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23034
23035 .cindex "Cyrus"
23036 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23037 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23038 .code
23039 # transport
23040 local_delivery_cyrus:
23041 driver = pipe
23042 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23043 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23044 user = cyrus
23045 group = mail
23046 return_output
23047 log_output
23048 message_prefix =
23049 message_suffix =
23050
23051 # router
23052 local_user_cyrus:
23053 driver = accept
23054 check_local_user
23055 local_part_suffix = .*
23056 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23057 .endd
23058 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23059 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23060 sender.
23061 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23062 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23063
23064
23065 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23067
23068 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23069 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23070 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23071 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23072 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23073 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23074 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23075 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23076
23077
23078 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23079 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23080 two ways:
23081
23082 .ilist
23083 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23084 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23085 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23086 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23087 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23088 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23089 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23090 .next
23091 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23092 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23093 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23094 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23095 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23096 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23097 process.
23098 .endlist
23099
23100
23101 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23102 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23103 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23104
23105
23106
23107 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23108 .vindex "&$host$&"
23109 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23110 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23111 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23112 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23113 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23114 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23115 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23116 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23117
23118
23119 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23120 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23121 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23122 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23123 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23124 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23125 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23126 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23127 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23128 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23129 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23130 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23131 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23132 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23133
23134 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23135 and will be removed in a future release.
23136
23137
23138 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23139 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23140 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23141
23142
23143 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23144 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23145 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23146 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23147 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23148 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23149 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23150 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23151
23152 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23153 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23154 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23155 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23156 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23157 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23158 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23159 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23160 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23161
23162
23163 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23164 .cindex "Cyrus"
23165 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23166 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23167 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23168 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23169 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23170 ignored.
23171
23172 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23173 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23174 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23175 particular connection.
23176
23177 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23178 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23179 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23180 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23181
23182 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23183 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23184 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23185 .code
23186 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23187 .endd
23188 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23189 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23190
23191 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23192 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23193 value.
23194
23195
23196 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23197 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23198 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23199 authenticated as a client.
23200
23201
23202 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23203 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23204 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23205 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23206
23207
23208 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23209 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23210 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23211 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23212 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23213 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23214 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23215
23216
23217 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23218 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23219 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23220 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23221 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23222 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23223 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23224 option.
23225
23226
23227 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23228 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23229 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23230 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23231
23232
23233 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23234 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23235 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23236 cutoff times.
23237
23238 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23239 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23240 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23241 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23242 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23243 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23244
23245 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23246 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23247 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23248 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23249 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23250 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23251 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23252 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23253 to them.
23254
23255
23256 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23257 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23258 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23259 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23260 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23261
23262
23263 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23264 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23265 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23266 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23267 details.
23268
23269
23270 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23271 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23272 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23273 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23274 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23275 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23276 the dnssec request bit set.
23277 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23278
23279
23280
23281 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23282 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23283 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23284 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23285 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23286 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23287 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23288 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23289 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23290
23291
23292
23293 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23294 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23295 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23296 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23297 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23298 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23299 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23300
23301 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23302 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23303 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23304 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23305 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23306
23307
23308 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23309 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23310 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23311 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23312 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23313 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23314 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23315 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23316
23317 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23318 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23319 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23320 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23321 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23322 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23323
23324 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23325 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23326 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23327 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23328 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23329
23330 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23331 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23332 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23333 copy of the message is sent.
23334
23335 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23336 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23337 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23338 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23339 fails"& facility.
23340
23341
23342 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23343 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23344 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23345 zero.
23346
23347 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23348 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23349 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23350 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23351 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23352 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23353
23354 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23355 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23356 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23357 implementations of TLS.
23358
23359 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23360 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23361 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23362 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23363 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23364 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23365 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23366 option is:
23367 .code
23368 $primary_hostname
23369 .endd
23370 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23371 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23372 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23373 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23374 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23375 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23376 interface address, you could use this:
23377 .code
23378 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23379 {$primary_hostname}}
23380 .endd
23381 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23382 callouts.
23383
23384 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23385 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23386 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23387 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23388 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23389 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23390
23391 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23392 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23393 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23394 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23395
23396 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23397 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23398 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23399 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23400 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23401 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23402 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23403
23404 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23405 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23406 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23407 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23408 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23409 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23410 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23411 address are used.
23412
23413 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23414 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23415
23416
23417 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23418 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23419 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23420 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23421 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23422 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23423 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23424 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23425 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23426 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23427
23428
23429 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23430 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23431 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23432 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23433
23434
23435 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23436 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23437 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23438 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23439
23440 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23441 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23442 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23443 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23444 to any host that matches this list.
23445
23446
23447 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23448 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23449 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23450 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23451 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23452 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23453 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23454 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23455
23456
23457 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23458 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23459 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23460 why it exists.
23461
23462
23463
23464 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23465 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23466 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23467 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23468 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23469 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23470 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23471 explanation of when this might be needed.
23472
23473
23474 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23475 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23476 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23477 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23478 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23479
23480
23481 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23482 .cindex "randomized host list"
23483 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23484 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23485 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23486 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23487 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23488 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23489 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23490 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23491
23492 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23493 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23494 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23495 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23496 .code
23497 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23498 .endd
23499 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23500 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23501 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23502
23503 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23504 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23505 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23506 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23507 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23508 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23509 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23510 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23511 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23512
23513
23514 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23515 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23516 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23517 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23518 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23519
23520 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23521 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23522 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23523 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23524 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23525
23526 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23527 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23528 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23529 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23530 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23531 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23532
23533 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23534 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23535 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23536 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23537 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23538 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23539 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23540
23541 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23542 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23543 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23544 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23545 for multi-recipient messages.
23546 The option can usually be left as default.
23547
23548 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23549 .cindex "bind IP address"
23550 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23551 .vindex "&$host$&"
23552 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23553 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23554 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23555 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23556 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23557 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23558 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23559 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23560 unknown.
23561
23562 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23563 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23564 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23565 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23566 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23567 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23568 .code
23569 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23570 .endd
23571 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23572 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23573 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23574 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23575
23576
23577 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23578 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23579 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23580 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23581 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23582 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23583 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23584 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23585 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23586 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23587 unreachable hosts.
23588
23589
23590 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23591 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23592 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23593 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23594 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23595
23596 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23597 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23598 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23599 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23600 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23601 permits this.
23602
23603
23604 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23605 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23606 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23607 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23608 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23609 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23610 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23611 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23612
23613 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23614 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23615 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23616
23617 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23618 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23619 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23620 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23621 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23622 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23623 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23624 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23625
23626 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23627 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23628 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23629 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23630 is deferred.
23631
23632
23633
23634 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23635 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23636 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23637 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23638 .vindex "&$port$&"
23639 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23640 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23641 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23642 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23643 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23644
23645 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23646 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23647 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23648 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23649
23650
23651 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23652 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23653 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23654 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23655 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23656 addresses is not affected.
23657
23658 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23659 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23660 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23661 Exim to use only the host name.
23662 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23663
23664
23665 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23666 .cindex "serializing connections"
23667 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23668 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23669 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23670 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23671 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23672 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23673 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23674
23675 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23676 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23677 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23678 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23679 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23680 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23681
23682 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23683 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23684 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23685 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23686 are used for ETRN serialization.
23687
23688 .new
23689 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23690 .wen
23691
23692
23693 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23694 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23695 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23696 .cindex "size" "of message"
23697 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23698 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23699 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23700 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23701 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23702 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23703 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23704 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23705
23706 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23707 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23708
23709
23710 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23711 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23712 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23713 .vindex "&$host$&"
23714 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23715 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23716 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23717 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23718 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23719 details of TLS.
23720
23721 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23722 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23723 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23724 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23725 client.
23726
23727
23728 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23729 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23730 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23731 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23732 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23733
23734
23735 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23736 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23737 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23738 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23739 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23740 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23741 will fail.
23742
23743 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23744
23745
23746 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23747 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23748 .vindex "&$host$&"
23749 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23750 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23751 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23752 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23753 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23754 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23755 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23756 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23757
23758
23759 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23760 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23761 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23762 .vindex "&$host$&"
23763 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23764 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23765 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23766 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23767 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23768 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23769 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23770 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23771 ciphers is a preference order.
23772
23773
23774
23775 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23776 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23777 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23778 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23779 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23780 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23781 certificate and private key for the session.
23782
23783 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23784
23785 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23786 TLS extensions.
23787
23788
23789
23790
23791 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23792 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23793 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23794 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23795 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23796 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23797 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23798 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23799 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23800 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23801 in clear.
23802
23803
23804 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23805 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23806 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23807 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23808 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23809 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23810 Note that unless the host is in this list
23811 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23812 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23813 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23814 certificate verification succeeds.
23815
23816
23817 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23818 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23819 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23820 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23821 while verifying the server certificate,
23822 checks will be included on the host name
23823 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23824 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23825 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23826
23827 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23828
23829
23830 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23831 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23832 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23833 .vindex "&$host$&"
23834 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23835 The value of this option must be either the
23836 word "system"
23837 or the absolute path to
23838 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23839 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23840
23841 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23842 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23843 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23844 must be specified.
23845
23846 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23847 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23848
23849 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23850 explicitly
23851 either by file or directory
23852 are added to those given by the system default location.
23853
23854 The values of &$host$& and
23855 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23856 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23857
23858 For back-compatibility,
23859 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23860 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23861 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23862
23863
23864 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23865 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23866 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23867 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23868 certificate verification must succeed.
23869 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23870 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23871 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23872
23873
23874
23875
23876 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23877 "SECTvalhosmax"
23878 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23879 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23880 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23881 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23882 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23883
23884
23885 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23886 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23887 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23888 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23889 retrying.
23890
23891 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23892 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23893 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23894
23895 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23896 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23897 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23898 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23899 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23900
23901 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23902 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23903 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23904 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23905 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23906 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23907 see below for an exception).
23908
23909 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23910 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23911 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23912 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23913 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23914
23915 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23916 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23917 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23918 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23919 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23920 reached their retry times.
23921
23922 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23923 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23924 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23925 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23926 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23927 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23928 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23929 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23930 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23931 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23932 reached.
23933
23934 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23935 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23936 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23937 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23938 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23939 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23940
23941 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23942 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23943 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23944 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23945 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23946 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23947
23948
23949
23950
23951
23952 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23953 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23954
23955 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23956 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23957 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23958 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23959 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23960 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23961
23962 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23963 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23964 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23965 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23966 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23967 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23968 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23969
23970 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23971 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23972 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23973 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23974
23975
23976 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23977 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23978 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23979 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23980
23981 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23982 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23983 facility; you do not have to use it.
23984
23985 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23986 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23987 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23988 address to which it applies.
23989
23990 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23991 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23992 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23993 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23994 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23995 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23996 rules.
23997
23998 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23999 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24000 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24001 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24002
24003
24004 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24005 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24006 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24007 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24008 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24009 discouraged.
24010
24011 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24012 illustrated by these examples:
24013
24014 .ilist
24015 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24016 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24017 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24018 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24019 .next
24020 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24021 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24022 .endlist
24023
24024
24025
24026 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24027 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24028 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24029 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24030 message's processing.
24031
24032 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24033 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24034 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24035 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24036 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24037 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24038 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24039 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24040 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24041
24042 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24043 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24044 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24045 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24046 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24047 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24048 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24049 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24050 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24051 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24052
24053 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24054 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24055 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24056 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24057 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24058 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24059
24060 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24061 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24062 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24063
24064 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24065 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24066 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24067 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24068 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24069 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24070 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24071 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24072 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24073
24074 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24075 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24076 transport time.
24077
24078
24079
24080
24081 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24082 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24083 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24084 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24085 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24086 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24087 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24088 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24089 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24090 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24091 .code
24092 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24093 .endd
24094 might produce the output
24095 .code
24096 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24097 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24098 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24099 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24100 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24101 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24102 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24103 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24104 .endd
24105 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24106 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24107 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24108 set for a particular transport.
24109
24110
24111 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24112 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24113 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24114 rules in the form
24115 .display
24116 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24117 .endd
24118 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24119 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24120 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24121 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24122
24123 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24124 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24125 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24126 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24127 ignored.
24128
24129 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24130 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24131 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24132
24133 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24134 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24135 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24136 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24137 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24138 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24139 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24140
24141 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24142 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24143 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24144 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24145 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24146 .code
24147 *@* ${lookup ...
24148 .endd
24149 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24150 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24151
24152
24153 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24154 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24155 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24156 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24157 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24158 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24159 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24160 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24161 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24162
24163 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24164 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24165 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24166
24167 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24168 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24169 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24170 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24171 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24172 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24173 of pattern they are set as follows:
24174
24175 .ilist
24176 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24177 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24178 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24179 pattern
24180 .code
24181 *queen@*.fict.example
24182 .endd
24183 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24184 .code
24185 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24186 $1 = hearts-
24187 $2 = wonderland
24188 .endd
24189 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24190 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24191
24192 .next
24193 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24194 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24195 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24196 rewriting rule of the form
24197 .display
24198 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24199 .endd
24200 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24201 .code
24202 $1 = foo
24203 $2 = bar
24204 $3 = baz.example
24205 .endd
24206 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24207 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24208 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24209 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24210 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24211 .endlist
24212
24213
24214 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24215 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24216 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24217 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24218 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24219 .code
24220 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24221 .endd
24222 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24223 &'From:'& headers.
24224
24225 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24226 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24227 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24228 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24229 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24230 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24231 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24232 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24233 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24234 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24235 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24236 entry written to the panic log.
24237
24238
24239
24240 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24241 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24242
24243 .ilist
24244 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24245 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24246 .next
24247 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24248 .next
24249 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24250 .endlist
24251
24252 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24253 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24254
24255
24256
24257 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24258 "SECID154"
24259 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24260 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24261 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24262 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24263 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24264 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24265 .display
24266 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24267 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24268 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24269 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24270 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24271 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24272 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24273 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24274 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24275 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24276 .endd
24277 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24278 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24279 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24280
24281 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24282 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24283
24284
24285 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24286 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24287 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24288 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24289 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24290 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24291 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24292 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24293 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24294
24295 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24296 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24297 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24298 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24299 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24300 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24301 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24302 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24303
24304
24305 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24306 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24307 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24308 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24309
24310 .ilist
24311 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24312 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24313 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24314 .next
24315 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24316 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24317 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24318 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24319 .next
24320 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24321 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24322 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24323 .next
24324 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24325 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24326 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24327 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24328 .code
24329 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24330 .endd
24331 into
24332 .code
24333 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24334 .endd
24335 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24336 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24337 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24338 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24339 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24340 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24341 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24342 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24343 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24344
24345 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24346 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24347 .endlist
24348
24349
24350 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24351 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24352 .code
24353 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24354 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24355 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24356 .endd
24357 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24358 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24359 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24360 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24361 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24362 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24363 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24364 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24365
24366 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24367 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24368 .code
24369 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24370 .endd
24371 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24372 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24373
24374 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24375 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24376 messages that originate outside the local host:
24377 .code
24378 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24379 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24380 .endd
24381 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24382 space.
24383
24384 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24385 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24386 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24387 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24388 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24389 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24390 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24391 components. For example, the rule
24392 .code
24393 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24394 .endd
24395 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24396 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24397 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24398 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24399 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24400 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24401 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24402 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24403
24404
24405
24406
24407
24408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24409 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24410
24411 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24412 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24413 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24414 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24415 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24416 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24417 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24418 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24419 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24420 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24421 address, domain and error.
24422
24423 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24424 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24425 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24426 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24427 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24428 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24429 log selector is set, the message
24430 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24431 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24432 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24433 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24434
24435 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24436 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24437 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24438 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24439 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24440 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24441 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24442 domain are maintained independently.
24443
24444 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24445 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24446 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24447 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24448 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24449 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24450 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24451 the local address is reached.
24452
24453 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24454 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24455 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24456 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24457 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24458
24459 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24460 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24461 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24462 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24463 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24464 messages that it should now be retaining.
24465
24466
24467
24468 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24469 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24470 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24471 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24472 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24473 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24474 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24475 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24476 message's sender, respectively.
24477
24478
24479 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24480 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24481 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24482 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24483 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24484 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24485 example,
24486 .code
24487 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24488 .endd
24489 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24490 whereas
24491 .code
24492 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24493 .endd
24494 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24495 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24496 part.
24497
24498 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24499 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24500 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24501 expressions work in address lists.
24502 .display
24503 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24504 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24505 .endd
24506
24507
24508 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24509 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24510 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24511 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24512 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24513 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24514 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24515 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24516 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24517
24518 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24519 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24520 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24521 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24522 local transports).
24523
24524 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24525 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24526 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24527 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24528 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24529 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24530 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24531 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24532 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24533 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24534 commands.
24535
24536
24537
24538 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24539 "SECID160"
24540 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24541 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24542 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24543 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24544 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24545 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24546 .code
24547 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24548 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24549 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24550 .endd
24551 and the retry rules are
24552 .code
24553 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24554 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24555 .endd
24556 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24557 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24558 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24559 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24560 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24561 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24562
24563 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24564 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24565 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24566 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24567
24568 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24569 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24570 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24571 .code
24572 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24573 .endd
24574 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24575 textual form of the IP address.
24576
24577 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24578 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24579 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24580 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24581
24582 .vlist
24583 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24584 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24585 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24586
24587 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24588 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24589 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24590
24591 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24592 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24593
24594 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24595 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24596 .endlist
24597
24598 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24599 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24600 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24601 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24602 retry rule of this form:
24603 .code
24604 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24605 .endd
24606 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24607 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24608
24609 .vlist
24610 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24611 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24612 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24613 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24614
24615 .vitem &%lookup%&
24616 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24617 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24618 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24619 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24620 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24621
24622 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24623 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24624
24625 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24626 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24627
24628 .vitem &%refused%&
24629 A connection was refused.
24630
24631 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24632 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24633
24634 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24635 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24636
24637 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24638 A connection attempt timed out.
24639
24640 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24641 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24642 obtained from an MX record.
24643
24644 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24645 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24646 obtained from an MX record.
24647
24648 .vitem &%timeout%&
24649 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24650
24651 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24652 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24653 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24654 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24655
24656 .vitem &%quota%&
24657 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24658 transport.
24659
24660 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24661 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24662 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24663 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24664 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24665 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24666 for four days.
24667 .endlist
24668
24669 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24670 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24671 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24672 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24673 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24674 heuristic rules:
24675
24676 .ilist
24677 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24678 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24679 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24680 .next
24681 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24682 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24683 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24684 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24685 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24686 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24687 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24688 .next
24689 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24690 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24691 .endlist
24692
24693 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24694 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24695 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24696 error).
24697
24698
24699
24700 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24701 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24702 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24703 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24704 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24705 form:
24706 .display
24707 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24708 .endd
24709 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24710 .code
24711 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24712 .endd
24713 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24714 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24715 For example:
24716 .code
24717 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24718 .endd
24719 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24720 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24721 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24722 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24723 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24724
24725 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24726 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24727 .code
24728 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24729 .endd
24730 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24731 list is never matched.
24732
24733
24734
24735
24736
24737 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24738 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24739 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24740 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24741 .display
24742 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24743 .endd
24744 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24745 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24746 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24747 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24748 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24749
24750 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24751 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24752 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24753 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24754 The available algorithms are:
24755
24756 .ilist
24757 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24758 the interval.
24759 .next
24760 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24761 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24762 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24763 .next
24764 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24765 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24766 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24767 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24768 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24769 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24770 queue processing times.
24771 .endlist
24772
24773 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24774 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24775 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24776 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24777 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24778 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24779 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24780 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24781 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24782 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24783 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24784 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24785
24786 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24787 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24788 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24789 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24790 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24791 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24792 time.
24793
24794 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24795 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24796 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24797 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24798 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24799 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24800 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24801 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24802 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24803 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24804 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24805 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24806
24807 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24808 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24809 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24810 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24811 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24812 deliveries that have been deferred.
24813
24814
24815 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24816 Here are some example retry rules:
24817 .code
24818 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24819 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24820 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24821 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24822 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24823 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24824 .endd
24825 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24826 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24827 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24828 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24829 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24830 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24831 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24832 days.
24833
24834 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24835 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24836 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24837 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24838 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24839
24840 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24841 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24842 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24843 were not obtained from an MX record.
24844
24845 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24846 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24847 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24848 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24849 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24850
24851
24852
24853 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24854 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24855 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24856 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24857 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24858 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24859 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24860 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24861 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24862 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24863 failing for the first time.
24864
24865 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24866 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24867 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24868 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24869
24870 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24871 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24872 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24873
24874
24875
24876
24877 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24878 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24879 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24880 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24881 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24882 default retry rule:
24883 .code
24884 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24885 .endd
24886 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24887 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24888 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24889
24890 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24891 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24892 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24893 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24894 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24895
24896 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24897 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24898 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24899
24900 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24901 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24902 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24903 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24904 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24905 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24906 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24907 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24908
24909 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24910 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24911 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24912 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24913 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24914 notice.
24915
24916 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24917 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24918 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24919 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24920 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24921 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24922 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24923 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24924 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24925 true.
24926
24927 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24928 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24929 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24930 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24931 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24932 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24933 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24934 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24935 reached.
24936
24937 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24938 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24939 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24940 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24941 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24942 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24943 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24944 time out the address.
24945
24946 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24947 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24948 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24949 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24950 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24951 considered immediately.
24952 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24953 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24954
24955
24956
24957
24958
24959
24960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24962
24963 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24964 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24965 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24966 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24967 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24968 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24969 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24970 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24971 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24972 other.
24973
24974 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24975 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24976
24977 .ilist
24978 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24979 the client's EHLO command.
24980 .next
24981 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24982 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24983 .next
24984 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24985 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24986 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24987 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24988 with the AUTH command.
24989 .next
24990 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24991 .next
24992 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24993 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24994 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24995 connection.
24996 .next
24997 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24998 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24999 unauthenticated connection.
25000 .endlist
25001
25002 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25003 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25004 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25005 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25006 .display
25007 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25008 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25009 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25010 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25011 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25012 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25013 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25014 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25015 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25016 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25017 &`250 HELP`&
25018 .endd
25019 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25020 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25021 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25022 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25023 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25024 included by setting
25025 .code
25026 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25027 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25028 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25029 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25030 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25031 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25032 AUTH_SPA=yes
25033 AUTH_TLS=yes
25034 .endd
25035 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25036 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25037 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25038 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25039 work via a socket interface.
25040 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25041 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25042 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25043 supporting setting a server keytab.
25044 The sixth can be configured to support
25045 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25046 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25047 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25048 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25049 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25050
25051 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25052 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25053 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25054 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25055 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25056 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25057 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25058
25059 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25060 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25061 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25062 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25063 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25064 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25065 .code
25066 cram:
25067 driver = cram_md5
25068 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25069 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25070 client_name = ph10
25071 client_secret = secret2
25072 .endd
25073 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25074 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25075
25076 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25077 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25078 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25079 in Exim.
25080
25081 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25082 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25083 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25084 authenticating data.
25085
25086 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25087 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25088 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25089 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25090 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25091 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25092 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25093 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25094 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25095 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25096 choose to honour.
25097
25098 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25099 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25100 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25101 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25102
25103
25104
25105 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25106 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25107 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25108
25109 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25110 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25111 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25112 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25113 encrypted by a setting such as:
25114 .code
25115 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25116 .endd
25117
25118
25119 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25120 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25121 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25122 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25123
25124
25125 .option driver authenticators string unset
25126 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25127 authenticators is to be used.
25128
25129
25130 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25131 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25132 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25133 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25134 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25135 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25136
25137
25138 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25139 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25140 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25141 mechanism is not advertised.
25142 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25143 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25144 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25145
25146
25147 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25148 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25149 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25150 for details.
25151
25152 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25153 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25154
25155 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25156 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25157 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25158 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25159 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25160 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25161 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25162 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25163 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25164 the error text.
25165
25166
25167 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25168 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25169 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25170 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25171 out the values of variables.
25172 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25173 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25174
25175
25176 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25177 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25178 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25179 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25180 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25181 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25182 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25183 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25184 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25185
25186
25187 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25188 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25189 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25190 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25191 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25192 remembered for later use.
25193 How it is used is described in the following section.
25194
25195
25196
25197
25198
25199 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25200 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25201 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25202 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25203 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25204 message:
25205
25206 .ilist
25207 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25208 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25209 .next
25210 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25211 .next
25212 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25213 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25214 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25215 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25216 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25217 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25218 given for the MAIL command.
25219 .next
25220 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25221 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25222 authenticated.
25223 .next
25224 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25225 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25226 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25227 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25228 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25229 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25230 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25231 message.
25232 .endlist
25233
25234
25235 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25236 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25237 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25238 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25239
25240 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25241 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25242 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25243 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25244 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25245 ACL is run.
25246
25247
25248
25249 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25250 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25251 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25252 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25253 conditions:
25254
25255 .ilist
25256 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25257 .next
25258 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25259 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25260 .endlist
25261
25262 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25263 the mechanisms are advertised.
25264
25265 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25266 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25267 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25268 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25269 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25270 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25271 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25272 .code
25273 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25274 .endd
25275 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25276
25277 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25278 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25279 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25280 such as:
25281 .code
25282 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25283 .endd
25284 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25285 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25286 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25287
25288 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25289 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25290 command. This is the case if
25291
25292 .ilist
25293 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25294 .next
25295 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25296 .next
25297 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25298 server authenticators.
25299 .endlist
25300
25301
25302 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25303 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25304 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25305
25306 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25307 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25308 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25309 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25310 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25311 rejected with a 504 error.
25312
25313 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25314 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25315 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25316 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25317 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25318 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25319 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25320 no successful authentication.
25321
25322
25323
25324
25325 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25326 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25327 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25328 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25329 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25330 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25331 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25332 script:
25333 .code
25334 use MIME::Base64;
25335 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25336 .endd
25337 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25338 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25339 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25340 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25341 command line to run this script on such data might be
25342 .code
25343 encode '\0user\0password'
25344 .endd
25345 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25346 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25347 whose code value is zero.
25348
25349 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25350 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25351 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25352 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25353
25354 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25355 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25356 example, a command such as
25357 .code
25358 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25359 .endd
25360 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25361
25362 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25363 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25364 .code
25365 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25366 .endd
25367 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25368 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25369 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25370 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25371
25372
25373
25374 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25375 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25376 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25377 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25378 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25379 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25380
25381 .ilist
25382 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25383 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25384 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25385 of the authenticator.
25386 .next
25387 .vindex "&$host$&"
25388 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25389 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25390 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25391 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25392 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25393 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25394 delivery to be deferred.
25395 .next
25396 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25397 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25398 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25399 usual way.
25400 .next
25401 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25402 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25403 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25404 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25405 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25406 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25407 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25408 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25409 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25410 .endlist
25411
25412 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25413 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25414 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25415 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25416 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25417 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25418 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25419 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25420 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25421 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25422 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25423 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25424 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25425
25426
25427
25428
25429
25430
25431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25433
25434 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25435 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25436 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25437 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25438 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25439 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25440 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25441 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25442 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25443 connections as you do for login accounts.
25444
25445 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25446 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25447 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25448
25449 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25450 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25451 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25452
25453 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25454 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25455 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25456 given.
25457
25458 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25459 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25460 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25461 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25462 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25463 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25464 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25465
25466 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25467 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25468 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25469 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25470 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25471 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25472 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25473
25474 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25475 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25476 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25477 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25478
25479 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25480 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25481 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25482
25483 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25484 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25485 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25486 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25487 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25488 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25489 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25490 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25491 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25492 string as the error text
25493
25494 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25495 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25496 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25497
25498
25499
25500 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25501 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25502 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25503 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25504 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25505 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25506 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25507 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25508
25509 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25510 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25511 configured as follows:
25512 .code
25513 fixed_plain:
25514 driver = plaintext
25515 public_name = PLAIN
25516 server_prompts = :
25517 server_condition = \
25518 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25519 server_set_id = $auth2
25520 .endd
25521 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25522 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25523 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25524 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25525
25526 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25527 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25528 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25529 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25530 .code
25531 250-AUTH PLAIN
25532 .endd
25533 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25534 .code
25535 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25536 .endd
25537 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25538 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25539 .code
25540 AUTH PLAIN
25541 .endd
25542 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25543 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25544
25545 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25546 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25547 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25548 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25549 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25550
25551 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25552 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25553 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25554
25555 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25556 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25557 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25558 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25559 This is an incorrect example:
25560 .code
25561 server_condition = \
25562 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25563 .endd
25564 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25565 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25566 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25567 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25568 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25569 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25570 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25571 .code
25572 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25573 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25574 .endd
25575 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25576 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25577 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25578 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25579 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25580
25581
25582 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25583 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25584 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25585 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25586 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25587 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25588 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25589 .code
25590 fixed_login:
25591 driver = plaintext
25592 public_name = LOGIN
25593 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25594 server_condition = \
25595 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25596 server_set_id = $auth1
25597 .endd
25598 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25599 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25600 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25601 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25602
25603 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25604 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25605 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25606 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25607 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25608 .code
25609 login:
25610 driver = plaintext
25611 public_name = LOGIN
25612 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25613 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25614 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25615 ldapauth{\
25616 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25617 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25618 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25619 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25620 .endd
25621 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25622 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25623 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25624 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25625 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25626 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25627 uninterpreted string.
25628
25629
25630 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25631 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25632 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25633 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25634 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25635 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25636
25637
25638
25639
25640 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25641 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25642 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25643
25644 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25645 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25646 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25647 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25648 usual.
25649
25650 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25651 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25652 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25653 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25654 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25655 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25656 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25657 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25658 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25659 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25660 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25661 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25662
25663 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25664 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25665
25666 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25667 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25668 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25669 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25670 the string.
25671
25672 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25673 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25674 .code
25675 fixed_plain:
25676 driver = plaintext
25677 public_name = PLAIN
25678 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25679 .endd
25680 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25681 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25682 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25683 .code
25684 fixed_login:
25685 driver = plaintext
25686 public_name = LOGIN
25687 client_send = : username : mysecret
25688 .endd
25689 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25690 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25691 prompts.
25692 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25693 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25694
25695
25696
25697
25698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25700
25701 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25702 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25703 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25704 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25705 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25706 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25707 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25708 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25709 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25710 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25711 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25712 available in plain text at either end.
25713
25714
25715 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25716 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25717 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25718 authenticator as a server:
25719
25720 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25721 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25722 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25723 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25724 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25725 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25726 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25727 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25728 returned to the client.
25729
25730 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25731 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25732 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25733 numeric variables for other things.
25734
25735 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25736 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25737 user name, authentication fails.
25738 .code
25739 fixed_cram:
25740 driver = cram_md5
25741 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25742 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25743 server_set_id = $auth1
25744 .endd
25745 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25746 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25747 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25748 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25749 .code
25750 lookup_cram:
25751 driver = cram_md5
25752 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25753 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25754 {$value}fail}
25755 server_set_id = $auth1
25756 .endd
25757 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25758 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25759
25760 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25761 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25762 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25763 realm, with:
25764 .code
25765 cyrusless_crammd5:
25766 driver = cram_md5
25767 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25768 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25769 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25770 server_set_id = $auth1
25771 .endd
25772
25773 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25774 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25775 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25776
25777
25778
25779 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25780 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25781 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25782
25783
25784 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25785 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25786 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25787
25788
25789 .vindex "&$host$&"
25790 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25791 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25792 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25793 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25794 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25795 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25796 send the message to the current server.
25797
25798 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25799 strings, is:
25800 .code
25801 fixed_cram:
25802 driver = cram_md5
25803 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25804 client_name = ph10
25805 client_secret = secret
25806 .endd
25807 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25808 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25809
25810
25811
25812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25813 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25814
25815 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25816 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25817 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25818 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25819 .cindex "Kerberos"
25820 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25821 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25822
25823 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25824 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25825 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25826 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25827 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25828
25829 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25830 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25831 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25832 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25833
25834 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25835 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25836 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25837 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25838 depending on the driver you are using.
25839
25840 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25841 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25842 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25843 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25844 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25845 implementation.
25846
25847 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25848 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25849 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25850 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25851 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25852 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25853 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25854 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25855
25856
25857 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25858 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25859 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25860 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25861 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25862 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25863 things.
25864
25865
25866 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25867 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25868 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25869 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25870
25871
25872 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25873 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25874 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25875 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25876 example:
25877 .code
25878 sasl:
25879 driver = cyrus_sasl
25880 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25881 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25882 server_set_id = $auth1
25883 .endd
25884
25885 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25886 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25887
25888
25889 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25890 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25891
25892
25893 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25894 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25895 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25896 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25897 .code
25898 sasl_cram_md5:
25899 driver = cyrus_sasl
25900 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25901 server_set_id = $auth1
25902
25903 sasl_plain:
25904 driver = cyrus_sasl
25905 public_name = PLAIN
25906 server_set_id = $auth2
25907 .endd
25908 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25909 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25910 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25911 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25912 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25913
25914
25915
25916
25917 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25919 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25920 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25921 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25922 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25923 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25924 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25925 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25926 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25927 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25928
25929 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25930
25931 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25932 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25933 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25934 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25935 .code
25936 dovecot_plain:
25937 driver = dovecot
25938 public_name = PLAIN
25939 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25940 server_set_id = $auth1
25941
25942 dovecot_ntlm:
25943 driver = dovecot
25944 public_name = NTLM
25945 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25946 server_set_id = $auth1
25947 .endd
25948 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25949 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25950 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25951 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25952 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25953 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25954 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25955 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25956
25957
25958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25960 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25961 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25962 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25963 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25964 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25965 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25966 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25967 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25968 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25969 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25970 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25971 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25972 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25973 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25974 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25975 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25976 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25977 without code changes in Exim.
25978
25979
25980 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25981 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25982 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25983 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25984 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25985 context.
25986
25987 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25988 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25989 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25990
25991 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25992 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25993 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25994
25995 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25996 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25997 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25998
25999
26000 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26001 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26002 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26003 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26004
26005
26006 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26007 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26008 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26009 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26010 example:
26011 .code
26012 sasl:
26013 driver = gsasl
26014 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26015 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26016 server_set_id = $auth1
26017 .endd
26018
26019
26020 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26021 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26022 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26023 the password itself.
26024
26025 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26026 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26027 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26028 if available, else the empty string.
26029 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26030 else the empty string.
26031
26032 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26033
26034 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26035 option to be simply "true".
26036
26037
26038 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26039 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26040 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26041
26042
26043 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26044 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26045 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26046 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26047
26048
26049 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26050 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26051 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26052 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26053
26054
26055 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26056 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26057 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26058
26059
26060 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26061 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26062 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26063 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26064
26065 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26066 meanings for these variables:
26067
26068 .ilist
26069 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26070 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26071 .next
26072 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26073 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26074 .next
26075 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26076 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26077 .endlist
26078
26079 On a per-mechanism basis:
26080
26081 .ilist
26082 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26083 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26084 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26085 .next
26086 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26087 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26088 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26089 .next
26090 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26091 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26092 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26093 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26094 .endlist
26095
26096 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26097 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26098 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26099
26100
26101 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26102 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26103 .code
26104 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26105 driver = gsasl
26106 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26107 server_realm = imap.example.org
26108 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26109 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26110 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26111 server_condition = yes
26112 .endd
26113
26114
26115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26117
26118 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26119 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26120 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26121 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26122 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26123 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26124 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26125 reliably.
26126
26127 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26128 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26129 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26130 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26131
26132 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26133 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26134 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26135 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26136
26137 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26138 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26139 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26140 from the keytab.
26141
26142
26143 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26144 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26145 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26146 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26147
26148 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26149 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26150 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26151 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26152
26153 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26154 .ilist
26155 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26156 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26157 .next
26158 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26159 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26160 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26161 GSS Display Name.
26162 .endlist
26163
26164
26165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26167
26168 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26169 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26170 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26171 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26172 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26173 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26174 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26175 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26176 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26177 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26178 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26179 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26180 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26181 follows:
26182
26183 .ilist
26184 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26185 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26186 .next
26187 The server sends back a challenge.
26188 .next
26189 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26190 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26191 .endlist
26192
26193 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26194
26195
26196
26197 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26198 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26199 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26200
26201 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26202 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26203 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26204 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26205 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26206 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26207 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26208 for other things. For example:
26209 .code
26210 spa:
26211 driver = spa
26212 public_name = NTLM
26213 server_password = \
26214 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26215 .endd
26216 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26217 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26218
26219
26220
26221
26222
26223 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26224 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26225 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26226
26227
26228
26229 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26230 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26231
26232
26233 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26234 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26235
26236
26237 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26238 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26239 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26240 &'msn.com'&:
26241 .code
26242 msn:
26243 driver = spa
26244 public_name = MSN
26245 client_username = msn/msn_username
26246 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26247 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26248 .endd
26249 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26250 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26251
26252
26253
26254
26255
26256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26258
26259 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26260 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26261 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26262 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26263 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26264 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26265 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26266 authentication based on client certificates.
26267
26268 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26269 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26270 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26271 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26272 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26273 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26274
26275 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26276 for which it must have been requested via the
26277 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26278 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26279
26280 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26281 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26282 and can authenticate the connection.
26283 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26284
26285 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26286
26287
26288 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26289 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26290
26291 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26292 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26293 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26294 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26295 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26296 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26297
26298 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26299 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26300 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26301
26302 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26303
26304
26305 Example:
26306 .code
26307 tls:
26308 driver = tls
26309 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26310 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26311 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26312 {!= {0} \
26313 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26314 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26315 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26316 } } } }
26317 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26318 .endd
26319 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26320 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26321
26322
26323 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26324 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26325 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26326
26327
26328
26329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26331
26332 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26333 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26334 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26335 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26336 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26337 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26338 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26339 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26340 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26341 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26342 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26343 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26344 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26345 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26346 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26347 certificates are used.
26348
26349 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26350 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26351 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26352 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26353 between them is encrypted.
26354
26355 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26356 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26357 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26358 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26359 encryption state.
26360
26361 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26362 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26363 in order to get TLS to work.
26364
26365
26366
26367 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26368 "SECID284"
26369 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26370 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26371 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26372 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26373 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26374 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26375 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26376 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26377 allocated for this purpose.
26378
26379 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26380 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26381 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26382 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26383 .code
26384 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26385 .endd
26386 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26387 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26388 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26389 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26390 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26391 defined elsewhere.
26392
26393 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26394 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26395
26396
26397
26398
26399
26400
26401 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26402 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26403 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26404 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26405 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26406 .code
26407 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26408 .endd
26409 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26410 .code
26411 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26412 .endd
26413 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26414 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26415
26416 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26417
26418 .ilist
26419 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26420 cannot be the path of a directory
26421 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26422 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26423 .next
26424 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26425 .next
26426 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26427 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26428 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26429 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26430 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26431 .next
26432 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26433 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26434 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26435 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26436 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26437 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26438 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26439 option).
26440 .next
26441 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26442 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26443 .next
26444 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26445 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26446 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26447 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26448 .next
26449 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26450 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26451 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26452 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26453 .endlist
26454
26455
26456 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26457 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26458 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26459 but not the chosen filename.
26460 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26461 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26462
26463 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26464 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26465 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26466 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26467 of bits requested.
26468 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26469 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26470 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26471 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26472 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26473 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26474 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26475
26476 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26477 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26478 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26479 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26480 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26481
26482 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26483 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26484 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26485 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26486 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26487 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26488
26489 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26490 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26491 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26492
26493 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26494 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26495 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26496 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26497 .code
26498 # ls
26499 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26500 # rm -f new-params
26501 # touch new-params
26502 # chown exim:exim new-params
26503 # chmod 0600 new-params
26504 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26505 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26506 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26507 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26508 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26509 # chmod 0400 new-params
26510 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26511 .endd
26512 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26513 stalling is removed.
26514
26515 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26516 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26517 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26518 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26519 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26520 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26521 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26522 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26523 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26524 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26525 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26526
26527 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26528 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26529 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26530 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26531
26532 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26533 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26534 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26535 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26536 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26537
26538
26539 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26540 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26541 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26542 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26543 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26544 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26545 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26546 directly to this function call.
26547 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26548 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26549 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26550 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26551
26552 .ilist
26553 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26554 .next
26555 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26556 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26557 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26558 SSL v3 algorithms.
26559 .next
26560 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26561 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26562 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26563 algorithms.
26564 .endlist
26565
26566 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26567 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26568 .ilist
26569 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26570 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26571 stated.
26572 .next
26573 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26574 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26575 .next
26576 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26577 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26578 .endlist
26579
26580 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26581 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26582 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26583 not be moved to the end of the list.
26584 .endlist
26585
26586 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26587 string:
26588 .code
26589 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26590 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26591 .endd
26592
26593 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26594 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26595 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26596 choice of clients used:
26597 .code
26598 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26599 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26600 {DEFAULT}\
26601 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26602 .endd
26603
26604
26605
26606 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26607 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26608 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26609 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26610 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26611 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26612 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26613 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26614 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26615 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26616 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26617 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26618
26619 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26620 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26621
26622 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26623 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26624 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26625 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26626 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26627 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26628
26629 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26630 "Priority strings". This is online as
26631 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26632 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26633 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26634 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26635 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26636
26637 For example:
26638 .code
26639 # Disable older versions of protocols
26640 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26641 .endd
26642
26643 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26644 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26645 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26646
26647 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26648 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26649 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26650 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26651 used:
26652 .code
26653 # GnuTLS variant
26654 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26655 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26656 {SECURE128}}
26657 .endd
26658
26659
26660 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26661 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26662 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26663 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26664 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26665 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26666 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26667 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26668
26669 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26670 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26671 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26672 with the error
26673 .code
26674 554 Security failure
26675 .endd
26676 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26677 rejected with a 554 error code.
26678
26679 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26680 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26681 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26682 without some further configuration at the server end.
26683
26684 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26685 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26686 .code
26687 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26688 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26689 .endd
26690 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26691 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26692 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26693 that goes with it. These files need to be
26694 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26695 always be given as full path names.
26696 The key must not be password-protected.
26697 They can be the same file if both the
26698 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26699 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26700 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26701 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26702 the server's certificate.
26703
26704 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26705 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26706 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26707
26708 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26709 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26710 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26711 transport.
26712
26713 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26714 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26715 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26716 .code
26717 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26718 .endd
26719 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26720 with the parameters contained in the file.
26721 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26722 available:
26723 .code
26724 tls_dhparam = none
26725 .endd
26726 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26727 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26728 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26729 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26730
26731 See the command
26732 .code
26733 openssl dhparam
26734 .endd
26735 for a way of generating file data.
26736
26737 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26738 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26739 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26740 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26741 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26742
26743 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26744 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26745 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26746 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26747 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26748 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26749 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26750 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26751 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26752
26753 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26754 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26755 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26756 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26757 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26758 documentation for more details.
26759
26760 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26761 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26762
26763
26764 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26765 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26766 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26767 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26768 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26769 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26770 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26771 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26772 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26773 expected certificates.
26774 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26775 an explicit file or,
26776 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26777 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26778
26779 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26780 directory is used
26781 (OpenSSL only),
26782 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26783 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26784 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26785 .code
26786 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26787 .endd
26788 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26789
26790 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26791 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26792 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26793 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26794 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26795 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26796 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26797 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26798 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26799 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26800
26801 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26802 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26803 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26804 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26805
26806 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26807 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26808 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26809 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26810 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26811 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26812
26813
26814 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26815 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26816 .cindex "revocation list"
26817 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26818 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26819 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26820 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26821 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26822 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26823 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26824 CRL in PEM format.
26825 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26826 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26827
26828 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26829 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26830 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26831 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26832 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26833 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26834
26835 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26836 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26837 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26838 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26839
26840 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26841 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26842 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26843 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26844 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26845 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26846 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26847 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26848
26849 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26850 .new
26851 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
26852 .wen
26853 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26854
26855 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26856 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26857 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26858 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26859 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26860
26861 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26862 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26863 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26864 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26865 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26866 next connection.
26867
26868 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26869 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26870 ignored.
26871
26872 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26873 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26874 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26875 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26876 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26877 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26878
26879 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26880 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26881
26882 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26883
26884 .code
26885 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26886 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26887 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26888
26889 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26890 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26891 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26892 .endd
26893
26894
26895
26896
26897 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26898 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26899 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26900 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26901 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26902 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26903 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26904 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26905 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26906
26907 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26908 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26909 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26910 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26911 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26912
26913 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26914 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26915 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26916 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26917 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26918 usual way.
26919
26920 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26921 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26922 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26923 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26924 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26925 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26926 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26927 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26928 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26929 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26930 unencrypted.
26931
26932 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26933 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26934 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26935 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26936
26937 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26938 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26939 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26940 a file or,
26941 depending on library version, a directory,
26942 must name a file or,
26943 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26944 The client verifies the server's certificate
26945 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26946 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26947 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26948 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26949
26950 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26951 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26952 or need not succeed respectively.
26953
26954 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26955 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26956 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26957 value is empty.
26958 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26959 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26960 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26961 otherwise.
26962
26963 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26964 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26965 for OCSP to be relevant.
26966
26967 If
26968 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26969 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26970 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26971 alternative hosts, if any.
26972
26973 &*Note*&:
26974 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26975 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26976 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26977 client.
26978
26979 .vindex "&$host$&"
26980 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26981 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26982 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26983 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26984 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26985
26986 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26987 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26988 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26989 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26990 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26991 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26992 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26993 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26994 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26995 outgoing connection.
26996
26997
26998
26999 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27000 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27001 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27002 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27003 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27004 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27005 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27006 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27007 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27008 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27009 for this session.
27010
27011 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27012 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27013 address.
27014
27015 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27016 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27017 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27018 be of limited use in that environment.
27019
27020 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27021 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27022 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27023 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27024 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27025
27026 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27027 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27028 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27029 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27030 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27031
27032 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27033 received from a client.
27034 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27035
27036 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27037 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27038 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27039
27040 .ilist
27041 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27042 &%tls_certificate%&
27043 .next
27044 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27045 &%tls_crl%&
27046 .next
27047 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27048 &%tls_privatekey%&
27049 .next
27050 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27051 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27052 .next
27053 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27054 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27055 .endlist
27056
27057 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27058 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27059 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27060 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27061
27062 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27063 are re-expanded.
27064
27065 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27066 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27067 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27068 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27069
27070 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27071 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27072 built, then you have SNI support).
27073
27074
27075
27076 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27077 "SECTmulmessam"
27078 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27079 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27080 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27081 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27082 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27083 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27084 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27085 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27086 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27087 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27088 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27089
27090 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27091 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27092 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27093 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27094 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27095 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27096 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27097 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27098 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27099
27100 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27101 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27102 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27103 information is recorded.
27104
27105 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27106 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27107 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27108
27109
27110
27111
27112 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27113 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27114 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27115 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27116 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27117 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27118 to Apache, currently at
27119 .display
27120 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27121 .endd
27122 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27123 links to further files.
27124 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27125 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27126 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27127 .display
27128 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27129 .endd
27130
27131
27132 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27133 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27134 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27135 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27136 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27137 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27138 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27139 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27140 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27141 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27142 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27143 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27144 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27145
27146 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27147 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27148 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27149 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27150
27151
27152
27153 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27154 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27155 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27156 with OpenSSL, like this:
27157 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27158 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27159 .code
27160 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27161 -days 9999 -nodes
27162 .endd
27163 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27164 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27165 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27166 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27167 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27168 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27169 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27170
27171 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27172 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27173 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27174 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27175 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27176 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27177 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27178 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27179 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27180 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27181 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27182 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27183 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27184 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27185 be a sensible resolution).
27186
27187 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27188 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27189 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27190
27191 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27192 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27193 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27194 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27195 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27196 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27197
27198 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27199 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27200 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27201 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27202 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27203 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27204
27205
27206
27207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27209
27210 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27211 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27212 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27213 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27214 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27215 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27216 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27217 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27218 one very small ACL:
27219 .code
27220 begin acl
27221 small_acl:
27222 accept hosts = one.host.only
27223 .endd
27224 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27225 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27226
27227 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27228 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27229 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27230 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27231 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27232 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27233 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27234 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27235
27236
27237 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27238 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27239 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27240 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27241 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27242
27243
27244
27245 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27246 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27247 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27248 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27249 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27250 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27251 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27252 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27253 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27254 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27255 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27256 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27257 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27258 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27259 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27260 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27261 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27262 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27263 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27264 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27265
27266 .table2 140pt
27267 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27268 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27269 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27270 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27271 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27272 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27273 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27274 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27275 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27276 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27277 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27278 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27279 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27280 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27281 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27282 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27283 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27284 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27285 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27286 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27287 .endtable
27288
27289 For example, if you set
27290 .code
27291 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27292 .endd
27293 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27294 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27295 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27296 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27297 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27298 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27299 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27300
27301
27302 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27303 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27304 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27305 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27306 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27307 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27308 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27309 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27310 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27311 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27312 in any of these ACLs.
27313
27314 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27315 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27316 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27317 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27318 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27319 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27320 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27321 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27322 .code
27323 control = suppress_local_fixups
27324 .endd
27325 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27326 run, it is too late.
27327
27328 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27329 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27330
27331 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27332 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27333 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27334
27335
27336 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27337 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27338 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27339 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27340 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27341 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27342 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27343 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27344 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27345
27346
27347 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27348 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27349 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27350 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27351 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27352 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27353 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27354 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27355 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27356
27357 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27358 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27359 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27360 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27361 an EHLO response.
27362
27363
27364 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27365 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27366 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27367 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27368 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27369 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27370 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27371 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27372 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27373 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27374
27375 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27376 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27377 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27378 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27379 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27380 associated with the DATA command.
27381
27382 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27383 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27384 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27385 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27386 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27387 your resources.
27388
27389 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27390 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27391 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27392 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27393
27394 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27395 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27396 enabled (which is the default).
27397
27398 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27399 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27400 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27401
27402 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27403
27404 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27405
27406
27407 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27408 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27409 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27410
27411 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27412
27413
27414 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27415 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27416 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27417 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27418 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27419 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27420 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27421 has been accepted.
27422
27423 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27424 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27425 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27426 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27427 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27428 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27429 for some or all recipients.
27430
27431 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27432 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27433 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27434 .new
27435 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27436 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27437 is &"yes"&.
27438 .wen
27439 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27440 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27441 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27442
27443 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27444 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27445
27446 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27447 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27448 the feature was not requested by the client.
27449
27450 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27451 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27452 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27453 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27454 does not in fact control any access.
27455 For this reason, it may only accept
27456 or warn as its final result.
27457
27458 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27459 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27460 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27461 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27462
27463 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27464 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27465
27466 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27467 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27468 response to QUIT.
27469
27470 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27471 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27472 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27473 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27474 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27475
27476
27477 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27478 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27479 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27480 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27481 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27482 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27483 situation even worse.
27484
27485 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27486 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27487 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27488 and &%warn%&.
27489
27490 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27491 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27492 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27493 connection. The possible values are:
27494 .table2
27495 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27496 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27497 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27498 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27499 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27500 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27501 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27502 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27503 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27504 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27505 .endtable
27506 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27507 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27508 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27509 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27510 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27511 used.
27512
27513
27514 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27515 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27516 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27517 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27518 .code
27519 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27520 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27521 .endd
27522 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27523 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27524 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27525 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27526 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27527
27528 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27529 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27530 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27531
27532 .ilist
27533 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27534 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27535 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27536 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27537 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27538 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27539 .code
27540 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27541 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27542 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27543 .endd
27544 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27545 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27546 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27547 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27548 .next
27549 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27550 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27551 matches the string.
27552 .next
27553 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27554 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27555 want to have something like
27556 .code
27557 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27558 .endd
27559 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27560 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27561 .endlist
27562
27563
27564
27565
27566 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27567 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27568 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27569 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27570 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27571 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27572 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27573 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27574 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27575
27576 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27577 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27578 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27579
27580
27581 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27582 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27583 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27584 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27585
27586 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27587 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27588 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27589 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27590 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27591 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27592 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27593
27594
27595 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27596 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27597 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27598
27599
27600
27601 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27602 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27603 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27604 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27605 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27606 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27607
27608 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27609 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27610 used to accept or reject anything.
27611
27612 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27613 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27614 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27615 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27616
27617 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27618 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27619 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27620 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27621 configuration file.
27622
27623
27624
27625
27626 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27627 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27628 .vindex &$domain$&
27629 .vindex &$local_part$&
27630 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27631 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27632 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27633 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27634 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27635 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27636 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27637 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27638 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27639
27640 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27641 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27642 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27643 how it is used.
27644
27645 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27646 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27647 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27648 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27649 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27650 received).
27651
27652 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27653 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27654 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27655 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27656 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27657 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27658 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27659 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27660
27661
27662
27663
27664
27665 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27666 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27667 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27668 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27669 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27670 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27671 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27672 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27673 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27674 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27675 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27676 unencrypted connections.
27677 .code
27678 acl_check_auth:
27679 accept encrypted = *
27680 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27681 {CRAM-MD5}}
27682 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27683 .endd
27684 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27685 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27686 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27687 option to do this.)
27688
27689
27690
27691 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27692 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27693 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27694 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27695 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27696 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27697 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27698
27699 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27700 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27701 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27702 example:
27703 .code
27704 deny dnslists = list1.example
27705 dnslists = list2.example
27706 .endd
27707 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27708 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27709 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27710 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27711 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27712
27713
27714 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27715 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27716
27717 .ilist
27718 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27719 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27720 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27721 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27722 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27723 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27724 check a RCPT command:
27725 .code
27726 accept domains = +local_domains
27727 endpass
27728 verify = recipient
27729 .endd
27730 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27731 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27732 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27733 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27734 &%endpass%&.
27735
27736 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27737 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27738 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27739 configuration.
27740
27741 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27742 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27743 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27744 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27745 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27746 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27747 .display
27748 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27749 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27750 .endd
27751 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27752 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27753 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27754
27755 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27756 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27757 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27758 of &%endpass%&.
27759
27760
27761 .next
27762 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27763 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27764 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27765 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27766 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27767 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27768 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27769
27770
27771 .next
27772 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27773 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27774 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27775 example,
27776 .code
27777 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27778 .endd
27779 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27780
27781
27782 .next
27783 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27784 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27785 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27786 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27787 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27788 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27789 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27790 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27791 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27792
27793 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27794 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27795 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27796
27797
27798 .next
27799 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27800 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27801 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27802 .code
27803 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27804 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27805 .endd
27806 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27807 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27808
27809 .next
27810 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27811 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27812 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27813 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27814 .code
27815 require message = Sender did not verify
27816 verify = sender
27817 .endd
27818 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27819 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27820 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27821 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27822
27823 .next
27824 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27825 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27826 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27827 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27828 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27829 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27830 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27831
27832 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27833 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27834 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27835 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27836 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27837
27838 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27839 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27840 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27841 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27842 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27843 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27844 onwards.
27845
27846
27847 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27848 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27849 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27850 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27851 .code
27852 warn !verify = sender
27853 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27854 .endd
27855 .endlist
27856
27857 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27858
27859 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27860 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27861 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27862 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27863 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27864
27865
27866
27867 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27868 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27869 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27870 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27871 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27872 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27873 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27874 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27875 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27876 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27877 .ilist
27878 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27879 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27880 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27881 on the same SMTP connection.
27882 .next
27883 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27884 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27885 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27886 .endlist
27887
27888 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27889 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27890 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27891 .code
27892 accept hosts = whatever
27893 set acl_m4 = some value
27894 accept authenticated = *
27895 set acl_c_auth = yes
27896 .endd
27897 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27898 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27899 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27900
27901 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27902 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27903 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27904 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27905 error is generated.
27906
27907 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27908 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27909
27910
27911 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27912 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27913 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27914 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27915 .code
27916 deny domains = *.dom.example
27917 !verify = recipient
27918 .endd
27919 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27920 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27921 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27922 two statements are equivalent:
27923 .code
27924 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27925 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27926 .endd
27927 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27928 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27929
27930 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27931 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27932 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27933 .code
27934 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27935 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27936 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27937 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27938 .endd
27939 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27940 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27941 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27942 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27943 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27944 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27945 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27946
27947 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27948 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27949 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27950 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27951 message is handled.
27952
27953 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27954 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27955 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27956 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27957 .code
27958 require message = Can't verify sender
27959 verify = sender
27960 message = Can't verify recipient
27961 verify = recipient
27962 message = This message cannot be used
27963 .endd
27964 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27965 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27966 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27967 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27968 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27969 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27970
27971 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27972 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27973 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27974 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27975 .code
27976 deny hosts = ...
27977 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27978 message = Invalid sender from client host
27979 .endd
27980 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27981 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27982
27983
27984
27985 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27986 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27987 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27988
27989 .vlist
27990 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27991 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27992 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27993 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27994
27995 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27996 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27997 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27998 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27999 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28000 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28001 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28002 write rather ugly lines like this:
28003 .display
28004 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28005 .endd
28006 Instead, all you need is
28007 .display
28008 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28009 .endd
28010
28011 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28012 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28013 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28014 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28015 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28016 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28017 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28018 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28019
28020 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28021 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28022 in several different ways. For example:
28023
28024 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28025 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28026 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28027 . ==== way.
28028
28029 .ilist
28030 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28031 .code
28032 accept ...some conditions
28033 control = queue_only
28034 .endd
28035 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28036 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28037
28038 .next
28039 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28040 .code
28041 accept ...some conditions...
28042 control = queue_only
28043 ...some more conditions...
28044 .endd
28045 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28046 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28047 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28048 to be relevant.
28049
28050 .next
28051 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28052 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28053 example:
28054 .code
28055 warn ...some conditions...
28056 control = freeze
28057 accept ...
28058 .endd
28059 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28060 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28061 log entry.
28062
28063 .next
28064 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28065 &%require%& verb. For example:
28066 .code
28067 require control = no_multiline_responses
28068 .endd
28069 .endlist
28070
28071 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28072 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28073 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28074 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28075 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28076 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28077 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28078 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28079 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28080
28081 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28082 example:
28083 .code
28084 deny ...some conditions...
28085 delay = 30s
28086 .endd
28087 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28088 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28089 .code
28090 deny delay = 30s
28091 ...some conditions...
28092 .endd
28093 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28094 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28095 .code
28096 warn ...some conditions...
28097 delay = 2m
28098 control = freeze
28099 accept ...
28100 .endd
28101
28102 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28103 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28104 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28105 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28106 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28107 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28108 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28109
28110
28111 .vitem &*endpass*&
28112 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28113 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28114 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28115 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28116 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28117 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28118 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28119
28120
28121 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28122 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28123 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28124 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28125 .code
28126 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28127 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28128 .endd
28129 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28130 example:
28131 .display
28132 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28133 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28134 .endd
28135 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28136 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28137 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28138 message.
28139
28140 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28141 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28142 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28143 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28144 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28145 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28146 ignored.
28147
28148 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28149 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28150 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28151 error message.
28152
28153 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28154 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28155 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28156 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28157 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28158 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28159
28160 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28161 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28162 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28163 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28164 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28165 logging rejections.
28166
28167
28168 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28169 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28170 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28171 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28172 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28173 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28174 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28175 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28176 .display
28177 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28178 &` log_reject_target =`&
28179 .endd
28180 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28181 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28182 current ACL.
28183
28184
28185 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28186 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28187 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28188 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28189 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28190 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28191 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28192 ACLs. For example:
28193 .display
28194 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28195 &` control = freeze`&
28196 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28197 .endd
28198 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28199 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28200 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28201 example:
28202 .code
28203 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28204 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28205 .endd
28206
28207
28208 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28209 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28210 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28211 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28212 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28213 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28214 &%accept%& for details.)
28215
28216 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28217 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28218 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28219 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28220 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28221 .code
28222 require message = Host not recognized
28223 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28224 .endd
28225 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28226 processed.)
28227
28228 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28229 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28230 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28231 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28232 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28233 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28234 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28235 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28236 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28237 EHLO options.
28238
28239 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28240 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28241 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28242 .code
28243 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28244 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28245 .endd
28246 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28247 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28248 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28249 2&'xx'&.
28250
28251 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28252 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28253
28254 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28255 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28256 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28257 response.
28258
28259 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28260 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28261 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28262
28263 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28264 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28265 However, the original message is available in the variable
28266 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28267 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28268 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28269 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28270
28271 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28272 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28273 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28274 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28275 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28276 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28277 effect.
28278
28279
28280 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28281 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28282 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28283 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28284
28285
28286 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28287 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28288 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28289 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28290
28291
28292 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28293 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28294 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28295 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28296 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28297 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28298 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28299 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28300 when:
28301 .code
28302 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28303 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28304 .endd
28305 .endlist
28306
28307
28308
28309
28310 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28311 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28312 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28313
28314 .vlist
28315 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28316 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28317 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28318 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28319 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28320 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28321 not work without it. For example:
28322 .code
28323 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28324 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28325 .endd
28326 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28327 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28328 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28329 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28330 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28331
28332
28333 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28334 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28335 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28336 .cindex "case of local parts"
28337 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28338 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28339 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28340 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28341 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28342 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28343 is encountered.
28344
28345 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28346 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28347 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28348 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28349 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28350
28351 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28352 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28353 spam score:
28354 .code
28355 warn control = caseful_local_part
28356 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28357 $acl_m4 + \
28358 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28359 }
28360 control = caselower_local_part
28361 .endd
28362 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28363 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28364
28365
28366 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28367 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28368 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28369 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28370
28371 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28372 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28373 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28374 is used for all recipients of the message,
28375 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28376 and data is copied from one to the other.
28377
28378 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28379 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28380 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28381 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28382 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28383 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28384
28385 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28386 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28387 Note also that headers cannot be
28388 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28389 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28390
28391 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28392 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28393 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28394 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28395
28396 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28397 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28398 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28399 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28400 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28401 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28402
28403 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28404 (possibly faked)
28405 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28406
28407
28408 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28409 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28410 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28411 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28412 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28413 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28414 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28415 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28416 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28417 contexts):
28418 .code
28419 control = debug
28420 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28421 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28422 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28423 .endd
28424
28425
28426 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28427 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28428 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28429 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28430 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28431
28432
28433 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28434 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28435 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28436 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28437 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28438 strings or to numeric value.
28439 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28440 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28441 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28442
28443 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28444 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28445 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28446 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28447 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28448
28449
28450 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28451 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28452 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28453 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28454 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28455 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28456 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28457 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28458
28459 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28460 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28461 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28462 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28463 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28464 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28465 work with.
28466
28467
28468 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28469 .cindex "fake defer"
28470 .cindex "defer, fake"
28471 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28472 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28473 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28474 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28475 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28476
28477 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28478 .cindex "fake rejection"
28479 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28480 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28481 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28482 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28483 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28484 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28485 the same SMTP connection.
28486
28487 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28488 message is supplied, the following is used:
28489 .code
28490 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28491 550-kept for evaluation.
28492 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28493 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28494 .endd
28495 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28496
28497 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28498 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28499 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28500 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28501 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28502 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28503 SMTP connection.
28504
28505 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28506 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28507 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28508 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28509
28510 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28511 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28512 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28513 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28514 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28515 disables such output flushing.
28516
28517 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28518 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28519 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28520 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28521 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28522 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28523
28524 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28525 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28526 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28527 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28528 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28529 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28530 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28531 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28532 to be useful in production.
28533
28534 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28535 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28536 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28537 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28538 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28539
28540 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28541 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28542 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28543 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28544 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28545 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28546
28547 .ilist
28548 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28549 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28550 verification failed"&) is sent.
28551 .next
28552 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28553 line is output.
28554 .endlist
28555
28556 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28557 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28558
28559 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28560 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28561 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28562 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28563 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28564 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28565 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28566
28567 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28568 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28569 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28570 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28571 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28572 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28573 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28574 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28575 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28576 same SMTP connection.
28577
28578 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28579 .cindex "message" "submission"
28580 .cindex "submission mode"
28581 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28582 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28583 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28584 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28585 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28586 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28587 late (the message has already been created).
28588
28589 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28590 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28591 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28592 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28593 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28594
28595 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28596 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28597 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28598 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28599 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28600
28601 .ilist
28602 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28603 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28604 .next
28605 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28606 .next
28607 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28608 .endlist ilist
28609
28610 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28611 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28612 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28613 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28614 data is read.
28615
28616 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28617 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28618 .endlist vlist
28619
28620
28621 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28622 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28623
28624 .ilist
28625 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28626 .next
28627 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28628 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28629 .next
28630 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28631 .next
28632 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28633 .endlist
28634
28635
28636
28637 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28638 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28639 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28640 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28641 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28642 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28643 .code
28644 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28645 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28646 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28647 .endd
28648 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28649 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28650 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28651 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28652 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28653 RCPT ACL).
28654
28655 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28656 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28657
28658 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28659 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28660 contains one or more newlines that
28661 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28662 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28663 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28664
28665 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28666 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28667 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28668 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28669 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28670 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28671 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28672 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28673 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28674 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28675 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28676
28677 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28678 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28679 of message headers
28680 until they are added to the
28681 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28682 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28683 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28684 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28685 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28686 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28687 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28688
28689 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28690
28691 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28692 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28693 .display
28694 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28695 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28696
28697 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28698 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28699 .endd
28700 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28701 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28702 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28703 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28704 honoured.
28705
28706 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28707 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28708 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28709 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28710 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28711 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28712 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28713 specifications.
28714
28715 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28716 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28717 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28718 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28719 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28720
28721 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28722 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28723 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28724 to be a header name first.) For example:
28725 .code
28726 warn add_header = \
28727 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28728 .endd
28729 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28730 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28731 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28732 up in reverse order.
28733
28734 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28735 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28736 system filter or in a router or transport.
28737
28738
28739
28740 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28741 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28742 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28743 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28744 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28745 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28746 .code
28747 warn message = Remove internal headers
28748 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28749 .endd
28750 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28751 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28752 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28753 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28754 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28755 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28756
28757 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28758 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28759
28760 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28761 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28762 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28763 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28764 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28765 .code
28766 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28767 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28768 warn message = Remove internal headers
28769 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28770 .endd
28771 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28772 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28773 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28774 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28775 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28776 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28777 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28778 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28779 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28780 would have been removed.
28781
28782 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28783 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28784 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28785 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28786 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28787 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28788 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28789 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28790 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28791
28792 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28793 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28794 .display
28795 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28796 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28797
28798 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28799 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28800 .endd
28801 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28802 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28803 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28804 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28805 are honoured.
28806
28807 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28808 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28809 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28810
28811
28812
28813
28814 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28815 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28816 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28817 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28818 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28819 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28820
28821 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28822 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28823 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28824 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28825 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28826 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28827 The conditions are as follows:
28828
28829
28830 .vlist
28831 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28832 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28833 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28834 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28835 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28836 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28837 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28838 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28839 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28840 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28841 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28842 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28843
28844 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28845 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28846 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28847 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28848 The name and values are expanded separately.
28849 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28850 will act as argument separators.
28851
28852 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28853 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28854 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28855 conditions are tested.
28856
28857 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28858 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28859 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28860 for different local users or different local domains.
28861
28862 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28863 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28864 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28865 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28866 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28867 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28868 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28869 .code
28870 authenticated = *
28871 .endd
28872
28873 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28874 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28875 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28876 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28877 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28878 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28879 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28880 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28881 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28882 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28883 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28884 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28885 negative.
28886
28887 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28888 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28889 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28890 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28891 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28892 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28893 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28894 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28895
28896 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28897 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28898 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28899 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28900 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28901
28902 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28903 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28904 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28905 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28906 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28907 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28908 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28909 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28910 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28911 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28912
28913 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28914 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28915 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28916 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28917 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28918 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28919 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28920 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28921 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28922 &%domains%& test.
28923
28924 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28925 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28926
28927
28928 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28929 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28930 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28931 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28932 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28933 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28934 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28935 .code
28936 encrypted = *
28937 .endd
28938
28939
28940 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28941 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28942 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28943 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28944 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28945 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28946 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28947 .code
28948 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28949 .endd
28950 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28951 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28952 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28953
28954 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28955 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28956 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28957 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28958 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28959 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28960
28961 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28962 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28963 .code
28964 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28965 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28966 .endd
28967 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28968 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28969 statement can then check the IP address.
28970
28971 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28972 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28973 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28974 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28975 .code
28976 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28977 message = $host_data
28978 .endd
28979 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28980
28981 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28982 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28983 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28984 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28985 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28986 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28987 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28988 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28989 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28990 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28991
28992 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28993 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28994 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28995 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28996 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28997 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28998 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28999
29000 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29001 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29002 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29003 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29004 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29005 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29006 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29007 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29008
29009 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29010 .cindex "rate limiting"
29011 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29012 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29013
29014 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29015 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29016 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29017 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29018 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29019 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29020
29021 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29022 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29023 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29024 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29025 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29026 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29027 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29028
29029 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29030 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29031 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29032 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29033 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29034 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29035 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29036 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29037 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29038 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29039 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29040 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29041 influence the sender checking.
29042
29043 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29044 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29045
29046 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29047 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29048 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29049 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29050 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29051 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29052 .code
29053 senders = :
29054 .endd
29055 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29056 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29057
29058 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29059 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29060 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29061 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29062 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29063 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29064
29065 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29066 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29067 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29068 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29069 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29070 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29071 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29072 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29073 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29074 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29075
29076 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29077 .cindex "CSA verification"
29078 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29079 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29080 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29081
29082 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29083 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29084 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29085 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29086 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29087 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29088 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29089 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29090 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29091 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29092
29093 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29094 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29095 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29096
29097 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29098 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29099 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29100 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29101 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29102 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29103 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29104 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29105 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29106 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29107 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29108 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29109 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29110 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29111 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29112
29113 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29114 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29115 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29116 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29117 .code
29118 deny senders = :
29119 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29120 !verify = header_sender
29121 .endd
29122
29123 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29124 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29125 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29126 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29127 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29128 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29129 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29130 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29131 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29132 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29133 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29134 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29135 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29136 appropriate.
29137
29138 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29139 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29140 .code
29141 To: @
29142 .endd
29143 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29144 common as they used to be.
29145
29146 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29147 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29148 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29149 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29150 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29151 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29152 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29153 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29154 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29155 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29156 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29157 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29158 independently of this condition.
29159
29160 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29161 option), this condition is always true.
29162
29163
29164 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29165 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29166 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29167 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29168 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29169 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29170 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29171 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29172 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29173
29174 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29175 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29176
29177
29178 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29179 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29180 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29181 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29182 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29183 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29184 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29185 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29186 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29187 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29188 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29189 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29190 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29191 value for the child address.
29192
29193 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29194 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29195 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29196 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29197 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29198 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29199 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29200 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29201 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29202 original IP address.
29203
29204 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29205 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29206
29207 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29208 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29209
29210 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29211 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29212 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29213 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29214 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29215 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29216 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29217 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29218 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29219
29220 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29221 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29222 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29223 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29224 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29225 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29226 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29227
29228 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29229 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29230 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29231
29232 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29233 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29234 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29235 verified as a sender.
29236 .endlist
29237
29238
29239
29240 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29241 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29242 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29243 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29244 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29245 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29246 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29247 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29248 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29249 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29250 .code
29251 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29252 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29253 .endd
29254 the following records are looked up:
29255 .code
29256 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29257 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29258 .endd
29259 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29260 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29261 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29262 use two separate conditions:
29263 .code
29264 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29265 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29266 .endd
29267 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29268 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29269 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29270 processed.
29271
29272 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29273 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29274 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29275 following special items in the list:
29276 .display
29277 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29278 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29279 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29280 .endd
29281 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29282 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29283 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29284 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29285 .code
29286 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29287 .endd
29288 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29289 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29290 .code
29291 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29292 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29293 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29294 .endd
29295 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29296 .cindex DNS TTL
29297 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29298 .new
29299 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29300 .wen
29301 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29302 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29303 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29304 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29305
29306
29307
29308 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29309 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29310 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29311 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29312 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29313 .code
29314 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29315 .endd
29316 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29317 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29318 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29319 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29320
29321
29322
29323
29324 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29325 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29326 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29327 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29328 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29329 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29330 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29331 .code
29332 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29333 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29334 .endd
29335 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29336 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29337 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29338 up by this example is
29339 .code
29340 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29341 .endd
29342 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29343 addresses. For example:
29344 .code
29345 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29346 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29347 .endd
29348 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29349 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29350
29351
29352
29353
29354 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29355 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29356 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29357 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29358 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29359 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29360 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29361 either to double the separators like this:
29362 .code
29363 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29364 .endd
29365 or to change the separator character, like this:
29366 .code
29367 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29368 .endd
29369 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29370 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29371 occurs. Consider this condition:
29372 .code
29373 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29374 .endd
29375 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29376 .code
29377 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29378 a.domain.black.list.tld
29379 .endd
29380 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29381 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29382 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29383 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29384 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29385 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29386 error for a previous item.
29387
29388 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29389 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29390 .code
29391 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29392 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29393 .endd
29394 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29395 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29396 .code
29397 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29398 $sender_address_domain \
29399 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29400 see $dnslist_text.
29401 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29402 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29403 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29404 .endd
29405 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29406 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29407 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29408 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29409 .code
29410 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29411 .endd
29412 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29413 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29414
29415 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29416 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29417
29418
29419
29420
29421 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29422 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29423 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29424 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29425 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29426 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29427 .display
29428 127.1.0.1 RBL
29429 127.1.0.2 DUL
29430 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29431 127.1.0.4 RSS
29432 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29433 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29434 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29435 .endd
29436 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29437 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29438 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29439
29440
29441 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29442 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29443 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29444 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29445 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29446 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29447 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29448 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29449 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29450 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29451 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29452 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29453 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29454 cases, for example:
29455 .code
29456 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29457 .endd
29458 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29459 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29460 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29461 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29462 .code
29463 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29464 .endd
29465 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29466 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29467
29468 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29469 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29470 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29471 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29472 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29473 information.
29474
29475 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29476 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29477 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29478 .code
29479 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29480 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29481 at $dnslist_domain
29482 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29483 .endd
29484
29485
29486
29487 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29488 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29489 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29490 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29491 For example,
29492 .code
29493 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29494 .endd
29495 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29496 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29497 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29498 describes how multiple records are handled.
29499
29500 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29501 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29502 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29503 .code
29504 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29505 .endd
29506 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29507 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29508 first. For example:
29509 .code
29510 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29511 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29512 .endd
29513
29514 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29515 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29516 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29517 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29518 tested. For example:
29519 .code
29520 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29521 .endd
29522 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29523 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29524 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29525 .code
29526 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29527 .endd
29528 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29529 an odd number.
29530
29531
29532
29533 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29534 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29535 condition. Whereas
29536 .code
29537 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29538 .endd
29539 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29540 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29541 .code
29542 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29543 .endd
29544 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29545 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29546 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29547 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29548
29549 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29550 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29551
29552 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29553 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29554 .code
29555 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29556 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29557 .endd
29558 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29559 Consider this example:
29560 .code
29561 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29562 list.dsbl.org : \
29563 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29564 relays.ordb.org
29565 .endd
29566 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29567 .code
29568 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29569 list.dsbl.org
29570 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29571 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29572 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29573 .endd
29574 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29575
29576
29577
29578
29579 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29580 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29581 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29582 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29583 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29584 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29585 .code
29586 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29587 .endd
29588 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29589 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29590 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29591 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29592 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29593 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29594
29595 .ilist
29596 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29597 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29598 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29599 .next
29600 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29601 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29602 changed to:
29603 .code
29604 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29605 .endd
29606 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29607 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29608 .code
29609 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29610 .endd
29611 for the condition to be true.
29612 .endlist
29613
29614 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29615 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29616 .ilist
29617 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29618 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29619 .code
29620 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29621 .endd
29622 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29623 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29624 .next
29625 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29626 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29627 .code
29628 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29629 .endd
29630 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29631 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29632 .code
29633 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29634 .endd
29635 for the condition to be false.
29636 .endlist
29637 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29638 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29639
29640
29641
29642
29643 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29644 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29645 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29646 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29647 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29648 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29649 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29650 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29651 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29652 lists.
29653
29654 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29655 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29656 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29657 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29658 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29659 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29660 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29661 .code
29662 reject message = \
29663 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29664 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29665 dnslists = \
29666 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29667 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29668 .endd
29669 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29670 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29671 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29672 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29673 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29674 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29675
29676 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29677 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29678 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29679 .code
29680 reject dnslists = \
29681 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29682 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29683 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29684 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29685 .endd
29686 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29687 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29688 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29689
29690
29691
29692 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29693 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29694 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29695 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29696 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29697 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29698 .code
29699 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29700 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29701 .endd
29702 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29703 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29704 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29705 .code
29706 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29707 .endd
29708 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29709 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29710
29711 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29712 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29713 .code
29714 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29715 dnslists = some.list.example
29716 .endd
29717
29718 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29719 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29720 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29721 .code
29722 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29723 .endd
29724
29725 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29726 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29727 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29728 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29729 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29730 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29731 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29732 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29733 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29734 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29735 .display
29736 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29737 .endd
29738 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29739 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29740
29741 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29742 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29743 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29744 of &'p'&.
29745
29746 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29747 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29748 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29749 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29750 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29751 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29752 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29753 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29754 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29755
29756 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29757 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29758 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29759 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29760
29761 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29762 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29763 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29764 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29765 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29766 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29767 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29768 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29769 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29770 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29771
29772 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29773 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29774 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29775 ACL.
29776
29777 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29778 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29779 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29780 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29781 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29782 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29783
29784 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29785 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29786 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29787 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29788 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29789 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29790 the &%count=%& option.
29791
29792
29793 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29794 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29795 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29796 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29797 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29798
29799 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29800 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29801 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29802 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29803
29804 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29805 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29806 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29807 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29808 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29809 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29810 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29811
29812 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29813 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29814 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29815 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29816 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29817 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29818 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29819
29820 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29821 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29822 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29823 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29824 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29825
29826 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29827 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29828 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29829 multiple different commands.
29830
29831 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29832 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29833 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29834 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29835 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29836
29837 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29838
29839
29840 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29841 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29842 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29843 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29844 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29845
29846 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29847 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29848
29849 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29850 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29851 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29852 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29853 new rate.
29854 .code
29855 acl_check_connect:
29856 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29857 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29858 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29859 # ...
29860 acl_check_mail:
29861 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29862 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29863 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29864 .endd
29865
29866 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29867 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29868 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29869 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29870 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29871 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29872 checks.
29873
29874 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29875 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29876 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29877 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29878 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29879
29880
29881 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29882 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29883 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29884 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29885 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29886 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29887 rest of the ACL.
29888
29889 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29890 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29891 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29892 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29893 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29894 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29895 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29896 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29897 from getting any email through.
29898
29899 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29900 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29901 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29902 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29903 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29904 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29905 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29906 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29907 .code
29908 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29909 .endd
29910
29911
29912 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29913 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29914 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29915 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29916 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29917 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29918 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29919 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29920 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29921
29922 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29923 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29924 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29925 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29926 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29927 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29928
29929 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29930 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29931 rate.
29932
29933 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29934 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29935 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29936 required increases with larger limits.
29937
29938 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29939 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29940 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29941 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29942 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29943 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29944 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29945 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29946 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29947 as intended.
29948
29949
29950 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29951 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29952 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29953 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29954 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29955 message. For example:
29956 .code
29957 # Log all senders' rates
29958 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29959 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29960
29961 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29962 # at the decimal point.
29963 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29964 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29965 $sender_rate_limit }s
29966
29967 # Keep authenticated users under control
29968 deny authenticated = *
29969 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29970
29971 # System-wide rate limit
29972 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29973 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29974
29975 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29976 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29977 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29978 messages per $sender_rate_period
29979 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29980 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29981 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29982 .endd
29983 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29984 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29985 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29986 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29987 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29988 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29989 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29990
29991
29992
29993 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29994 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29995 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29996 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29997 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29998 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29999 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30000 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30001 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30002 .code
30003 verify = sender/callout
30004 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30005 .endd
30006 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30007 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30008 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30009 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30010 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30011 The available options are as follows:
30012
30013 .ilist
30014 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30015 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30016 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30017 .next
30018 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30019 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30020 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30021 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30022 .next
30023 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30024 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30025 .next
30026 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30027 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30028 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30029 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30030 .endlist
30031
30032 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30033 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30034 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30035 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30036 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30037 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30038 coding like this:
30039 .code
30040 warn !verify = sender
30041 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30042 .endd
30043 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30044 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30045 verification failure.
30046
30047 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30048 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30049
30050 .ilist
30051 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30052 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30053 .next
30054 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30055 .next
30056 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30057 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30058 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30059 .next
30060 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30061 .next
30062 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30063 .endlist
30064
30065 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30066 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30067
30068
30069
30070
30071 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30072 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30073 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30074 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30075 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30076 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30077 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30078 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30079 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30080 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30081 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30082 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30083 sender's domain.
30084
30085 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30086 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30087 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30088 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30089 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30090 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30091
30092 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30093 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30094 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30095 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30096 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30097
30098 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30099 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30100 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30101 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30102 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30103 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30104 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30105 supplies a host list.
30106 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30107
30108 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30109 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30110 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30111 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30112 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30113 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30114 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30115
30116 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30117 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30118 following SMTP commands are sent:
30119 .display
30120 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30121 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30122 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30123 &`QUIT`&
30124 .endd
30125 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30126 set to &"lmtp"&.
30127
30128 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30129 settings.
30130
30131 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30132 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30133 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30134 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30135 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30136 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30137
30138 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30139 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30140 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30141 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30142 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30143
30144 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30145 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30146 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30147 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30148 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30149
30150
30151
30152
30153 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30154 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30155 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30156 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30157 .code
30158 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30159 .endd
30160 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30161 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30162 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30163
30164
30165 .vlist
30166 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30167 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30168 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30169 For example:
30170 .code
30171 verify = sender/callout=5s
30172 .endd
30173 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30174 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30175 the &%connect%& parameter.
30176
30177
30178 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30179 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30180 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30181 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30182 .code
30183 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30184 .endd
30185 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30186
30187 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30188 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30189 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30190 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30191 updated in this circumstance.
30192
30193 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30194 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30195 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30196 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30197 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30198 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30199
30200
30201 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30202 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30203 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30204 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30205 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30206 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30207 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30208 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30209 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30210 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30211 .code
30212 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30213 .endd
30214 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30215
30216
30217 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30218 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30219 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30220 For example:
30221 .code
30222 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30223 .endd
30224 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30225 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30226 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30227 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30228 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30229
30230
30231 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30232 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30233 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30234 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30235
30236 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30237 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30238 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30239 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30240 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30241 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30242 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30243 made, until the cache record expires.
30244
30245 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30246 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30247 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30248 For example:
30249 .code
30250 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30251 .endd
30252 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30253 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30254 .code
30255 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30256 .endd
30257 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30258 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30259 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30260 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30261
30262
30263 .vitem &*random*&
30264 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30265 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30266 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30267 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30268 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30269 .code
30270 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30271 .endd
30272 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30273 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30274 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30275 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30276 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30277
30278 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30279 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30280 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30281 .code
30282 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30283 .endd
30284 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30285 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30286 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30287 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30288 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30289
30290 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30291 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30292 .code
30293 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30294 .endd
30295 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30296 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30297 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30298 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30299 usefulness of callout caching.
30300 .endlist
30301
30302 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30303 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30304 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30305 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30306 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30307 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30308 these circumstances.
30309
30310 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30311 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30312 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30313 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30314 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30315 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30316 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30317
30318 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30319 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30320 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30321 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30322
30323
30324
30325
30326 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30327 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30328 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30329 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30330 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30331 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30332 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30333 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30334 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30335 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30336
30337 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30338 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30339 is not available.
30340
30341 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30342 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30343 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30344
30345 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30346 commands up to and including
30347 .code
30348 MAIL FROM:<>
30349 .endd
30350 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30351 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30352 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30353 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30354 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30355 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30356 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30357
30358 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30359 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30360 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30361 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30362 will eventually be noticed.
30363
30364 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30365 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30366 behaviour will be the same.
30367
30368
30369
30370 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30371 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30372 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30373 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30374 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30375 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30376 you might see:
30377 .code
30378 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30379 250 OK
30380 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30381 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30382 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30383 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30384 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30385 550 Sender verification failed
30386 .endd
30387 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30388 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30389 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30390 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30391 example:
30392 .code
30393 verify = sender/no_details
30394 .endd
30395
30396 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30397 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30398 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30399 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30400 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30401 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30402 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30403
30404 .ilist
30405 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30406 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30407 verification also fails.
30408 .next
30409 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30410 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30411 .endlist
30412
30413 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30414 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30415 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30416 .code
30417 A.Wol: aw123
30418 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30419 .endd
30420 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30421 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30422 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30423 verification to succeed.
30424
30425 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30426 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30427 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30428 option. For example:
30429 .code
30430 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30431 .endd
30432 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30433 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30434
30435 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30436 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30437 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30438 address and a report is output for each of them.
30439
30440
30441
30442 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30443 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30444 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30445 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30446 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30447 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30448 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30449 .code
30450 verify = csa
30451 .endd
30452 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30453 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30454 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30455 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30456 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30457 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30458
30459 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30460 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30461 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30462 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30463
30464 .ilist
30465 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30466 .next
30467 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30468 .next
30469 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30470 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30471 .next
30472 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30473 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30474 .endlist
30475
30476 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30477 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30478 .code
30479 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30480 .endd
30481 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30482 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30483 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30484 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30485 meaningful to say:
30486 .code
30487 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30488 .endd
30489 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30490 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30491 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30492
30493 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30494 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30495 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30496 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30497 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30498 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30499 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30500 of legitimate HELO domains.
30501
30502 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30503 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30504 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30505 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30506 lookup such as:
30507 .code
30508 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30509 .endd
30510 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30511 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30512 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30513
30514
30515
30516
30517 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30518 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30519 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30520 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30521 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30522 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30523 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30524 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30525
30526 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30527 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30528 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30529 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30530 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30531 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30532 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30533
30534 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30535 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30536 like this:
30537 .code
30538 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30539 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30540 }{$value}}
30541 .endd
30542 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30543 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30544 use this:
30545 .code
30546 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30547 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30548 senders = :
30549 recipients = +batv_senders
30550
30551 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30552 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30553 senders = :
30554 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30555 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30556 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30557 .endd
30558 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30559 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30560 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30561 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30562 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30563
30564 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30565 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30566 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30567 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30568 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30569 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30570 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30571
30572 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30573 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30574 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30575 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30576 .code
30577 batv_redirect:
30578 driver = redirect
30579 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30580 .endd
30581 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30582 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30583 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30584 local addresses.
30585
30586 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30587 can be used:
30588 .code
30589 external_smtp_batv:
30590 driver = smtp
30591 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30592 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30593 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30594 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30595 {$value}fail}}}
30596 .endd
30597 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30598
30599
30600
30601 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30602 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30603 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30604 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30605 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30606 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30607 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30608 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30609 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30610 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30611
30612 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30613 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30614 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30615 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30616 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30617 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30618 . ///
30619 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30620 . ///
30621 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30622 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30623 system to arbitrary domains.
30624
30625
30626 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30627 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30628 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30629 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30630
30631 .ilist
30632 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30633 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30634 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30635 .next
30636 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30637 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30638 .next
30639 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30640 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30641 .endlist
30642
30643
30644 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30645 .code
30646 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30647 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30648 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30649 .endd
30650 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30651 command:
30652 .code
30653 acl_check_rcpt:
30654 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30655 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30656 .endd
30657 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30658 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30659 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30660 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30661 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30662 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30663 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30664
30665
30666
30667 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30668 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30669 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30670 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30671 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30672
30673 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30674 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30675 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30676 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30677 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30678 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30679 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30680 .ecindex IIDacl
30681
30682
30683
30684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30686
30687 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30688 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30689 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30690 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30691 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30692 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30693 specification.
30694
30695 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30696 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30697 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30698 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30699 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30700
30701 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30702 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30703 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30704
30705 .ilist
30706 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30707 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30708 .next
30709 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30710 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30711 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30712 .next
30713 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30714 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30715 .next
30716 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30717 conditions.
30718 .next
30719 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30720 .endlist
30721
30722 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30723 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30724 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30725
30726 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30727 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30728 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30729 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30730 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30731 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30732
30733 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30734 temporarily created in a file called:
30735 .display
30736 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30737 .endd
30738 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30739 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30740 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30741 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30742 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30743 .code
30744 control = no_mbox_unspool
30745 .endd
30746 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30747 same directory by default.
30748
30749
30750
30751 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30752 .cindex "virus scanning"
30753 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30754 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30755 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30756 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30757 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30758 in memory and thus are much faster.
30759
30760 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30761 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30762
30763 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30764 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30765 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30766 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30767 .display
30768 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30769 .endd
30770 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30771 .code
30772 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30773 .endd
30774 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30775 before use.
30776 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30777 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30778
30779 .vlist
30780 .vitem &%avast%&
30781 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30782 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30783 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30784 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30785 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30786 This scanner type takes one option,
30787 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30788 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30789 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30790 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30791 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30792 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30793 For example:
30794 .code
30795 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30796 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30797 .endd
30798 If you omit the argument, the default path
30799 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30800 is used.
30801 If you use a remote host,
30802 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30803 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30804 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30805 .code
30806 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30807 FLAGS
30808 SENSITIVITY
30809 PACK
30810 .endd
30811
30812
30813 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30814 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30815 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30816 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30817 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30818 example:
30819 .code
30820 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30821 .endd
30822
30823
30824 .vitem &%clamd%&
30825 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30826 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30827 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30828 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30829 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30830
30831 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30832 a UNIX socket specification,
30833 a TCP socket specification,
30834 or a (global) option.
30835
30836 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30837 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30838 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30839 and the second a port number,
30840 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30841 These per-server options are supported:
30842 .code
30843 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30844 .endd
30845
30846 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30847 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30848
30849 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30850
30851 Examples:
30852 .code
30853 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30854 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30855 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30856 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30857 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30858 .endd
30859 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30860 &`local`&
30861 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30862 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30863 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30864 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30865 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30866 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30867
30868 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30869 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30870 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30871 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30872 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30873 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30874 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30875 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30876 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30877 .code
30878 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30879 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30880 (Connection refused)
30881 .endd
30882
30883 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30884 contributing the code for this scanner.
30885
30886 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30887 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30888 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30889 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30890 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30891
30892 .olist
30893 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30894 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30895
30896 .next
30897 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30898 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30899 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30900 the &"trigger"& expression.
30901
30902 .next
30903 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30904 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30905 &"name"& expression.
30906 .endlist olist
30907
30908 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30909 .code
30910 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30911 .endd
30912 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30913 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30914 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30915 configuration setting:
30916 .code
30917 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30918 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30919 found in file:'(.+)'
30920 .endd
30921 .vitem &%drweb%&
30922 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30923 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30924 takes one option,
30925 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30926 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30927 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30928 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30929 For example:
30930 .code
30931 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30932 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30933 .endd
30934 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30935 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30936
30937 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30938 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30939 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30940 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30941 (or port-range).
30942 For example:
30943 .code
30944 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30945 .endd
30946 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30947
30948 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30949 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30950 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30951 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30952 .code
30953 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30954 .endd
30955 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30956 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30957
30958 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30959 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30960 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30961 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30962 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30963 For example:
30964 .code
30965 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30966 .endd
30967 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30968
30969 .vitem &%mksd%&
30970 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30971 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30972 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30973 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30974 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30975 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30976 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30977 .code
30978 av_scanner = mksd:2
30979 .endd
30980 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30981
30982 .vitem &%sock%&
30983 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30984 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30985 running on the local machine.
30986 There are four options:
30987 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30988 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30989 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30990 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30991 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30992 For example:
30993 .code
30994 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30995 .endd
30996 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30997 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30998 Both regular-expressions are required.
30999
31000 .vitem &%sophie%&
31001 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31002 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31003 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31004 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31005 client communication. For example:
31006 .code
31007 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31008 .endd
31009 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31010 the option.
31011 .endlist
31012
31013 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31014 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31015 ACL.
31016
31017 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31018 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31019 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31020 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31021 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31022 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31023 message.
31024
31025 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31026 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31027 The first element can then be one of
31028
31029 .ilist
31030 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31031 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31032 recommended usage.
31033 .next
31034 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31035 the condition fails immediately.
31036 .next
31037 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31038 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31039 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31040 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31041 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31042 .endlist
31043
31044 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31045 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31046 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31047
31048 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31049 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31050 For example:
31051 .code
31052 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31053 .endd
31054 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31055
31056 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31057 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31058 is set to record the actual address used.
31059
31060 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31061 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31062 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31063 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31064 logging data.
31065
31066 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31067 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31068 &%malware%& condition.
31069
31070 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31071 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31072
31073 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31074 .code
31075 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31076 demime = *
31077 malware = *
31078 .endd
31079 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31080 .code
31081 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31082 demime = *
31083 malware = */defer_ok
31084 .endd
31085 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31086 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31087 .code
31088 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31089 .endd
31090 in the main Exim configuration.
31091 .code
31092 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31093 set acl_m0 = sophie
31094 malware = *
31095
31096 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31097 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31098 malware = *
31099 .endd
31100
31101
31102 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31103 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31104 .cindex "spam scanning"
31105 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31106 .cindex "Rspamd"
31107 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31108 score and a report for the message.
31109 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31110
31111 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31112 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31113 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31114
31115 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31116 .code
31117 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31118 .endd
31119 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31120 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31121 nicely, however.
31122
31123 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31124 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31125 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31126 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31127 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31128 configuration as follows (example):
31129 .code
31130 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31131 .endd
31132
31133 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31134 on TCP port 11333)
31135 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31136 .code
31137 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31138 .endd
31139
31140 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31141 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31142 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31143 .code
31144 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31145 .endd
31146 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31147 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31148 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31149 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31150 .code
31151 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31152 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31153 192.168.2.12 783
31154 .endd
31155 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31156 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31157 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31158 condition defers.
31159
31160 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31161 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31162 and changeable in the usual way.
31163
31164 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31165 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31166 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31167 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31168
31169 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31170 are options.
31171 The supported options are:
31172 .code
31173 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31174 weight=<value> Selection bias
31175 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31176 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31177 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31178 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31179 .endd
31180
31181 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31182 higher values being tried first.
31183 The default priority is 1.
31184
31185 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31186 Within a priority set
31187 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31188 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31189
31190 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31191 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31192 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31193 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31194
31195 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31196 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31197
31198 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31199 The default value is two minutes.
31200
31201 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31202 a failed connect is made.
31203 The default is to not retry.
31204
31205 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31206 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31207 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31208 expansion.
31209
31210 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31211 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31212 is set to record the actual address used.
31213
31214 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31215 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31216 .code
31217 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31218 spam = joe
31219 .endd
31220 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31221 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31222 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31223 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31224 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31225 right-hand side.
31226
31227 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31228 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31229 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31230 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31231 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31232 are not set.
31233 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31234 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31235 after the first),
31236 or the use of PRDR,
31237 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31238 are needed to use this feature.
31239
31240 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31241 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31242 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31243
31244
31245 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31246 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31247 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31248 example:
31249 .code
31250 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31251 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31252 spam = nobody
31253 .endd
31254
31255 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31256 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31257 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31258 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31259
31260 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31261 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31262 variables.
31263 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31264 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31265 available for use at delivery time.
31266
31267 .vlist
31268 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31269 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31270 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31271
31272 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31273 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31274 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31275 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31276 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31277
31278 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31279 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31280 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31281 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31282 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31283 spam bar is 50 characters.
31284
31285 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31286 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31287 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31288 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31289
31290 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31291 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31292 spam score versus threshold.
31293 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31294
31295 .endlist
31296
31297 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31298 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31299 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31300
31301 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31302 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31303 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31304 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31305 spam condition, like this:
31306 .code
31307 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31308 spam = joe/defer_ok
31309 .endd
31310 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31311
31312 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31313 condition:
31314 .code
31315 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31316 warn spam = nobody:true
31317 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31318 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31319
31320 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31321 # is over threshold
31322 warn spam = nobody
31323 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31324
31325 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31326 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31327 spam = nobody:true
31328 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31329 .endd
31330
31331
31332
31333 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31334 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31335 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31336 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31337 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31338 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31339 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31340 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31341 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31342 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31343 cases.
31344
31345 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31346 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31347 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31348 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31349 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31350 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31351 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31352
31353 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31354 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31355 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31356 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31357 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31358
31359 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31360 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31361 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31362 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31363 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31364 syntax is:
31365 .display
31366 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31367 .endd
31368 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31369 the value can be:
31370
31371 .olist
31372 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31373 .next
31374 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31375 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31376 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31377 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31378 .next
31379 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31380 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31381 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31382 the full path and file name.
31383 .next
31384 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31385 filename, and the default path is then used.
31386 .endlist
31387 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31388 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31389 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31390 .code
31391 decode = $mime_filename
31392 .endd
31393 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31394 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31395 automatically unlinked.
31396
31397 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31398 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31399 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31400 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31401 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31402
31403 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31404 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31405 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31406
31407 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31408 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31409 available in the MIME ACL:
31410
31411 .vlist
31412 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31413 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31414 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31415 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31416 contains the empty string.
31417
31418 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31419 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31420 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31421 .code
31422 us-ascii
31423 gb2312 (Chinese)
31424 iso-8859-1
31425 .endd
31426 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31427 case-insensitively.
31428
31429 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31430 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31431 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31432 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31433 only used for display purposes.
31434
31435 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31436 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31437 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31438
31439 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31440 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31441 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31442
31443 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31444 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31445 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31446 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31447 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31448
31449 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31450 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31451 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31452 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31453
31454 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31455 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31456 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31457 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31458 .code
31459 text/plain
31460 text/html
31461 application/octet-stream
31462 image/jpeg
31463 audio/midi
31464 .endd
31465 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31466 empty string.
31467
31468 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31469 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31470 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31471 containing the decoded data.
31472 .endlist
31473
31474 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31475 .vlist
31476 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31477 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31478 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31479 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31480 RFC2047
31481 or RFC2231
31482 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31483 If no filename was
31484 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31485
31486 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31487 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31488 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31489 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31490
31491 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31492 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31493 follows:
31494
31495 .olist
31496 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31497
31498 .next
31499 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31500 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31501
31502 .next
31503 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31504 and the rest are attachments.
31505
31506 .next
31507 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31508 .endlist olist
31509
31510 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31511 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31512 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31513 .code
31514 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31515 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31516 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31517 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31518 .endd
31519 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31520 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31521 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31522 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31523 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31524
31525 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31526 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31527 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31528 decoding is fully recursive.
31529
31530 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31531 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31532 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31533 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31534 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31535 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31536 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31537 .endlist
31538
31539
31540
31541 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31542 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31543 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31544 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31545 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31546
31547 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31548 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31549 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31550 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31551 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31552
31553 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31554 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31555 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31556 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31557 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31558 32K characters are checked.
31559
31560 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31561 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31562 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31563 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31564 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31565 .code
31566 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31567 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31568 .endd
31569 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31570 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31571 matching regular expression.
31572 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31573 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31574
31575 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31576 CPU-intensive.
31577
31578
31579
31580
31581 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31582 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31583 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31584 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31585 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31586 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31587 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31588 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31589 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31590 use the &%demime%& condition.
31591
31592 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31593 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31594 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31595 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31596 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31597 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31598
31599 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31600 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31601 example:
31602 .code
31603 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31604 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31605 .endd
31606 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31607 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31608 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31609 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31610
31611 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31612 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31613 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31614
31615 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31616
31617 .vlist
31618 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31619 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31620 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31621 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31622 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31623 zero, no error occurred.
31624
31625 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31626 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31627 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31628 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31629 .endlist
31630
31631 .vlist
31632 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31633 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31634 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31635 extension it found.
31636 .endlist
31637
31638 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31639 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31640
31641 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31642 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31643 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31644 facility:
31645 .code
31646 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31647 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31648 demime = *
31649 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31650
31651 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31652 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31653 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31654 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31655
31656 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31657 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31658 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31659 demime = exe:doc
31660 control = freeze
31661 .endd
31662 .ecindex IIDcosca
31663
31664
31665
31666
31667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31669
31670 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31671 "Local scan function"
31672 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31673 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31674 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31675 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31676 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31677
31678 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31679 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31680 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31681 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31682 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31683
31684 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31685 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31686 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31687 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31688
31689 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31690 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31691 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31692 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31693
31694 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31695 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31696 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31697 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31698 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31699 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31700 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31701 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31702 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31703
31704
31705
31706 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31707 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31708 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31709 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31710 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31711 directory, so you might set
31712 .code
31713 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31714 .endd
31715 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31716 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31717 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31718 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31719 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31720 _src/local_scan.c_.
31721
31722 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31723 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31724 .code
31725 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31726 .endd
31727 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31728
31729
31730
31731
31732 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31733 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31734 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31735 .code
31736 #include "local_scan.h"
31737 .endd
31738 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31739 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31740 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31741 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31742 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31743 strings and pointers to character strings:
31744 .code
31745 #define CS (char *)
31746 #define CCS (const char *)
31747 #define CSS (char **)
31748 #define US (unsigned char *)
31749 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31750 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31751 .endd
31752 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31753 .code
31754 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31755 .endd
31756 The arguments are as follows:
31757
31758 .ilist
31759 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31760 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31761 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31762
31763 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31764 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31765 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31766 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31767 case this changes in some future version.
31768 .next
31769 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31770 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31771 .endlist
31772
31773 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31774
31775 .vlist
31776 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31777 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31778 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31779 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31780 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31781 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31782
31783 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31784 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31785 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31786
31787 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31788 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31789 queued without immediate delivery.
31790
31791 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31792 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31793 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31794 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31795 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31796 used.
31797
31798 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31799 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31800 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31801 problem"& is used.
31802
31803 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31804 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31805 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31806 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31807 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31808 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31809 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31810
31811 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31812 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31813 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31814 .endlist
31815
31816 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31817 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31818 &%-oe%& command line options.
31819
31820
31821
31822 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31823 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31824 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31825 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31826 want to do this, you must have the line
31827 .code
31828 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31829 .endd
31830 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31831 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31832 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31833 to define them.
31834
31835 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31836 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31837 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31838 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31839 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31840 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31841 .code
31842 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31843 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31844
31845 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31846 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31847 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31848 };
31849
31850 int local_scan_options_count =
31851 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31852 .endd
31853 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31854 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31855 .code
31856 begin local_scan
31857 my_integer = 99
31858 my_string = some string of text...
31859 .endd
31860 The available types of option data are as follows:
31861
31862 .vlist
31863 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31864 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31865 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31866 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31867 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31868 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31869 values.)
31870
31871 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31872 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31873 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31874 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31875
31876 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31877 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31878 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31879 Exim.
31880
31881 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31882 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31883 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31884 printed with the suffix K or M.
31885
31886 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31887 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31888 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31889 always output in octal.
31890
31891 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31892 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31893 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31894
31895 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31896 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31897 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31898 .endlist
31899
31900 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31901 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31902
31903
31904
31905 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31906 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31907 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31908 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31909 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31910 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31911 C variables are as follows:
31912
31913 .vlist
31914 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31915 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31916
31917 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31918 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31919
31920 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31921 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31922 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31923 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31924
31925 .ilist
31926 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31927 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31928 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31929
31930 .next
31931 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31932 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31933 of debugging bits.
31934 .endlist ilist
31935
31936 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31937 selected, you should use code like this:
31938 .code
31939 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31940 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31941 .endd
31942 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31943 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31944 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31945
31946 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31947 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31948 discussed below.
31949
31950 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31951 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31952
31953 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31954 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31955
31956 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31957 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31958 &%-bh%& command line option.
31959
31960 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31961 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31962 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31963
31964 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31965 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31966 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31967 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31968
31969 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31970 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31971 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31972
31973 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31974 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31975
31976 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31977 The number of accepted recipients.
31978
31979 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31980 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31981 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31982 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31983 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31984 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31985 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31986 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31987 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31988 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31989 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31990 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31991
31992 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31993 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31994
31995 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31996 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31997 locally-submitted messages.
31998
31999 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32000 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32001 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32002
32003 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32004 The name of the sending host, if known.
32005
32006 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32007 The port on the sending host.
32008
32009 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32010 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32011
32012 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32013 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32014
32015 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32016 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32017 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32018 .endlist
32019
32020
32021 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32022 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32023 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32024 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32025 their type to *.
32026
32027
32028 .vlist
32029 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32030 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32031
32032 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32033 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32034 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32035 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32036 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32037 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32038 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32039
32040 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32041 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32042 internal newlines.
32043
32044 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32045 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32046 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32047 .endlist
32048
32049
32050
32051 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32052 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32053
32054 .vlist
32055 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32056 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32057
32058 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32059 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32060 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32061 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32062
32063 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32064 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32065 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32066 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32067 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32068 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32069 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32070 is NULL for all recipients.
32071 .endlist
32072
32073
32074
32075 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32076 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32077 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32078 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32079 release:
32080
32081 .vlist
32082 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32083 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32084
32085 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32086 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32087 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32088 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32089
32090 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32091 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32092 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32093 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32094 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32095
32096 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32097
32098 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32099 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32100 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32101 return value is as follows:
32102
32103 .ilist
32104 >= 0
32105
32106 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32107 ending status.
32108
32109 .next
32110 < 0 and > &--256
32111
32112 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32113 signal number.
32114
32115 .next
32116 &--256
32117
32118 The process timed out.
32119 .next
32120 &--257
32121
32122 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32123 .endlist
32124
32125 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32126 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32127 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32128 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32129 forks a subprocess that is running
32130 .code
32131 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32132 .endd
32133 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32134 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32135 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32136 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32137
32138 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32139 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32140 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32141 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32142
32143
32144 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32145 *sender_authentication)*&
32146 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32147 that it runs is:
32148 .display
32149 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32150 .endd
32151 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32152
32153
32154 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32155 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32156 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32157 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32158 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32159 .code
32160 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32161 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32162 .endd
32163
32164 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32165 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32166 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32167 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32168 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32169 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32170 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32171 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32172
32173 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32174 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32175 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32176 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32177 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32178 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32179
32180 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32181 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32182 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32183 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32184
32185 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32186 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32187 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32188 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32189 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32190 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32191 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32192 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32193 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32194 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32195 .code
32196 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32197 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32198 .endd
32199 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32200 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32201
32202
32203 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32204 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32205 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32206 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32207 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32208
32209
32210 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32211 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32212 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32213 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32214 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32215 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32216 .code
32217 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32218 .endd
32219 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32220 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32221 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32222 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32223 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32224 zero-terminated.
32225
32226 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32227 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32228 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32229 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32230 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32231 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32232 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32233 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32234
32235 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32236 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32237 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32238 .display
32239 &`OK `& match succeeded
32240 &`FAIL `& match failed
32241 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32242 .endd
32243 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32244 inability to contact a database.
32245
32246 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32247 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32248 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32249 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32250 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32251
32252 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32253 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32254 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32255 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32256 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32257
32258 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32259 uschar&~*list)*&"
32260 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32261 expected to be
32262 .code
32263 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32264 .endd
32265 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32266 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32267 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32268 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32269 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32270 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32271 failed.
32272
32273 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32274 *format,&~...)*&"
32275 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32276 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32277 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32278 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32279 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32280 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32281
32282
32283 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32284 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32285 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32286 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32287
32288 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32289 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32290 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32291 value afterwards. For example:
32292 .code
32293 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32294 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32295 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32296 .endd
32297
32298 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32299 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32300 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32301 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32302 address.
32303 .endlist
32304
32305
32306 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32307 .vlist
32308 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32309 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32310 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32311 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32312 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32313 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32314 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32315 binary string is returned with an error message.
32316
32317 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32318 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32319 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32320
32321 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32322 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32323 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32324 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32325 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32326
32327 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32328 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32329 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32330
32331 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32332 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32333 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32334 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32335 with translation.
32336
32337
32338 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32339 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32340 below.
32341
32342 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32343 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32344 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32345 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32346 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32347 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32348 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32349 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32350 is involved.
32351
32352 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32353 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32354
32355 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32356 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32357 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32358 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32359 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32360 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32361 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32362 .code
32363 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32364 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32365 .endd
32366 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32367 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32368 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32369 multiple output lines.
32370
32371 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32372 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32373 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32374 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32375 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32376 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32377 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32378 is an error.
32379
32380 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32381 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32382 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32383 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32384
32385 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32386 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32387 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32388
32389 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32390 See below.
32391
32392 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32393 See below.
32394
32395 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32396 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32397 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32398 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32399 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32400 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32401 more discussion.
32402 .endlist
32403
32404
32405
32406 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32407 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32408 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32409 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32410 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32411 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32412 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32413 terminates.
32414
32415 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32416 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32417 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32418 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32419
32420 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32421 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32422 .code
32423 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32424 .endd
32425 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32426 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32427 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32428 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32429
32430 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32431 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32432 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32433 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32434 &%store_pool%&.
32435 .ecindex IIDlosca
32436
32437
32438
32439
32440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32442
32443 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32444 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32445 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32446 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32447 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32448 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32449 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32450 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32451
32452 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32453 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32454 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32455 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32456 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32457
32458 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32459 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32460 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32461 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32462 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32463 prevent it happening on retries.
32464
32465 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32466 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32467 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32468 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32469 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32470 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32471 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32472 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32473
32474
32475 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32476 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32477 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32478 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32479 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32480 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32481 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32482 .code
32483 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32484 system_filter_user = exim
32485 .endd
32486 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32487 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32488 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32489 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32490 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32491 by the &%reply%& command.
32492
32493
32494 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32495 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32496 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32497 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32498
32499 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32500 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32501
32502
32503
32504 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32505 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32506 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32507 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32508 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32509 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32510 they cause errors.
32511
32512 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32513 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32514 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32515 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32516 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32517 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32518 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32519
32520 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32521 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32522 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32523 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32524 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32525
32526 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32527 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32528 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32529 to which users' filter files can refer.
32530
32531
32532
32533 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32534 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32535 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32536 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32537 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32538
32539
32540
32541 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32542 .cindex "freezing messages"
32543 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32544 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32545 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32546 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32547 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32548 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32549 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32550 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32551 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32552 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32553 .code
32554 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32555 .endd
32556 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32557
32558 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32559 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32560 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32561 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32562 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32563 run.
32564
32565 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32566 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32567 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32568 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32569
32570 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32571 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32572 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32573 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32574 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32575 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32576 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32577 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32578 message. For example:
32579 .code
32580 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32581 because it contains attachments that we are \
32582 not prepared to receive."
32583 .endd
32584
32585 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32586 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32587 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32588 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32589 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32590 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32591 use, for example
32592 .code
32593 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32594 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32595 .endd
32596 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32597 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32598 generated by the filter.
32599
32600 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32601 &%defer%&,
32602 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32603 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32604 as
32605 .code
32606 mail ...
32607 freeze
32608 .endd
32609 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32610 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32611 take place.
32612
32613
32614
32615 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32616 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32617 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32618 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32619 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32620 .code
32621 headers add <string>
32622 headers remove <string>
32623 .endd
32624 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32625 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32626 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32627 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32628 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32629
32630 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32631 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32632 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32633 example:
32634 .code
32635 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32636 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32637 X-header-2: ...."
32638 .endd
32639 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32640 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32641 space after input continuations is ignored.
32642
32643 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32644 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32645 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32646 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32647 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32648
32649 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32650 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32651 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32652 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32653 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32654 used for all recipients of the message.
32655
32656 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32657 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32658 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32659 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32660 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32661 until the message is actually being written (see section
32662 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32663
32664 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32665 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32666 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32667 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32668 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32669 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32670 modified more than once.
32671
32672 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32673 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32674 For example:
32675 .code
32676 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32677 headers remove "Subject"
32678 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32679 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32680 .endd
32681
32682
32683
32684 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32685 .cindex "envelope sender"
32686 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32687 .code
32688 errors_to <some address>
32689 .endd
32690 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32691 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32692 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32693 might use
32694 .code
32695 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32696 .endd
32697 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32698 address if its delivery failed.
32699
32700
32701
32702 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32703 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32704 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32705 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32706 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32707 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32708 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32709 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32710 which implements such a filter:
32711 .code
32712 central_filter:
32713 check_local_user
32714 driver = redirect
32715 domains = +local_domains
32716 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32717 no_verify
32718 allow_filter
32719 allow_freeze
32720 .endd
32721 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32722 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32723 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32724 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32725
32726 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32727 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32728 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32729 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32730 normal way.
32731 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32732 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32733 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32734
32735
32736
32737
32738
32739
32740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32742
32743 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32744 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32745 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32746 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32747 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32748 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32749 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32750 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32751
32752 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32753 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32754 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32755 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32756 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32757
32758 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32759 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32760 loopback interface specially in any way.
32761
32762 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32763 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32764
32765
32766
32767
32768 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32769 .cindex "message" "submission"
32770 .cindex "submission mode"
32771 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32772 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32773 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32774 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32775 .code
32776 control = submission
32777 .endd
32778 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32779 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32780 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32781 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32782 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32783 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32784 .code
32785 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32786 control = submission
32787 .endd
32788 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32789 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32790 is used to separate options. For example:
32791 .code
32792 control = submission/sender_retain
32793 .endd
32794 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32795 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32796 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32797 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32798 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32799 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32800 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32801
32802 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32803 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32804 example:
32805 .code
32806 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32807 .endd
32808 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32809 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32810 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32811 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32812 .code
32813 accept authenticated = *
32814 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32815 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32816 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32817 .endd
32818 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32819 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32820 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32821 .code
32822 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32823 .endd
32824 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32825 line would be:
32826 .code
32827 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32828 .endd
32829 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32830 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32831 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32832 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32833
32834 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32835 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32836 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32837 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32838 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32839 spoof another's address.
32840
32841 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32842 .cindex "line endings"
32843 .cindex "carriage return"
32844 .cindex "linefeed"
32845 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32846 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32847 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32848 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32849 use CRLF or just CR.
32850
32851 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32852 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32853 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32854 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32855 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32856 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32857 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32858 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32859 follows:
32860
32861 .ilist
32862 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32863 .next
32864 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32865 is ignored.
32866 .next
32867 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32868 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32869 terminator.
32870 .next
32871 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32872 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32873 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32874 people trying to play silly games.
32875 .next
32876 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32877 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32878 line.
32879 .endlist
32880
32881
32882
32883
32884
32885 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32886 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32887 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32888 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32889 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32890 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32891 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32892 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32893
32894 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32895 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32896 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32897 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32898 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32899
32900 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32901 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32902 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32903 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32904 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32905 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32906 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32907 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32908
32909
32910
32911
32912 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32913 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32914 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32915 .cindex "sender" "address"
32916 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32917 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32918 .cindex "envelope sender"
32919 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32920 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32921 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32922 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32923 .code
32924 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32925 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32926 .endd
32927 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32928 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32929 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32930 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32931 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32932 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32933 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32934 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32935 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32936
32937 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32938 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32939 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32940 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32941 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32942 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32943 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32944
32945 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32946 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32947 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32948
32949 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32950 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32951 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32952 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32953
32954
32955
32956 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32957 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32958 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32959 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32960 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32961 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32962 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32963
32964 .blockquote
32965 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32966 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32967 .endblockquote
32968
32969 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32970 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32971 follows:
32972
32973 .ilist
32974 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32975 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32976 .next
32977 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32978 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32979 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32980 .next
32981 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32982 also removed.
32983 .next
32984 For a locally-submitted message,
32985 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32986 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32987 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32988 included in log lines in this case.
32989 .next
32990 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32991 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32992 .endlist
32993
32994
32995
32996
32997 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32998 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32999 includes the header line:
33000 .code
33001 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33002 .endd
33003
33004 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33005 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33006 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33007 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33008 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33009 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33010
33011
33012 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33013 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33014 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33015 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33016 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33017
33018 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33019 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33020 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33021 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33022 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33023 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33024 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33025 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33026 messages.
33027
33028
33029 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33030 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33031 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33032 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33033 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33034 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33035 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33036 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33037 messages.
33038
33039
33040 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33041 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33042 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33043 .cindex "message" "submission"
33044 .cindex "submission mode"
33045 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33046 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33047
33048 .ilist
33049 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33050 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33051 .next
33052 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33053 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33054 .olist
33055 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33056 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33057 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33058 .next
33059 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33060 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33061 .next
33062 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33063 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33064 .endlist
33065 .endlist
33066
33067 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33068
33069 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33070 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33071 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33072 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33073 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33074 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33075 &%qualify_domain%&.
33076
33077 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33078 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33079 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33080 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33081
33082
33083 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33084 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33085 .cindex "message" "submission"
33086 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33087 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33088 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33089 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33090 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33091 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33092 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33093 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33094 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33095 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33096
33097
33098 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33099 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33100 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33101 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33102 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33103
33104 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33105 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33106 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33107 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33108
33109 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33110 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33111 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33112
33113
33114 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33115 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33116 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33117 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33118 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33119 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33120 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33121 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33122 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33123 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33124 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33125
33126
33127
33128 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33129 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33130 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33131 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33132 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33133 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33134 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33135 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33136
33137
33138
33139 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33140 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33141 .cindex "message" "submission"
33142 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33143 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33144 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33145 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33146 control setting.
33147
33148 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33149 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33150 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33151 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33152 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33153 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33154 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33155 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33156 line is added to the message.
33157
33158 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33159 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33160 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33161 options true at the same time.
33162
33163 .cindex "submission mode"
33164 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33165 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33166 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33167 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33168
33169 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33170 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33171 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33172 created as follows:
33173
33174 .ilist
33175 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33176 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33177 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33178 .next
33179 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33180 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33181 .next
33182 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33183 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33184 .endlist
33185
33186 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33187 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33188 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33189 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33190
33191 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33192 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33193 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33194 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33195
33196
33197
33198 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33199 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33200 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33201 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33202 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33203 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33204 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33205 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33206 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33207
33208 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33209 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33210 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33211 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33212 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33213 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33214
33215 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33216 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33217 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33218
33219 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33220 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33221 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33222 .code
33223 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33224 X-added-second: another added header line
33225 .endd
33226 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33227
33228 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33229 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33230 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33231
33232 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33233 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33234 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33235 not part of the names. For example:
33236 .code
33237 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33238 .endd
33239
33240 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33241 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33242 Each item is separately expanded.
33243 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33244 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33245 will act as list separators.
33246
33247 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33248 items are expanded at routing time,
33249 and then associated with all addresses that are
33250 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33251 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33252 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33253
33254 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33255 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33256 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33257 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33258
33259 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33260 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33261 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33262 requirements.
33263
33264 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33265 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33266 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33267 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33268 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33269 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33270 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33271
33272 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33273 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33274 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33275 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33276
33277 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33278 the following consequences:
33279
33280 .ilist
33281 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33282 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33283 to it, at all times.
33284 .next
33285 Header lines that are added by a router's
33286 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33287 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33288 .next
33289 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33290 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33291 .next
33292 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33293 a later router or by a transport.
33294 .next
33295 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33296 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33297 .code
33298 headers_remove = subject
33299 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33300 .endd
33301 .endlist
33302
33303 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33304 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33305
33306
33307
33308
33309
33310 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33311 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33312 .cindex "constructed address"
33313 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33314 the form
33315 .display
33316 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33317 .endd
33318 For example:
33319 .code
33320 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33321 .endd
33322 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33323 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33324 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33325 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33326 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33327 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33328 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33329 there is no password file entry.
33330
33331 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33332 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33333 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33334 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33335 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33336 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33337 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33338 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33339 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33340
33341
33342
33343 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33344 .cindex "case of local parts"
33345 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33346 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33347 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33348 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33349 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33350 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33351 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33352 router option.
33353
33354 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33355 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33356 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33357 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33358 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33359 .code
33360 correct_case:
33361 driver = redirect
33362 domains = +local_domains
33363 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33364 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33365 @$domain
33366 .endd
33367 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33368 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33369 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33370 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33371 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33372
33373
33374
33375 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33376 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33377 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33378 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33379 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33380 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33381 empty components for compatibility.
33382
33383
33384
33385 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33386 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33387 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33388 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33389 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33390 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33391
33392 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33393 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33394 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33395 example, a header such as
33396 .code
33397 To: hare@teaparty
33398 .endd
33399 might get rewritten as
33400 .code
33401 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33402 .endd
33403 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33404 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33405 been routed.
33406
33407 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33408 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33409 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33410 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33411 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33412 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33413 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33414
33415
33416
33417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33419
33420 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33421 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33422 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33423 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33424 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33425 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33426 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33427
33428 .ilist
33429 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33430 .next
33431 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33432 .next
33433 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33434 .endlist
33435
33436 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33437
33438 .ilist
33439 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33440 .next
33441 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33442 &"lmtp"&);
33443 .next
33444 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33445 transport);
33446 .next
33447 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33448 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33449 .endlist
33450
33451 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33452 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33453 used to contain the envelope information.
33454
33455
33456
33457 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33458 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33459 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33460 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33461 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33462 .cindex "EHLO"
33463 .cindex "HELO"
33464 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33465 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33466 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33467 processing is the same in both cases.
33468
33469 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33470 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33471 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33472 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33473 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33474 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33475 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33476 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33477 suppressed.
33478
33479 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33480 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33481 required for the transaction.
33482
33483 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33484 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33485 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33486 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33487 is called for verification.
33488
33489 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33490 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33491 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33492
33493 .cindex "carriage return"
33494 .cindex "linefeed"
33495 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33496 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33497 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33498 line terminator.
33499
33500 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33501 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33502 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33503 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33504 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33505 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33506 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33507 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33508 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33509
33510 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33511 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33512 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33513 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33514
33515 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33516 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33517 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33518 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33519
33520 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33521 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33522 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33523 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33524 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33525 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33526 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33527 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33528 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33529 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33530
33531 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33532 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33533
33534 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33535 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33536 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33537 square bracket of the IP address.
33538
33539
33540
33541
33542 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33543 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33544 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33545 .cindex "host" "error"
33546 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33547 message errors, and recipient errors.
33548
33549 .vlist
33550 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33551 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33552 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33553
33554 .ilist
33555 Connection refused or timed out,
33556 .next
33557 Any error response code on connection,
33558 .next
33559 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33560 .next
33561 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33562 .next
33563 I/O errors at any time,
33564 .next
33565 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33566 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33567 .endlist ilist
33568
33569 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33570 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33571 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33572 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33573 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33574 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33575 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33576 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33577
33578 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33579 .cindex "message" "error"
33580 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33581 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33582 message errors are:
33583
33584 .ilist
33585 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33586 the data,
33587 .next
33588 Timeout after MAIL,
33589 .next
33590 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33591 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33592 connection at any other time.
33593 .endlist ilist
33594
33595 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33596 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33597 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33598 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33599 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33600 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33601 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33602 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33603 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33604 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33605
33606 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33607 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33608 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33609 response to MAIL.
33610
33611 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33612 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33613 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33614 recipient errors are:
33615
33616 .ilist
33617 Any error response to RCPT,
33618 .next
33619 Timeout after RCPT.
33620 .endlist
33621
33622 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33623 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33624 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33625 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33626 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33627 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33628 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33629 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33630 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33631 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33632 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33633 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33634 the retry clock is reset.
33635
33636 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33637 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33638 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33639 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33640 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33641 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33642 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33643 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33644 recipient's retry time.
33645 .endlist
33646
33647 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33648 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33649 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33650 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33651 until the next delivery attempt.
33652
33653 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33654 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33655 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33656 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33657 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33658 is created.
33659
33660 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33661 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33662 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33663 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33664 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33665 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33666 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33667
33668 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33669 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33670 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33671 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33672 then to be treated as a host error.
33673
33674 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33675 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33676 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33677 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33678 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33679
33680
33681
33682
33683 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33684 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33685 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33686 .cindex "inetd"
33687 .cindex "daemon"
33688 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33689 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33690 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33691 .code
33692 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33693 .endd
33694 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33695 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33696 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33697 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33698 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33699 stream and exits with an error code.
33700
33701 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33702 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33703 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33704 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33705
33706 .cindex "carriage return"
33707 .cindex "linefeed"
33708 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33709 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33710 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33711 line terminator.
33712 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33713 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33714 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33715
33716 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33717 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33718 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33719 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33720 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33721 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33722 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33723 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33724
33725 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33726 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33727 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33728 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33729 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33730 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33731 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33732 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33733 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33734
33735 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33736 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33737 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33738
33739 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33740 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33741 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33742 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33743 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33744
33745 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33746 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33747 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33748 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33749 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33750 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33751 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33752
33753 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33754 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33755 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33756 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33757 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33758
33759 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33760 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33761 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33762 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33763 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33764 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33765 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33766 a delivery process.
33767
33768 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33769 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33770 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33771 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33772 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33773
33774 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33775 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33776 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33777 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33778
33779 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33780 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33781 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33782
33783
33784
33785 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33786 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33787 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33788 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33789 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33790 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33791 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33792 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33793
33794
33795 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33796 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33797 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33798 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33799 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33800 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33801 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33802 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33803 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33804 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33805 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33806
33807
33808
33809 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33810 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33811 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33812 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33813 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33814 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33815 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33816 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33817
33818 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33819 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33820 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33821 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33822 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33823 counted.
33824
33825 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33826 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33827 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33828
33829 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33830 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33831 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33832 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33833 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33834
33835
33836
33837
33838 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33839 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33840 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33841 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33842 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33843
33844 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33845 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33846 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33847
33848 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33849 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33850 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33851 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33852 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33853 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33854 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33855 RCPT failures.
33856
33857
33858
33859 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33860 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33861 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33862 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33863 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33864 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33865 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33866
33867 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33868 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33869 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33870 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33871 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33872 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33873 argument. For example,
33874 .code
33875 ETRN #brigadoon
33876 .endd
33877 runs the command
33878 .code
33879 exim -R brigadoon
33880 .endd
33881 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33882 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33883 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33884 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33885 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33886
33887 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33888 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33889 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33890 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33891 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33892 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33893 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33894 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33895
33896 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33897 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33898 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33899 whatever the form of its argument. For
33900 example:
33901 .code
33902 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33903 $sender_host_address
33904 .endd
33905 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33906 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33907 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33908 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33909 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33910 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33911 for it to change them before running the command.
33912
33913
33914
33915 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33916 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33917 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33918 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33919 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33920 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33921 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33922 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33923 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33924 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33925 runs for RCPT commands:
33926 .code
33927 accept hosts = :
33928 .endd
33929 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33930
33931
33932
33933 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33934 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33935 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33936 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33937 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33938 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33939 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33940 envelope along with the message.
33941
33942 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33943 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33944 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33945 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33946 can be used to specify it.
33947
33948 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33949 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33950 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33951 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33952 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33953
33954 .vindex "&$host$&"
33955 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33956 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33957 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33958 router:
33959 .code
33960 begin routers
33961 route_append:
33962 driver = manualroute
33963 transport = smtp_appendfile
33964 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33965
33966 begin transports
33967 smtp_appendfile:
33968 driver = appendfile
33969 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33970 batch_max = 1000
33971 use_bsmtp
33972 user = exim
33973 .endd
33974 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33975 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33976 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33977
33978
33979
33980 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33981 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33982 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33983 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33984 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33985 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33986 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33987 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33988 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33989 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33990
33991 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33992 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33993
33994 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33995 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33996 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33997 make some use of automatically, for example:
33998 .code
33999 554 Unexpected end of file
34000 Transaction started in line 10
34001 Error detected in line 14
34002 .endd
34003 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34004 file, for example:
34005 .code
34006 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34007 The error message was:
34008
34009 501 '>' missing at end of address
34010
34011 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34012 The error was detected in line 12.
34013 The SMTP command at fault was:
34014
34015 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34016
34017 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34018 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34019 .endd
34020 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34021 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34022 accepted.
34023 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34024 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34025
34026
34027
34028 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34030
34031 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34032 "Customizing messages"
34033 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34034 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34035 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34036 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34037 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34038
34039 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34040 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34041 option. Exim also adds the line
34042 .code
34043 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34044 .endd
34045 to all warning and bounce messages,
34046
34047
34048 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34049 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34050 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34051 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34052 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34053 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34054 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34055
34056 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34057 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34058 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34059 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34060 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34061 item.
34062
34063 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34064 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34065 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34066 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34067 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34068 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34069 option, rounded to a whole number.
34070
34071 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34072
34073 .ilist
34074 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34075 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34076 .next
34077 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34078 failing addresses with their error messages.
34079 .next
34080 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34081 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34082 .next
34083 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34084 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34085 .endlist
34086
34087 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34088 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34089 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34090 .code
34091 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34092 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34093 {: returning message to sender}}
34094 ****
34095 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34096
34097 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34098 {that you sent }{sent by
34099
34100 <$sender_address>
34101
34102 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34103 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34104 ****
34105 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34106 ****
34107 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34108 ------
34109 ****
34110 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34111 only the first
34112 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34113 ****
34114 .endd
34115 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34116 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34117 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34118 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34119 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34120 text sections:
34121
34122 .ilist
34123 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34124 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34125 .next
34126 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34127 the delayed addresses.
34128 .next
34129 The third item then ends the message.
34130 .endlist
34131
34132 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34133 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34134 .code
34135 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34136 $warn_message_delay
34137 ****
34138 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34139
34140 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34141 {that you sent }{sent by
34142
34143 <$sender_address>
34144
34145 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34146 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34147
34148 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34149 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34150 The date of the message is: $h_date
34151
34152 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34153 ****
34154 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34155 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34156 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34157 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34158 the message will be returned to you.
34159 .endd
34160 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34161 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34162 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34163 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34164 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34165 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34166 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34167 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34168 handled them.
34169
34170
34171
34172
34173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34175
34176 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34177 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34178 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34179
34180
34181
34182 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34183 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34184 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34185 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34186 routing explicitly:
34187 .code
34188 send_to_smart_host:
34189 driver = manualroute
34190 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34191 transport = remote_smtp
34192 .endd
34193 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34194 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34195 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34196 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34197 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34198
34199
34200
34201
34202 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34203 .cindex "mailing lists"
34204 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34205 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34206 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34207
34208 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34209 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34210 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34211 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34212 .code
34213 lists:
34214 driver = redirect
34215 domains = lists.example
34216 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34217 forbid_pipe
34218 forbid_file
34219 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34220 no_more
34221 .endd
34222 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34223 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34224 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34225 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34226
34227 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34228 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34229 a mailing list.
34230
34231 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34232 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34233 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34234 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34235 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34236
34237 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34238 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34239 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34240 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34241 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34242 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34243 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34244 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34245 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34246
34247
34248
34249 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34250 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34251 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34252 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34253 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34254 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34255 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34256
34257 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34258 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34259 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34260 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34261 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34262
34263
34264
34265 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34266 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34267 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34268 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34269 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34270 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34271 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34272 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34273 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34274 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34275
34276 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34277 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34278 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34279 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34280 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34281 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34282 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34283 pre-existing messages.
34284
34285 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34286 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34287 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34288 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34289 one level of expansion anyway.
34290
34291
34292
34293 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34294 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34295 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34296 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34297 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34298 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34299
34300 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34301 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34302 .code
34303 lists_request:
34304 driver = redirect
34305 domains = lists.example
34306 local_part_suffix = -request
34307 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34308 no_more
34309
34310 lists_post:
34311 driver = redirect
34312 domains = lists.example
34313 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34314 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34315 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34316 forbid_pipe
34317 forbid_file
34318 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34319 no_more
34320
34321 lists_closed:
34322 driver = redirect
34323 domains = lists.example
34324 allow_fail
34325 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34326 .endd
34327 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34328 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34329 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34330 mailing list.
34331
34332 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34333 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34334 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34335 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34336 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34337 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34338 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34339 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34340 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34341
34342 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34343 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34344 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34345
34346
34347
34348
34349 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34350 .cindex "VERP"
34351 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34352 .cindex "envelope sender"
34353 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34354 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34355 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34356 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34357 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34358 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34359
34360 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34361 .oindex &%return_path%&
34362 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34363 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34364 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34365 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34366 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34367 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34368 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34369 .code
34370 verp_smtp:
34371 driver = smtp
34372 max_rcpt = 1
34373 return_path = \
34374 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34375 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34376 .endd
34377 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34378 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34379 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34380 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34381 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34382 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34383 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34384 rewritten as
34385 .code
34386 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34387 .endd
34388 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34389 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34390 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34391 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34392 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34393 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34394
34395 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34396 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34397 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34398 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34399 .code
34400 dnslookup:
34401 driver = dnslookup
34402 domains = ! +local_domains
34403 transport = \
34404 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34405 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34406 no_more
34407 .endd
34408 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34409 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34410 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34411 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34412 address.
34413
34414 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34415 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34416 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34417 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34418 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34419 .code
34420 verp_dnslookup:
34421 driver = dnslookup
34422 domains = ! +local_domains
34423 transport = remote_smtp
34424 errors_to = \
34425 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34426 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34427 no_more
34428 .endd
34429 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34430 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34431 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34432 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34433 them.
34434
34435 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34436 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34437 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34438 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34439 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34440 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34441 used).
34442
34443
34444
34445
34446
34447
34448 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34449 .cindex "virtual domains"
34450 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34451 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34452 meanings:
34453
34454 .ilist
34455 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34456 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34457 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34458 .next
34459 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34460 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34461 have login accounts on that host.
34462 .endlist
34463
34464 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34465 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34466 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34467 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34468 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34469 to a router of this form:
34470 .code
34471 virtual:
34472 driver = redirect
34473 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34474 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34475 no_more
34476 .endd
34477 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34478 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34479 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34480 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34481 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34482 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34483
34484 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34485 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34486 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34487 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34488
34489 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34490 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34491 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34492 .code
34493 my_domains:
34494 driver = accept
34495 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34496 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34497 transport = my_mailboxes
34498 .endd
34499 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34500 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34501 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34502 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34503 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34504 follows:
34505 .code
34506 my_mailboxes:
34507 driver = appendfile
34508 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34509 user = mail
34510 .endd
34511 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34512 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34513
34514 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34515 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34516 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34517 information about the domains.
34518
34519
34520
34521 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34522 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34523 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34524 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34525 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34526 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34527 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34528 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34529 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34530 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34531 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34532 example, consider this router:
34533 .code
34534 userforward:
34535 driver = redirect
34536 check_local_user
34537 file = $home/.forward
34538 local_part_suffix = -*
34539 local_part_suffix_optional
34540 allow_filter
34541 .endd
34542 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34543 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34544 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34545 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34546 .code
34547 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34548 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34549 endif
34550 .endd
34551 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34552 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34553 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34554 control over which suffixes are valid.
34555
34556 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34557 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34558 another MTA:
34559 .code
34560 userforward:
34561 driver = redirect
34562 check_local_user
34563 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34564 local_part_suffix = -*
34565 local_part_suffix_optional
34566 allow_filter
34567 .endd
34568 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34569 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34570 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34571 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34572 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34573
34574
34575
34576 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34577 .cindex "vacation processing"
34578 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34579 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34580 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34581 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34582 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34583
34584 .ilist
34585 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34586 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34587 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34588 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34589 .code
34590 spqr, vacation-spqr
34591 .endd
34592 .next
34593 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34594 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34595 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34596 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34597 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34598 message.
34599 .endlist
34600
34601 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34602 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34603
34604
34605
34606 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34607 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34608 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34609 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34610 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34611 each day's messages.
34612
34613 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34614 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34615 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34616 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34617
34618
34619
34620 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34621 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34622 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34623 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34624 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34625 permanently connected.
34626
34627 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34628 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34629 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34630
34631
34632 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34633 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34634 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34635 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34636 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34637 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34638 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34639 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34640
34641 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34642 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34643 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34644 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34645 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34646 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34647 if required.
34648
34649 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34650 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34651 intermittent host. For example:
34652 .code
34653 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34654 .endd
34655 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34656 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34657 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34658 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34659 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34660 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34661 immediately.
34662
34663 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34664 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34665 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34666 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34667 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34668 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34669 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34670
34671
34672
34673 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34674 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34675 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34676 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34677 delivered immediately.
34678
34679 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34680 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34681 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34682 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34683 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34684 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34685 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34686 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34687 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34688 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34689 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34690 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34691 single SMTP connection.
34692
34693
34694
34695 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34696 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34697
34698 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34699 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34700 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34701 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34702 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34703 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34704 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34705 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34706 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34707 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34708 messages this way.
34709
34710 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34711 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34712 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34713 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34714 email is not desirable.
34715
34716 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34717 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34718 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34719 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34720 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34721 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34722 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34723
34724 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34725 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34726 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34727 before sending a message to the smart host.
34728
34729 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34730 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34731 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34732
34733 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34734 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34735 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34736 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34737 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34738 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34739 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34740
34741 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34742 following ways:
34743
34744 .ilist
34745 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34746 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34747 .next
34748 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34749 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34750 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34751 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34752 successful, a zero return code is given.
34753 .next
34754 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34755 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34756 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34757 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34758 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34759 are.
34760 .next
34761 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34762 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34763 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34764 .next
34765 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34766 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34767 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34768 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34769 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34770 .next
34771 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34772 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34773 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34774 .next
34775 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34776 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34777 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34778 are ever generated.
34779 .next
34780 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34781 .next
34782 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34783 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34784 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34785 .endlist
34786
34787 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34788 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34789 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34790 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34791 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34792 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34793
34794
34795
34796
34797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34799
34800 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34801 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34802 .cindex "log" "types of"
34803 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34804 and the panic log:
34805
34806 .ilist
34807 .cindex "main log"
34808 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34809 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34810 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34811 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34812 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34813 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34814 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34815 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34816 .next
34817 .cindex "reject log"
34818 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34819 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34820 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34821 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34822 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34823 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34824 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34825 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34826 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34827 false.
34828 .next
34829 .cindex "panic log"
34830 .cindex "system log"
34831 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34832 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34833 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34834 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34835 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34836 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34837 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34838 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34839 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34840 .endlist
34841
34842 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34843 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34844 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34845 .code
34846 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34847 by QUIT
34848 .endd
34849 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34850 ways of changing this:
34851
34852 .ilist
34853 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34854 you set
34855 .code
34856 timezone = UTC
34857 .endd
34858 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34859 .next
34860 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34861 example:
34862 .code
34863 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34864 .endd
34865 .endlist
34866
34867 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34868 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34869 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34870 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34871 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34872 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34873
34874
34875
34876
34877 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34878 .cindex "log" "destination"
34879 .cindex "log" "to file"
34880 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34881 .cindex "syslog"
34882 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34883 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34884 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34885 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34886 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34887 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34888 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34889
34890 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34891 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34892 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34893 references to the host name:
34894 .code
34895 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34896 .endd
34897 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34898 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34899 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34900 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34901 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34902 log at all.
34903
34904 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34905 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34906 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34907 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34908 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34909 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34910 implying the use of a default path.
34911
34912 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34913 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34914 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34915 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34916 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34917 equivalent to the setting:
34918 .code
34919 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34920 .endd
34921 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34922 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34923 that is where the logs are written.
34924
34925 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34926 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34927
34928 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34929 .display
34930 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34931 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34932 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34933 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34934 .endd
34935 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34936 error is logged.
34937
34938
34939
34940 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34941 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34942 .cindex "cycling logs"
34943 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34944 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34945 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34946 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34947 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34948 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34949 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34950
34951 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34952 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34953 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34954 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34955 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34956 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34957 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34958 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34959 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34960 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34961 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34962 renamed.
34963
34964
34965
34966 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34967 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34968 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34969 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34970 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34971 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34972 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34973 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34974 .code
34975 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34976 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34977 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34978 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34979 .endd
34980 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34981 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34982 .code
34983 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34984 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34985 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34986 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34987 .endd
34988 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34989 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34990 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34991 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34992
34993 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34994 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34995 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34996 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34997 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34998 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34999 log names:
35000 .code
35001 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35002 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35003 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35004 /var/log/exim/panic
35005 .endd
35006
35007
35008 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35009 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35010 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35011 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35012 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35013 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35014 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35015 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35016 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35017 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35018 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35019 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35020 the time and host name to each line.
35021 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35022
35023 .ilist
35024 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35025 .next
35026 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35027 .next
35028 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35029 .endlist
35030
35031 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35032 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35033 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35034 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35035
35036 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35037 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35038 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35039 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35040 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35041 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35042 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35043 RFC 3164, you should set
35044 .code
35045 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35046 .endd
35047 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35048 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35049
35050 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35051 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35052 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35053 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35054 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35055 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35056 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35057 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35058 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35059 .code
35060 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35061 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35062 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35063 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35064 [5/5] mple>)
35065 .endd
35066 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35067 (LOG_NOTICE):
35068 .code
35069 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35070 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35071 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35072 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35073 [5\18] .example>)
35074 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35075 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35076 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35077 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35078 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35079 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35080 [12\18] F From: <>
35081 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35082 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35083 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35084 [16\18] le>
35085 [17\18] B Bcc:
35086 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35087 .endd
35088 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35089 without modification.
35090
35091 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35092 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35093 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35094 where it is.
35095
35096
35097
35098 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35099 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35100 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35101 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35102 timestamp. The flags are:
35103 .display
35104 &`<=`& message arrival
35105 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35106 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35107 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35108 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35109 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35110 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35111 .endd
35112
35113
35114 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35115 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35116 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35117 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35118 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35119 .code
35120 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35121 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35122 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35123 .endd
35124 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35125 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35126 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35127 .code
35128 R=<message id>
35129 .endd
35130 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35131
35132 .cindex "HELO"
35133 .cindex "EHLO"
35134 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35135 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35136 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35137 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35138 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35139 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35140 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35141 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35142 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35143 name in parentheses.
35144
35145 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35146 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35147 the log containing text like these examples:
35148 .code
35149 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35150 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35151 .endd
35152 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35153 on.
35154
35155 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35156 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35157 of Exim.
35158
35159 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35160 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35161 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35162 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35163 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35164 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35165 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35166 suite that was used.
35167
35168 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35169 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35170 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35171 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35172 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35173 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35174 authenticator name.
35175
35176 .cindex "size" "of message"
35177 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35178 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35179 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35180 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35181 other).
35182
35183 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35184 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35185
35186
35187
35188 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35189 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35190 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35191 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35192 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35193 to fit it on the page:
35194 .code
35195 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35196 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35197 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35198 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35199 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35200 .endd
35201 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35202 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35203 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35204 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35205 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35206
35207 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35208 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35209 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35210 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35211
35212 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35213 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35214 .display
35215 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35216 .endd
35217 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35218 parentheses afterwards.
35219
35220 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35221 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35222 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35223 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35224 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35225 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35226
35227 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35228 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35229 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35230 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35231 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35232
35233 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35234 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35235
35236 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35237 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35238
35239
35240 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35241 .cindex "discarded messages"
35242 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35243 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35244 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35245 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35246 .code
35247 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35248 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35249 .endd
35250 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35251 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35252 .code
35253 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35254 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35255 .endd
35256
35257
35258 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35259 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35260 .code
35261 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35262 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35263 .endd
35264 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35265 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35266 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35267 .code
35268 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35269 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35270 .endd
35271 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35272 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35273 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35274
35275
35276
35277 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35278 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35279 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35280 following form is logged:
35281 .code
35282 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35283 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35284 .endd
35285 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35286 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35287 .code
35288 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35289 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35290 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35291 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35292 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35293 .endd
35294 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35295 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35296 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35297 flagged with &`**`&.
35298
35299
35300
35301 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35302 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35303 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35304 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35305 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35306
35307
35308
35309 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35310 A line of the form
35311 .code
35312 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35313 .endd
35314 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35315 at the end of its processing.
35316
35317
35318
35319
35320 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35321 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35322 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35323 the following table:
35324 .display
35325 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35326 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35327 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35328 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35329 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35330 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35331 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35332 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35333 &`H `& host name and IP address
35334 &`I `& local interface used
35335 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35336 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35337 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35338 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35339 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35340 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35341 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35342 &`S `& size of message
35343 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35344 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35345 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35346 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35347 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35348 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35349 .endd
35350
35351
35352 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35353 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35354 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35355
35356 .ilist
35357 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35358 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35359 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35360 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35361 during the first delivery attempt.
35362 .next
35363 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35364 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35365 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35366 .next
35367 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35368 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35369 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35370 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35371 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35372 doing.
35373 .next
35374 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35375 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35376 message:
35377 .olist
35378 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35379 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35380 .next
35381 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35382 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35383 .next
35384 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35385 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35386 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35387 .code
35388 errors_to = <>
35389 .endd
35390 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35391 .endlist olist
35392 .endlist ilist
35393
35394
35395
35396
35397
35398 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35399 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35400 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35401 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35402 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35403 example:
35404 .code
35405 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35406 .endd
35407 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35408 selection marked by asterisks:
35409 .display
35410 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35411 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35412 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35413 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35414 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35415 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35416 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35417 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35418 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35419 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35420 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35421 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35422 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35423 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35424 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35425 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35426 .new
35427 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35428 .wen
35429 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35430 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35431 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35432 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35433 &` pid `& Exim process id
35434 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35435 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35436 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35437 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35438 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35439 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35440 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35441 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35442 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35443 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35444 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35445 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35446 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35447 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35448 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35449 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35450 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35451 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35452 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35453 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35454 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35455 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35456
35457 &` all `& all of the above
35458 .endd
35459 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35460 section &<<SECID99>>&
35461
35462 More details on each of these items follows:
35463
35464 .ilist
35465 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35466 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35467 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35468 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35469 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35470 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35471 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35472 .next
35473 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35474 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35475 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35476 this log selector is set.
35477 .next
35478 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35479 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35480 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35481 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35482 such users cannot access the log).
35483 .next
35484 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35485 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35486 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35487 parentheses between them.
35488 .next
35489 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35490 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35491 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35492 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35493 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35494 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35495 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35496 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35497 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35498 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35499 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35500 between the caller and Exim.
35501 .next
35502 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35503 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35504 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35505 .next
35506 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35507 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35508 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35509 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35510 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35511 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35512 .next
35513 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35514 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35515 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35516 .next
35517 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35518 .cindex "size" "of message"
35519 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35520 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35521 .next
35522 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35523 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35524 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35525 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35526 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35527 .next
35528 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35529 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35530 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35531 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35532 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35533 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35534 .next
35535 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35536 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35537 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35538 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35539 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35540 .next
35541 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35542 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35543 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35544 client's ident port times out.
35545 .next
35546 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35547 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35548 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35549 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35550 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35551 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35552 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35553 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35554 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35555 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35556 .new
35557 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35558 .wen
35559 .next
35560 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35561 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35562 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35563 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35564 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35565 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35566 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35567 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35568 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35569 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35570 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35571 .next
35572 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35573 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35574 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35575 .next
35576 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35577 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35578 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35579 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35580 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35581 .new
35582 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35583 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35584 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35585 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35586 .wen
35587 .next
35588 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35589 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35590 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35591 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35592 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35593 .new
35594 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35595 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35596 .wen
35597 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35598 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35599 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35600 .next
35601 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35602 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35603 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35604 immediately after the time and date.
35605 .next
35606 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35607 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35608 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35609 .next
35610 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35611 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35612 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35613 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35614 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35615 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35616 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35617 message has been successfully received.
35618 .next
35619 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35620 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35621 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35622 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35623 .next
35624 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35625 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35626 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35627 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35628 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35629 has taken place.
35630 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35631 in the list.
35632 .next
35633 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35634 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35635 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35636 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35637 .next
35638 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35639 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35640 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35641 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35642 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35643 .next
35644 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35645 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35646 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35647 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35648 attempt.
35649 .next
35650 .cindex "log" "return path"
35651 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35652 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35653 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35654 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35655 .next
35656 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35657 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35658 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35659 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35660 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35661 .next
35662 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35663 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35664 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35665 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35666 detail is lost.
35667 .next
35668 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35669 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35670 it is too big.
35671 .next
35672 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35673 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35674 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35675 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35676 it.
35677 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35678 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35679 .next
35680 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35681 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35682 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35683 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35684 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35685 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35686 response.
35687 .next
35688 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35689 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35690 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35691 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35692 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35693 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35694 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35695 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35696 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35697 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35698
35699 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35700 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35701 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35702 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35703 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35704 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35705 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35706 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35707 .next
35708 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35709 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35710 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35711 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35712 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35713 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35714 .next
35715 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35716 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35717 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35718 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35719 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35720 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35721 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35722 already have their own log lines.
35723
35724 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35725 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35726 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35727 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35728 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35729 the same logging options.
35730
35731 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35732 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35733 .code
35734 C=EHLO,QUIT
35735 .endd
35736 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35737 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35738 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35739 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35740 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35741 .next
35742 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35743 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35744 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35745 was accepted or used.
35746 .next
35747 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35748 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35749 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35750 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35751 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35752 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35753 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35754 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35755 .next
35756 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35757 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35758 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35759 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35760 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35761 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35762 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35763 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35764 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35765 .next
35766 .cindex "log" "subject"
35767 .cindex "subject, logging"
35768 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35769 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35770 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35771 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35772 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35773 .next
35774 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35775 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35776 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35777 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35778 .next
35779 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35780 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35781 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35782 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35783 .next
35784 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35785 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35786 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35787 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35788 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35789 .next
35790 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35791 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35792 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35793 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35794 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35795 .next
35796 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35797 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35798 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35799 .endlist
35800
35801
35802 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35803 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35804 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35805 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35806 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35807 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35808 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35809 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35810 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35811 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35812 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35813 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35814 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35815
35816 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35817 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35818 &%message_logs%& option false.
35819 .ecindex IIDloggen
35820
35821
35822
35823
35824 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35825 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35826
35827 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35828 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35829 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35830 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35831 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35832
35833 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35834 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35835 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35836 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35837 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35838 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35839 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35840 various criteria"
35841 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35842 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35843 "extract statistics from the log"
35844 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35845 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35846 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35847 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35848 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35849 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35850 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35851 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35852 .endtable
35853
35854 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35855 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35856 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35857
35858
35859
35860
35861 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35862 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35863 .cindex "process, querying"
35864 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35865 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35866 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35867 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35868 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35869 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35870 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35871 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35872 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35873
35874 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35875 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35876 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35877
35878
35879 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35880 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35881 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35882 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35883 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35884 options:
35885 .display
35886 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35887 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35888 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35889 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35890 .endd
35891 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35892 .code
35893 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35894 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35895 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35896 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35897 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35898 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35899 .endd
35900 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35901 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35902
35903
35904
35905 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35906 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35907 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35908 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35909 .code
35910 exim -bpu
35911 .endd
35912 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35913 .code
35914 exim -bp
35915 .endd
35916 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35917 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35918
35919 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35920 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35921
35922 .vlist
35923 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35924 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35925 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35926 .code
35927 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35928 .endd
35929 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35930 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35931 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35932
35933 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35934 Match against the size field.
35935
35936 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35937 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35938
35939 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35940 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35941
35942 .vitem &*-z*&
35943 Match only frozen messages.
35944
35945 .vitem &*-x*&
35946 Match only non-frozen messages.
35947 .endlist
35948
35949 The following options control the format of the output:
35950
35951 .vlist
35952 .vitem &*-c*&
35953 Display only the count of matching messages.
35954
35955 .vitem &*-l*&
35956 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35957 the default.
35958
35959 .vitem &*-i*&
35960 Display message ids only.
35961
35962 .vitem &*-b*&
35963 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35964
35965 .vitem &*-R*&
35966 Display messages in reverse order.
35967
35968 .vitem &*-a*&
35969 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35970 .endlist
35971
35972 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35973
35974
35975
35976 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35977 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35978 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35979 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35980 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35981 running a command such as
35982 .code
35983 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35984 .endd
35985 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35986 it, as in the following example:
35987 .code
35988 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35989 .endd
35990 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35991 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35992 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35993 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35994
35995 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35996 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35997 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35998 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35999 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36000 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36001 sender.
36002
36003 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36004 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36005 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36006 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36007 level"& addresses).
36008
36009
36010
36011
36012 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36013 "SECTextspeinf"
36014 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36015 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36016 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36017 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36018 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36019 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36020 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36021 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36022 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36023 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36024 .display
36025 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36026 .endd
36027 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36028
36029 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36030 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36031 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36032
36033 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36034 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36035 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36036 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36037 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36038
36039 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36040 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36041 regular expression.
36042
36043 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36044 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36045
36046 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36047 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36048 normally.
36049
36050 Example of &%-M%&:
36051 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36052 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36053 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36054 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36055 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36056 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36057 search term.
36058
36059 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36060 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36061 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36062 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36063 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36064
36065
36066 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36067 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36068 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36069 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36070 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36071 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36072 the &%--help%& option.
36073
36074
36075 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36076 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36077 .cindex "cycling logs"
36078 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36079 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36080 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36081 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36082 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36083 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36084 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36085 .ilist
36086 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36087 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36088 .next
36089 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36090 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36091 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36092 configuration.
36093 .endlist
36094
36095 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36096 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36097 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36098 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36099 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36100 logs are handled similarly.
36101
36102 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36103 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36104 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36105 any existing log files.
36106
36107 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36108 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36109 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36110 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36111 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36112 .code
36113 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36114 .endd
36115 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36116 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36117
36118
36119
36120 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36121 .cindex "statistics"
36122 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36123 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36124 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36125 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36126 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36127
36128 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36129 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36130 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36131 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36132 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36133 .code
36134 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36135 .endd
36136 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36137 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36138 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36139 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36140 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36141 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36142 also produced per user.
36143
36144 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36145 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36146 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36147 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36148 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36149
36150 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36151 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36152 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36153 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36154 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36155 an entirely separate message.
36156
36157 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36158 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36159 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36160 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36161 least one address that failed.
36162
36163 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36164 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36165 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36166 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36167 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36168 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36169 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36170
36171 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36172 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36173 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36174
36175 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36176 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36177 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36178 .code
36179 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36180 .endd
36181
36182 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36183 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36184 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36185 .cindex "checking access"
36186 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36187 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36188 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36189 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36190 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36191 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36192
36193 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36194 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36195 .code
36196 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36197 .endd
36198 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36199 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36200 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36201 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36202 .code
36203 Rejected:
36204 550 Relay not permitted
36205 .endd
36206 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36207 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36208 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36209 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36210 you can use:
36211 .code
36212 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36213 -f himself@there.example
36214 .endd
36215 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36216 mandatory arguments.
36217
36218 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36219 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36220 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36221
36222
36223
36224 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36225 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36226 .cindex "building DBM files"
36227 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36228 .cindex "lower casing"
36229 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36230 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36231 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36232 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36233 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36234 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36235
36236 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36237 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36238 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36239 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36240 files.
36241
36242 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36243 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36244 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36245 well.
36246
36247 .cindex "USE_DB"
36248 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36249 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36250 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36251 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36252 .code
36253 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36254 .endd
36255 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36256 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36257
36258 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36259 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36260 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36261 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36262 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36263 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36264
36265 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36266 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36267 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36268 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36269 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36270 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36271 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36272 return code is 2.
36273
36274
36275
36276
36277 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36278 .cindex "retry" "times"
36279 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36280 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36281 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36282 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36283 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36284 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36285 output. For example:
36286 .code
36287 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36288 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36289 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36290 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36291 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36292 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36293 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36294 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36295 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36296 past final cutoff time
36297 .endd
36298 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36299 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36300 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36301 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36302 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36303 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36304 run very often.
36305
36306 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36307 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36308 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36309 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36310 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36311 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36312
36313
36314
36315 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36316 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36317 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36318 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36319 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36320 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36321 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36322
36323 .ilist
36324 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36325 .next
36326 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36327 for remote hosts
36328 .next
36329 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36330 .next
36331 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36332 .next
36333 &'misc'&: other hints data
36334 .endlist
36335
36336 The &'misc'& database is used for
36337
36338 .ilist
36339 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36340 .next
36341 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36342 &(smtp)& transport)
36343 .next
36344 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36345 in a transport)
36346 .endlist
36347
36348
36349
36350 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36351 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36352 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36353 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36354 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36355 .code
36356 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36357 .endd
36358 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36359 .code
36360 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36361 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36362 .endd
36363 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36364 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36365 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36366 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36367 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36368 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36369 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36370 and a textual description of the error.
36371
36372 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36373 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36374 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36375 exceeded.
36376
36377 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36378 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36379 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36380 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36381 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36382 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36383 cross-references.
36384
36385
36386
36387 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36388 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36389 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36390 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36391 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36392 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36393 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36394 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36395 updated sufficiently often.
36396
36397 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36398 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36399 the retry database:
36400 .code
36401 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36402 .endd
36403 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36404 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36405 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36406 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36407 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36408 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36409 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36410 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36411 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36412 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36413 whenever it removes information from the database.
36414
36415 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36416 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36417 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36418 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36419 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36420
36421 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36422 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36423 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36424 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36425 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36426 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36427 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36428 tidied.
36429
36430 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36431 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36432
36433
36434
36435
36436 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36437 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36438 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36439 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36440 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36441 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36442 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36443 displayed.
36444
36445 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36446 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36447 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36448 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36449 by new data, for example:
36450 .code
36451 > 4 951102:1000
36452 .endd
36453 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36454 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36455 used as optional separators.
36456
36457
36458
36459
36460 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36461 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36462 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36463 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36464 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36465 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36466 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36467 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36468 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36469 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36470 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36471 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36472 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36473
36474 .vlist
36475 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36476 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36477
36478 .vitem &%-flock%&
36479 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36480 supports it.
36481
36482 .vitem &%-interval%&
36483 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36484 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36485
36486 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36487 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36488
36489 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36490 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36491
36492 .vitem &%-q%&
36493 Suppress verification output.
36494
36495 .vitem &%-retries%&
36496 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36497 the lock (default 10).
36498
36499 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36500 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36501 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36502 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36503 subsequently sees.
36504
36505 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36506 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36507 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36508 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36509
36510 .vitem &%-v%&
36511 Generate verbose output.
36512 .endlist
36513
36514 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36515 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36516 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36517 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36518 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36519 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36520 more than 30 minutes old.
36521
36522 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36523 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36524 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36525 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36526 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36527 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36528
36529 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36530 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36531 suppresses all output except error messages.
36532
36533 A command such as
36534 .code
36535 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36536 .endd
36537 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36538 .display
36539 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36540 <&'some commands'&>
36541 &`End`&
36542 .endd
36543 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36544 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36545 such as
36546 .code
36547 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36548 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36549 .endd
36550 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36551 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36552 .ecindex IIDutils
36553
36554
36555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36557
36558 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36559 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36560 .cindex "X-windows"
36561 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36562 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36563 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36564 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36565 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36566 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36567 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36568 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36569
36570
36571
36572 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36573 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36574 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36575 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36576 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36577 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36578 parameters are for.
36579
36580 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36581 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36582 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36583 .code
36584 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36585 .endd
36586 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36587 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36588 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36589 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36590 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36591
36592 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36593 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36594 .code
36595 Eximon*background: gray94
36596 .endd
36597 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36598 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36599 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36600 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36601 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36602 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36603 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36604 .code
36605 xrdb -merge <<End
36606 Eximon*highlight: gray
36607 End
36608 .endd
36609 .cindex "admin user"
36610 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36611 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36612
36613 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36614 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36615 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36616 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36617 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36618
36619 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36620 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36621 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36622 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36623 different parts of the display.
36624
36625
36626
36627
36628 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36629 .cindex "stripchart"
36630 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36631 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36632 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36633 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36634 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36635 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36636 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36637 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36638 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36639
36640 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36641 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36642 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36643 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36644
36645 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36646 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36647 to a single partition.
36648
36649 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36650 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36651 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36652 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36653 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36654 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36655 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36656
36657
36658
36659
36660 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36661 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36662 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36663 .cindex "window size"
36664 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36665 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36666 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36667 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36668 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36669 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36670
36671 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36672 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36673 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36674 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36675
36676 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36677 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36678 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36679 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36680 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36681 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36682
36683 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36684 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36685 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36686
36687
36688
36689 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36690 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36691 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36692 the main log is maintained.
36693 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36694 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36695 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36696 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36697 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36698
36699 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36700 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36701 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36702 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36703 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36704 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36705 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36706 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36707 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36708 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36709 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36710
36711 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36712 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36713 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36714 It cannot go further back up the log.
36715
36716 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36717 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36718 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36719 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36720 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36721 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36722
36723 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36724 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36725 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36726 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36727 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36728 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36729
36730 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36731 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36732 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36733 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36734 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36735 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36736 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36737 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36738 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36739 window.
36740
36741
36742
36743 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36744 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36745 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36746 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36747 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36748 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36749 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36750 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36751 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36752 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36753
36754 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36755 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36756 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36757 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36758 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36759 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36760 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36761
36762 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36763 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36764 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36765 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36766 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36767 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36768 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36769
36770 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36771 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36772 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36773 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36774
36775 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36776 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36777 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36778 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36779 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36780 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36781 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36782 not shown.
36783
36784 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36785 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36786
36787 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36788 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36789 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36790 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36791 display is updated.
36792
36793
36794
36795 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36796 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36797 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36798 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36799 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36800 any selected text.
36801
36802 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36803 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36804 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36805 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36806 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36807 .code
36808 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36809 .endd
36810 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36811 follows:
36812
36813 .ilist
36814 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36815 in a new text window.
36816 .next
36817 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36818 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36819 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36820 .next
36821 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36822 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36823 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36824 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36825 .next
36826 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36827 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36828 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36829 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36830 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36831 .next
36832 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36833 that the message be frozen.
36834 .next
36835 .cindex "thawing messages"
36836 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36837 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36838 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36839 that the message be thawed.
36840 .next
36841 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36842 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36843 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36844 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36845 .next
36846 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36847 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36848 message.
36849 .next
36850 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36851 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36852 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36853 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36854 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36855 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36856 which case no action is taken.
36857 .next
36858 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36859 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36860 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36861 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36862 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36863 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36864 case no action is taken.
36865 .next
36866 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36867 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36868 .next
36869 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36870 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36871 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36872 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36873 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36874 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36875 the address is qualified with that domain.
36876 .endlist
36877
36878 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36879 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36880 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36881 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36882 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36883 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36884 if no output is generated.
36885
36886 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36887 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36888 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36889 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36890
36891 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36892 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36893 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36894 .ecindex IIDeximon
36895
36896
36897
36898
36899
36900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36901 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36902
36903 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36904 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36905 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36906 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36907
36908 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36909 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36910 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36911 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36912 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36913 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36914
36915 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36916 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36917 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36918 as soon as possible.
36919
36920
36921 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36922 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36923 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36924 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36925 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36926 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36927
36928 .ilist
36929 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36930 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36931 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36932 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36933 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36934 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36935
36936 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36937 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36938 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36939 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36940 .next
36941
36942 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36943 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36944 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36945 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36946 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36947 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36948 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36949 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36950 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36951 separate commands.
36952
36953 .next
36954 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36955 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36956 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36957 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36958 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36959 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36960 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36961 .next
36962 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36963 is disabled.
36964 .next
36965 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36966 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36967 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36968 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36969 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36970 .endlist
36971
36972
36973
36974 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36975 .cindex "setuid"
36976 .cindex "root privilege"
36977 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36978 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36979 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36980 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36981 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36982 is required for two things:
36983
36984 .ilist
36985 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36986 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36987 not required.
36988 .next
36989 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36990 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36991 configuration.
36992 .endlist
36993
36994 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36995 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36996 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36997 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36998 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36999 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37000 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37001 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37002
37003 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37004 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37005 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37006
37007 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37008 uid and gid in the following cases:
37009
37010 .ilist
37011 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37012 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37013 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37014 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37015 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37016 the calling process.
37017 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37018 option may not be used at all.
37019 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37020 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37021 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37022 .next
37023 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37024 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37025 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37026 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37027 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37028 calling process.
37029 .next
37030 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37031 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37032 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37033 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37034 testing address verification
37035 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37036 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37037 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37038 option).
37039 .next
37040 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37041 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37042 .endlist
37043
37044 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37045
37046 .ilist
37047 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37048 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37049 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37050 will be used during message reception.
37051 .next
37052 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37053 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37054 .next
37055 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37056 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37057 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37058 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37059 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37060 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37061 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37062 generating bounce and warning messages.
37063
37064 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37065 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37066 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37067 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37068 .next
37069 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37070 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37071 .endlist
37072
37073
37074
37075
37076 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37077 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37078 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37079 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37080 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37081 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37082 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37083 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37084 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37085 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37086 to any other uid.
37087
37088 .cindex SIGHUP
37089 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37090 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37091 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37092 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37093
37094 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37095 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37096 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37097 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37098 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37099
37100 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37101 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37102 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37103 effect.
37104
37105 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37106 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37107 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37108
37109 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37110 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37111 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37112 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37113 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37114 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37115 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37116 address this problem at this time.
37117
37118 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37119 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37120 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37121 be used in the most straightforward way.
37122
37123 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37124 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37125
37126 .ilist
37127 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37128 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37129 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37130 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37131 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37132 .next
37133 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37134 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37135 .next
37136 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37137 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37138 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37139 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37140 .next
37141 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37142 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37143
37144 .olist
37145 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37146 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37147 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37148 .next
37149 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37150 owned by the Exim user.
37151 .next
37152 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37153 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37154 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37155 .endlist olist
37156 .endlist ilist
37157
37158
37159 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37160 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37161 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37162 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37163
37164 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37165 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37166
37167
37168
37169
37170 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37171 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37172 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37173
37174
37175
37176 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37177 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37178 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37179 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37180 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37181 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37182 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37183
37184 .ilist
37185 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37186 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37187 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37188 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37189 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37190 .next
37191 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37192 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37193 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37194 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37195 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37196 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37197 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37198 .next
37199 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37200 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37201 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37202 .next
37203 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37204 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37205 .next
37206 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37207 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37208 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37209 .next
37210 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37211 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37212 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37213 of opaque strings.
37214 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37215 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37216 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37217 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37218 .endlist
37219
37220
37221
37222
37223 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37224 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37225 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37226 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37227 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37228 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37229 are some issues to be aware of:
37230
37231 .ilist
37232 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37233 .next
37234 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37235 .next
37236 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37237 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37238 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37239 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37240 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37241 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37242 data.
37243 .next
37244 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37245 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37246 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37247 .next
37248 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37249 expected to yield one result.
37250 .endlist
37251
37252
37253
37254
37255 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37256 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37257 .cindex "IP source routing"
37258 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37259 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37260 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37261 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37262
37263
37264
37265 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37266 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37267 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37268
37269
37270
37271
37272 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37273 .cindex "trusted users"
37274 .cindex "admin user"
37275 .cindex "privileged user"
37276 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37277 .cindex "user" "admin"
37278 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37279 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37280 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37281 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37282 permit a remote host to be specified.
37283
37284 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37285 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37286 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37287 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37288 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37289 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37290 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37291
37292 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37293 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37294 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37295 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37296 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37297
37298 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37299 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37300 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37301 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37302 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37303
37304 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37305 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37306 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37307 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37308 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37309 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37310 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37311 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37312
37313 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37314 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37315 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37316 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37317 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37318 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37319 files.
37320
37321
37322
37323 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37324 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37325 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37326 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37327 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37328 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37329
37330
37331
37332 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37333 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37334 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37335 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37336 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37337 this.
37338
37339
37340
37341 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37342 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37343 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37344 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37345 converted output.
37346
37347
37348
37349 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37350 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37351 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37352 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37353 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37354
37355
37356
37357 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37358 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37359 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37360 loading it.
37361
37362
37363 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37364 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37365 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37366 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37367 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37368 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37369 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37370
37371 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37372 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37373 string.
37374
37375
37376
37377 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37378 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37379 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37380 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37381
37382
37383
37384 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37385 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37386 enough to hold the result.
37387 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37388
37389
37390
37391
37392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37394
37395 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37396 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37397 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37398 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37399 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37400 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37401 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37402 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37403 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37404 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37405 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37406 themselves are recoverable.
37407
37408 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37409 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37410 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37411
37412 .ilist
37413 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37414 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37415 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37416 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37417 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37418 .next
37419 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37420 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37421 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37422 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37423 will always be the case.
37424 .next
37425 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37426 .next
37427 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37428 signature.
37429 .endlist
37430 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37431
37432 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37433 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37434 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37435 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37436 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37437 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37438 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37439 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37440 attempt.
37441
37442 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37443 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37444 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37445 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37446 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37447 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37448 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37449 normally the Exim user.
37450
37451 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37452 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37453 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37454 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37455 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37456 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37457 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37458 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37459
37460 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37461 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37462 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37463 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37464
37465 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37466 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37467
37468 .vlist
37469 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37470 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37471 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37472 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37473 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37474 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37475 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37476 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37477 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37478 newlines.
37479
37480 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37481 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37482 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37483 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37484 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37485 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37486
37487 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37488 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37489 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37490 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37491 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37492 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37493
37494 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37495 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37496 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37497
37498 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37499 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37500 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37501 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37502 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37503
37504 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37505 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37506 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37507 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37508 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37509
37510 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37511 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37512 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37513
37514 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37515 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37516 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37517
37518 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37519 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37520 present.
37521
37522 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37523 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37524 present if the number is greater than zero.
37525
37526 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37527 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37528 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37529
37530 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37531 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37532 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37533
37534 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37535 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37536 command.
37537
37538 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37539 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37540 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37541 messages.
37542
37543 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37544 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37545 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37546 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37547
37548 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37549 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37550 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37551
37552 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37553 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37554 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37555 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37556 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37557 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37558
37559 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37560 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37561 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37562 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37563 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37564
37565 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37566 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37567 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37568 generated messages.
37569
37570 .vitem &%-local%&
37571 The message is from a local sender.
37572
37573 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37574 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37575
37576 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37577 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37578 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37579 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37580
37581 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37582 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37583 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37584
37585 .vitem &%-N%&
37586 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37587 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37588 &%-N%& is assumed.
37589
37590 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37591 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37592 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37593
37594 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37595 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37596 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37597
37598 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37599 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37600 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37601
37602 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37603 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37604 certificate was verified by the server.
37605
37606 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37607 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37608 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37609
37610 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37611 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37612 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37613 certificate.
37614 .endlist
37615
37616 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37617 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37618 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37619 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37620 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37621 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37622 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37623 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37624 addresses are complete.
37625
37626 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37627 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37628 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37629 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37630 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37631 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37632 .code
37633 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37634 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37635 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37636 .endd
37637 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37638 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37639 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37640 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37641 example:
37642 .code
37643 4
37644 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37645 darcy@austen.fict.example
37646 rdo@foundation
37647 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37648 .endd
37649 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37650 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37651 line is of the following form:
37652 .display
37653 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37654 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37655 .endd
37656 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37657 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37658 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37659 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37660 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37661 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37662 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37663 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37664
37665
37666 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37667 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37668 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37669 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37670 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37671 following:
37672
37673 .table2 50pt
37674 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37675 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37676 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37677 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37678 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37679 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37680 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37681 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37682 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37683 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37684 .endtable
37685
37686 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37687 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37688 typical set of headers:
37689 .code
37690 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37691 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37692 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37693 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37694 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37695 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37696 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37697 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37698 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37699 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37700 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37701 .endd
37702 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37703 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37704 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37705 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37706 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37707 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37708
37709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37711
37712 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37713 "DKIM Support"
37714 .cindex "DKIM"
37715
37716 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37717 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37718 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37719 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37720
37721 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37722 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37723
37724 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37725 .olist
37726 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37727 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37728 (including transport filters)
37729 except cutthrough delivery.
37730 .next
37731 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37732 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37733 different signature contexts.
37734 .endlist
37735
37736 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37737 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37738 Exim's standard controls.
37739
37740 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37741 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37742 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37743 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37744 .code
37745 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37746 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37747 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37748 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37749 .endd
37750 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37751 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37752 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37753 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37754 senders).
37755
37756
37757 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37758 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37759
37760 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37761 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37762
37763 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37764 MANDATORY:
37765 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37766 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37767
37768 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37769 MANDATORY:
37770 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37771 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37772 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37773 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37774
37775 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37776 MANDATORY:
37777 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37778 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37779 The result can either
37780 .ilist
37781 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37782 .next
37783 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37784 the private key.
37785 .next
37786 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37787 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37788 is set.
37789 .endlist
37790
37791 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37792 OPTIONAL:
37793 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37794 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37795 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37796 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37797
37798 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37799 OPTIONAL:
37800 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37801 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37802 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37803 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37804 variables here.
37805
37806 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37807 OPTIONAL:
37808 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37809 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37810 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37811 used.
37812
37813
37814 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37815 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37816
37817 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37818 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37819 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37820 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37821 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37822 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37823 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37824
37825 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37826 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37827 runtime of the ACL.
37828
37829 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37830 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37831 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37832 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37833
37834 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37835 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37836 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37837 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37838 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37839 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37840 it defaults as:
37841 .code
37842 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37843 .endd
37844 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37845 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37846 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37847 .code
37848 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37849 .endd
37850 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37851 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37852 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37853 .code
37854 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37855 .endd
37856
37857 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37858 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37859
37860
37861 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37862 available (from most to least important):
37863
37864
37865 .vlist
37866 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37867 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37868 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37869 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37870 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37871 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37872 .ilist
37873 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37874 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37875 .next
37876 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37877 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37878 .next
37879 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37880 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37881 .next
37882 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37883 .endlist
37884 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37885 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37886 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37887 .ilist
37888 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37889 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37890 .next
37891 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37892 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37893 .next
37894 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37895 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37896 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37897 .next
37898 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37899 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37900 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37901 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37902 .endlist
37903 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37904 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37905 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37906 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37907 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37908 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37909 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37910 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37911 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37912 The key record selector string.
37913 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37914 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37915 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37916 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37917 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37918 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37919 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37920 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37921 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37922 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37923 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37924 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37925 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37926 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37927 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37928 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37929 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37930 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37931 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37932 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37933 integer size comparisons against this value.
37934 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37935 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37936 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37937 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37938 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37939 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37940 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37941 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37942 in the key record.
37943 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37944 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37945 in the key record.
37946 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37947 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37948 .endlist
37949
37950 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37951
37952 .vlist
37953 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37954 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37955 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37956 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37957 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37958
37959 .code
37960 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37961 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37962 sender_domains = gmail.com
37963 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37964 dkim_status = none
37965 .endd
37966
37967 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37968 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37969 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37970 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37971
37972 .code
37973 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37974 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37975 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37976 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37977 .endd
37978
37979 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37980 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37981 for more information of what they mean.
37982 .endlist
37983
37984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37986
37987 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37988 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37989 .cindex "adding drivers"
37990 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37991 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37992 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37993 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37994
37995 .olist
37996 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37997 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37998 .next
37999 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38000 .display
38001 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38002 .endd
38003 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38004 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38005 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38006 .next
38007 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38008 .code
38009 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38010 .endd
38011 .next
38012 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38013 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38014 .next
38015 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38016 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38017 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38018 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38019 simple form that most lookups have.
38020 .next
38021 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38022 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38023 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38024 .next
38025 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38026 &_src_&.
38027 .next
38028 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38029 as for other drivers and lookups.
38030 .endlist
38031
38032 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38033 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38034 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38035 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38036 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38037
38038 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38039 the interface that is expected.
38040
38041
38042
38043
38044 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38045 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38046
38047 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38048 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38049 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38050 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38051 . processors.
38052 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38053
38054 .literal xml
38055 <?sdop
38056 format="newpage"
38057 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38058 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38059 ?>
38060 .literal off
38061
38062 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38063 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38064 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38065
38066
38067 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38068 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////